TLS: add variables for the IETF standard name for the connection ciphersuite
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
... / ...
CommitLineData
1. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
6.
7. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9. unwanted vertical space.
10. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11
12.include stdflags
13.include stdmacs
14
15. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18
19.docbook
20
21. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
25. processors.
26. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27
28.literal xml
29<?sdop
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
34?>
35.literal off
36
37. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38. This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40
41.book
42
43. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45. Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
47
48.set previousversion "4.92"
49.include ./local_params
50
51.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52.set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
53
54.macro copyyear
552018
56.endmacro
57
58. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60. provided in the xfpt library.
61. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62
63. --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
64
65.flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66
67. --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68. --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
69
70.flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
71.flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
72
73. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
76. --- index entry.
77
78.macro option
79.arg 5
80.oindex "&%$5%&"
81.endarg
82.arg -5
83.oindex "&%$1%&"
84.endarg
85.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
87.endtable
88.endmacro
89
90. --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91. --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92. --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93
94.macro table2 196pt 254pt
95.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
96.endmacro
97
98. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
101
102.macro irow
103.arg 4
104.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
105.endarg
106.arg -4
107.arg 3
108.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
109.endarg
110.arg -3
111.row "&I;$1" "$2"
112.endarg
113.endarg
114.endmacro
115
116. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119. --- ID that ties them together.
120
121.macro cindex
122&<indexterm role="concept">&
123&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124.arg 2
125&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
126.endarg
127&</indexterm>&
128.endmacro
129
130.macro scindex
131&<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132&<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133.arg 3
134&<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
135.endarg
136&</indexterm>&
137.endmacro
138
139.macro ecindex
140&<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
141.endmacro
142
143.macro oindex
144&<indexterm role="option">&
145&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146.arg 2
147&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
148.endarg
149&</indexterm>&
150.endmacro
151
152.macro vindex
153&<indexterm role="variable">&
154&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155.arg 2
156&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
157.endarg
158&</indexterm>&
159.endmacro
160
161.macro index
162.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163.endmacro
164. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
165
166
167. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168. The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
169. output formats.
170. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
171
172.literal xml
173<bookinfo>
174<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
176<date>
177.fulldate
178</date>
179<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181<revhistory><revision>
182.versiondatexml
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184</revision></revhistory>
185<copyright><year>
186.copyyear
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
188</bookinfo>
189.literal off
190
191
192. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193. This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194. "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
197
198.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199.literal xml
200
201<indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
204</indexterm>
205<indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
209</indexterm>
210<indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
213</indexterm>
214<indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
217</indexterm>
218<indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
221</indexterm>
222<indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
225</indexterm>
226<indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
230</indexterm>
231<indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
234</indexterm>
235<indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
238</indexterm>
239<indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
242</indexterm>
243<indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
246</indexterm>
247<indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
251</indexterm>
252<indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
255</indexterm>
256<indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
259</indexterm>
260<indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
263</indexterm>
264<indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
267</indexterm>
268<indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
271</indexterm>
272<indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
275</indexterm>
276<indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
279</indexterm>
280<indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
283</indexterm>
284<indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
287</indexterm>
288<indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
291</indexterm>
292<indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
295</indexterm>
296<indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
299</indexterm>
300<indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
303</indexterm>
304<indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
308</indexterm>
309<indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
312</indexterm>
313<indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
316</indexterm>
317<indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
320</indexterm>
321
322.literal off
323
324
325. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326. This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327. we can't have the .chapter line here.
328. chapter "Introduction"
329. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
330
331Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
335
336Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
343
344There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
347
348The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
351
352The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
357
358Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
363
364Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367&_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
368contributors.
369
370
371.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
373
374.cindex "documentation"
375This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
376Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
377renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
378capable of showing a change indicator.
379
380This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
381is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
382with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
383and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
384it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
385Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
386a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
387very wide interest.
388
389.cindex "books about Exim"
390An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
391introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
392SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
393(&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
394
395The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
396Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
397with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
398published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
399
400.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
401If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
402Debian-specific features in the file
403&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
404The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
405information.
406
407.cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
408.cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
409.cindex "change log"
410As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
411yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
412digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
413new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
414&_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
415
416Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
417incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
418they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
419can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
420
421All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
422change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
423
424.cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
425This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
426that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
427directory are:
428
429.table2 100pt
430.row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
431.row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
432.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
433.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
434.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
435.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
436.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
437.row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
438.endtable
439
440The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
441available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
442&<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
443
444
445
446.section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
447.cindex "website"
448.cindex "FTP site"
449The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
450available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
451website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
452
453.cindex "wiki"
454.cindex "FAQ"
455As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
456differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
457online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
458which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
459examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
460The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
461provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
462
463.cindex Bugzilla
464An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
465this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
466first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
467Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
468
469
470.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
471.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
472The following Exim mailing lists exist:
473
474.table2 140pt
475.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
476.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
477.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
478.row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
479.endtable
480
481You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
482or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
483.cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
484If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
485the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
486via this web page:
487.display
488&url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
489.endd
490Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
491lists.
492
493.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
494.cindex "bug reports"
495.cindex "reporting bugs"
496Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
497via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
498whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
499message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
500
501
502
503.section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
504.cindex "FTP site"
505.cindex "HTTPS download site"
506.cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
507.cindex "distribution" "https site"
508The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
509.display
510&url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
511.endd
512The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
513We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
514
515The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
516content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
517&url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
518
519If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
520follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
521If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
522here are top-level directories.
523
524There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
526
527Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
531.display
532&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz_&
533&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
534&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
535.endd
536where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
537files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
538The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
539most portable to old systems.
540
541.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
542.cindex "distribution" "public key"
543.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
544The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
545Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
546&'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
547other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
548PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
549PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
550&_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
551such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
552
553At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
554with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
555of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
556and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
557
558The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
559.display
560&_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
561&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
562&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
563.endd
564For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
565separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
566find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
567
568.cindex "documentation" "available formats"
569The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
570documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
571inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
572.display
573&_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
574&_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575&_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576&_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
577.endd
578These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
579distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
580
581
582.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
583.ilist
584.cindex "limitations of Exim"
585.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
586Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
587RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
588simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
589configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
590UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
591.next
592.cindex "domainless addresses"
593.cindex "address" "without domain"
594Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
595local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
596configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
597systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
598arrival.
599.next
600.cindex "transport" "external"
601.cindex "external transports"
602The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
603and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
604transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
605and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
606to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
607handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
608.next
609Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
610such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
611(that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
612other means.
613.next
614Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
615are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
616are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
617compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
618a number of common scanners are provided.
619.endlist
620
621
622.section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
623Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
624into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
625values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
626file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
627distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
628
629
630.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
631.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
632Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
633can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
634&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
635about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
636Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
637example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
638format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
6393, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
640documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
641made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
642
643Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
644line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
645which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
646interface to Exim's command line administration options.
647
648
649
650.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
651.cindex "terminology definitions"
652.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
653The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
654It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
655below) by a blank line.
656
657.cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
658When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
659delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
660&'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
661called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
662failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
663message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
664rise to further bounce messages.
665
666The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
667value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
668also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
669otherwise.
670
671The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
672destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
673down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
674until a later time.
675
676The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
677host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
678the part of an email address following the @ sign.
679
680.cindex "envelope, definition of"
681.cindex "sender" "definition of"
682A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
683body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
684be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
685sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
686envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
687messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
688
689.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
690.cindex "header section" "definition of"
691The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
692of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
693&'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
694indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
695line.
696
697.cindex "local part" "definition of"
698.cindex "domain" "definition of"
699The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
700part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
701@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
702
703.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
704.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
705The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
706delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
707TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
708host it is running on are &'remote'&.
709
710.cindex "return path" "definition of"
711&'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
712message's envelope.
713
714.cindex "queue" "definition of"
715The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
716because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
717Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
718normally no ordering of waiting messages.
719
720.cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
721The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
722and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
723is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
724the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
725
726.cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
727The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
728messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
729delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
730mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
731the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
732
733
734
735
736
737
738. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
739. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
740
741.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
742.cindex "incorporated code"
743.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
744.cindex "PCRE"
745.cindex "OpenDMARC"
746A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
747
748.ilist
749Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
750Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
751&copy; University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
752Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
753or obtain and install the full version of the library from
754&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
755.next
756.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
757Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
758contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
759Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
760It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
761following statements:
762
763.blockquote
764Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
765
766This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
767the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
768Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
769version.
770This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
771the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
772&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
773some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
774restrictions applied to it).
775.endblockquote
776.next
777.cindex "SPA authentication"
778.cindex "Samba project"
779.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
780Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
781by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
782Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
783under the Gnu GPL.
784.next
785.cindex "Cyrus"
786.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
787.cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
788Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
789by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
790Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
791conditions expressed therein.
792
793.blockquote
794Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
795
796Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
797modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
798are met:
799
800.olist
801Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
802notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
803.next
804Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
805notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
806the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
807distribution.
808.next
809The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
810endorse or promote products derived from this software without
811prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
812details, please contact
813.display
814 Office of Technology Transfer
815 Carnegie Mellon University
816 5000 Forbes Avenue
817 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
818 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
819 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
820.endd
821.next
822Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
823acknowledgment:
824
825&"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
826at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
827
828CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
829THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
830AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
831FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
832WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
833AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
834OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
835.endlist
836.endblockquote
837
838.next
839.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
840.cindex "X-windows"
841.cindex "Athena"
842The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
843modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
844This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
845below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
846
847.blockquote
848Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
849and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
850
851All Rights Reserved
852
853Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
854documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
855provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
856both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
857supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
858used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
859software without specific, written prior permission.
860
861DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
862ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
863DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
864ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
865WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
866ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
867SOFTWARE.
868.endblockquote
869
870.next
871.cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
872The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
873The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
874derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
875license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
876source code.
877
878.next
879Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
880not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
881contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
882.endlist
883
884
885
886
887
888. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
889. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
890
891.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
892 "Receiving and delivering mail"
893
894
895.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
896.cindex "design philosophy"
897Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
898to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
899most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
900maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
901it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
902has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
903
904
905.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
906.cindex "policy control" "overview"
907Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
908Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
909&"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
910unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
911facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
912
913.ilist
914.cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
915Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
916incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
917series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
918several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
919host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
920very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
921rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
922two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
923error code.
924.next
925An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
926case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
927.next
928When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
929provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
930spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
931which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
932.next
933When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
934host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
935function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
936whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
937is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
938.next
939Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
940software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
941Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
942.next
943After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
944the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
945runs at the start of every delivery process.
946.endlist
947
948
949
950.section "User filters" "SECID12"
951.cindex "filter" "introduction"
952.cindex "Sieve filter"
953In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
954setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
955chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
956configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
957&'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
958of filtering are available:
959
960.ilist
961Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
962by RFC 3028.
963.next
964Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
965powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
966.endlist
967
968User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
969
970
971
972.section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
973.cindex "message ids" "details of format"
974.cindex "format" "of message id"
975.cindex "id of message"
976.cindex "base62"
977.cindex "base36"
978.cindex "Darwin"
979.cindex "Cygwin"
980Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
981characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
982example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
983normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
984system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
985(avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
986id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
987not always case-sensitive.
988
989.cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
990The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
991Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
992within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
993be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
994the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
995somewhat eccentric:
996
997.ilist
998The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
999started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1000contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1001way of representing the date and time of day).
1002.next
1003After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1004received the message.
1005.next
1006There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1007.olist
1008.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1009If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1010time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1011that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1012systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1013.next
1014If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1015the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1016(1/100) of a second.
1017.endlist
1018.endlist
1019
1020After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1021appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1022received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1023pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1024will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1025
1026
1027.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1028.cindex "receiving mail"
1029.cindex "message" "reception"
1030The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1031TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1032SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1033there are several possibilities:
1034
1035.ilist
1036If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1037non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1038command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1039.next
1040If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1041non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1042the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1043command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1044but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1045envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1046.next
1047If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1048interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1049passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1050This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1051example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1052.next
1053A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1054(127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1055does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1056in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1057.endlist
1058
1059
1060.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1061.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1062In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1063constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1064qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1065option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1066SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1067certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1068unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1069address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1070different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1071users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1072users to change sender addresses.
1073
1074Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1075checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1076(either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1077number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1078individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1079requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1080&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1081
1082Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1083received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1084connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1085queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1086configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1087message is received.
1088
1089
1090
1091
1092
1093.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1094.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1095.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1096When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1097first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1098the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1099the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1100file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1101
1102.cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1103By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1104&_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1105not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1106improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1107used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1108whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1109processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1110overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1111affect file system performance.
1112
1113The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1114the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1115any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1116a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1117first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1118
1119.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1120Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1121(see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1122both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1123If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1124example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1125generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1126rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1127different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1128addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1129delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1130&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1131
1132
1133
1134.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1135.cindex "message" "life of"
1136.cindex "message" "frozen"
1137A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1138its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1139administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1140cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1141recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1142spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1143
1144.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1145.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1146An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1147corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1148addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1149to be sent.
1150
1151.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1152.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1153There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1154&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1155The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1156
1157.cindex "message" "log file for"
1158.cindex "log" "file for each message"
1159While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1160attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1161delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1162lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1163These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1164deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1165The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1166&%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1167systems.
1168
1169.cindex "journal file"
1170.cindex "file" "journal"
1171All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1172spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1173address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1174message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1175addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1176is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1177Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1178minimize the possibility of data loss.
1179
1180Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1181the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1182time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1183updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1184deliveries caused by crashes.
1185
1186
1187
1188.section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1189.cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1190.cindex "router" "definition of"
1191.cindex "transport" "definition of"
1192The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1193&'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1194number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1195specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1196ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1197
1198.cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1199Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1200of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1201you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1202option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1203instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1204instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1205configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1206the driver's features in general.
1207
1208A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1209its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1210converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1211alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1212to be bounced.
1213
1214A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1215spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1216transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1217&'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1218to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1219several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1220
1221.cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1222An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1223turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1224specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1225detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1226address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1227
1228To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1229routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1230routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1231configuration.
1232
1233The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1234addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1235Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1236is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1237its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1238match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1239find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1240assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1241configured to fail the address.
1242
1243The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1244&"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1245aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1246original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1247router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1248address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1249
1250The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1251address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1252see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1253local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1254the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1255the address is bounced.
1256
1257
1258
1259.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1260.cindex "router" "for verification"
1261.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1262As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1263are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1264one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1265sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1266&%-bvs%& command line options.
1267
1268When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1269does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1270detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1271when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1272sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1273previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1274checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1275would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1276
1277
1278
1279
1280.section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1281.cindex "router" "running details"
1282.cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1283.cindex "router" "result of running"
1284As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1285running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1286passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1287the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1288the following:
1289
1290.ilist
1291&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1292transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1293original address ceases
1294.oindex "&%unseen%&"
1295unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1296can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1297for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1298passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1299end of routing.
1300
1301Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1302starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1303setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1304child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1305&%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1306.next
1307&'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1308requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1309is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1310&%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1311must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1312.next
1313&'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1314recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1315this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1316set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1317&'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1318.next
1319&'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1320the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1321original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1322.next
1323&'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1324database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1325processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1326next time the message is considered for delivery.
1327.next
1328&'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1329its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1330.endlist
1331
1332If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1333any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1334situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1335making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1336router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1337
1338Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1339met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1340You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1341when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1342facility for this purpose.
1343
1344
1345.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1346.cindex "case of local parts"
1347.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1348.cindex "duplicate addresses"
1349Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1350and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1351check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1352actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1353routed addresses are shown.
1354
1355
1356
1357.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1358.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1359.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1360The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1361order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1362described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1363
1364.ilist
1365.cindex affix "router precondition"
1366The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371of any other conditions.
1372.next
1373Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375&%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1376address.
1377Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378&%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1382.next
1383If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1388.next
1389Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1392.next
1393Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1395.next
1396If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397of domains that it defines.
1398.next
1399.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400.vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402.cindex affix "router precondition"
1403If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1404the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1405&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1406part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1407that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1408that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1409&$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1410.next
1411.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1412.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1413.vindex "&$home$&"
1414If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1415an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1416local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1417user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1418remaining preconditions.
1419.next
1420If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1421because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1422later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1423subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1424could lead to confusion.
1425.next
1426If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1427set of addresses that it defines.
1428.next
1429If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1430specified files is tested.
1431.next
1432.cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1433If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1434uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1435Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1436.endlist
1437
1438
1439Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1440it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1441part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1442&%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1443&%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1444going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1445example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1446
1447
1448
1449.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1450.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1451When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1452
1453.ilist
1454If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1455filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1456message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1457fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1458files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1459filtering'&.
1460.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1461(&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1462
1463Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1464&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1465filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1466if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1467be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1468condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1469filter.
1470.next
1471Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1472its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1473address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1474can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1475processed entirely independently of each other.
1476.next
1477.cindex "routing" "loops in"
1478.cindex "loop" "while routing"
1479A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1480transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1481is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1482Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1483from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1484process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1485which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1486.next
1487When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1488handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1489doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1490local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1491collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1492addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1493address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1494addresses to the same domain.
1495.next
1496Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1497non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1498deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1499to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1500run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1501one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1502The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1503deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1504.next
1505.cindex "queue runner"
1506When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1507database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1508address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1509Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1510reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1511queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1512follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1513better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1514causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1515.next
1516.cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1517Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1518deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1519retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1520reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1521not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1522.next
1523If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1524appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1525for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1526messages to other addresses.
1527.next
1528.cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1529If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1530the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1531&'deferred'&.
1532.next
1533When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1534handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1535deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1536.endlist
1537
1538
1539
1540
1541.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1542.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1543.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1544.cindex "queue runner"
1545Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1546attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1547uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1548intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1549not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1550first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1551its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1552passed its retry time.
1553You can run several queue runners at once.
1554
1555Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1556address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1557should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1558bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1559error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1560as permanent.
1561
1562
1563
1564.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1565.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1566There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1567particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1568connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1569detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1570Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1571is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1572impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1573also apply.
1574
1575If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1576waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1577connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1578deferred,
1579.cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1580Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1581SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1582for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1583connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1584one connection.
1585
1586
1587
1588.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1589.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1590.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1591When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1592bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1593errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1594delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1595many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1596attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1597message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1598See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1599
1600.cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1601Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1602failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1603automatically.
1604
1605.cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1606A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1607obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1608address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1609forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1610failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1611&<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1612of the list.
1613
1614
1615
1616.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1617.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1618If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1619itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1620but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1621that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1622for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1623&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1624
1625
1626
1627
1628
1629. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1631
1632.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1633.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1634
1635.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1636Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1637creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1638&_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1639
1640.table2 140pt
1641.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1642.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1643 documented"
1644.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1645.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1646.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1647.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1648 instructions"
1649.endtable
1650
1651Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1652following subdirectories are created:
1653
1654.table2 140pt
1655.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1656.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1657.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1658.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1659.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1660.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1661.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1662.endtable
1663
1664The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1665with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1666that may be useful to some sites.
1667
1668
1669.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1670.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1671The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1672a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1673source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1674Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1675system.
1676.cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1677Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1678the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1679architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1680overridden if necessary.
1681.cindex compiler requirements
1682.cindex compiler version
1683A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1684
1685
1686.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1687.cindex "PCRE library"
1688Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1689modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1690install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1691system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1692process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1693headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1694and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1695or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1696If your operating system has no
1697PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1698from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1699More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1700
1701.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1702.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1703.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1704Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1705DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1706databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1707different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1708
1709.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1710.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1711.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1712.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1713If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1714Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1715may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1716you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1717
1718.cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1719Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1720via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1721versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1722some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1723distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1724versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1725Berkeley DB library.
1726
1727Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1728use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1729possibilities:
1730
1731.olist
1732A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1733Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1734.next
1735.cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1736The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1737compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1738&_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1739filename is used unmodified.
1740.next
1741.cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1742The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1743operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1744programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1745.next
1746If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1747file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1748the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1749.next
1750To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1751Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
17522.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1753Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1754Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1755&url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1756page with far newer versions listed.
1757It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1758Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1759suited to Exim's usage model.
1760.next
1761.cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1762Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1763&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1764operates on a single file.
1765.endlist
1766
1767.cindex "USE_DB"
1768.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1769Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1770to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1771USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1772&_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1773.code
1774USE_DB=yes
1775.endd
1776Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1777error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1778
1779At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1780thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1781configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1782Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1783configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1784&_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1785
1786As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1787necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1788in one of these lines:
1789.code
1790DBMLIB = -ldb
1791DBMLIB = -ltdb
1792.endd
1793Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1794place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1795the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1796file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1797this example:
1798.code
1799INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1800DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1801.endd
1802There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1803file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1804
1805
1806
1807.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1808.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1809.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1810.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1811.cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1812Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1813independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1814&_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1815&_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1816therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1817building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1818&_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1819
1820There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1821without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1822(CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1823(BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1824maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1825a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1826
1827There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1828at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1829machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1830directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1831you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1832detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1833be logged.
1834
1835.cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1836Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1837access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1838facilities, you need to set
1839.code
1840WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1841.endd
1842in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1843chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1844
1845
1846.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1847.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1848If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1849required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1850your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1851happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1852&_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1853
1854This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1855operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1856to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1857configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1858defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1859do this.
1860
1861
1862
1863.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1864.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1865.cindex "RFC 2047"
1866The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1867described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1868in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1869character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1870mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1871(default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1872supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1873
1874However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1875very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1876&url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1877systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1878&[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1879.code
1880HAVE_ICONV=yes
1881.endd
1882to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1883
1884
1885
1886.section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1887.cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1888.cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1889.cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1890.cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1891.cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1892Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1893command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1894start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1895&%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1896line option).
1897
1898If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1899OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1900implementing SSL.
1901
1902If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1903.code
1904SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1905TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1906.endd
1907in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1908OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1909.code
1910SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1911TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1912TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1913.endd
1914.cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1915If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1916.code
1917SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1918USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1919.endd
1920.cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1921If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1922.code
1923SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1924USE_GNUTLS=yes
1925TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1926.endd
1927in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1928library and include files. For example:
1929.code
1930SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1931USE_GNUTLS=yes
1932TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1933TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1934.endd
1935.cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1936If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1937.code
1938SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1939USE_GNUTLS=yes
1940USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1941.endd
1942
1943You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1944specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1945given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1946
1947
1948
1949
1950.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1951
1952.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1953.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1954.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1955.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1956Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1957SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1958alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1959already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1960should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1961&_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1962&_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1963EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1964you might have
1965.code
1966USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1967CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1968EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1969.endd
1970in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1971files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1972.code
1973exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1974.endd
1975in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1976the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1977All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1978can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1979&_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1980configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1981further details.
1982
1983
1984.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1985.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1986Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1987&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1988it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1989where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1990library files.
1991
1992Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1993defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1994currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1995as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1996over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1997Exim used to
1998have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
1999withdrawn.
2000
2001
2002
2003.section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2004.cindex "lookup modules"
2005.cindex "dynamic modules"
2006.cindex ".so building"
2007On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2008the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2009on demand.
2010This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2011library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2012dependencies.
2013Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2014
2015Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2016installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2017measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2018for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2019Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2020see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2021
2022Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2023&`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2024For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2025on demand:
2026.code
2027LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
2028LOOKUP_SQLITE=2
2029LOOKUP_MYSQL=2
2030.endd
2031
2032
2033.section "The building process" "SECID29"
2034.cindex "build directory"
2035Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2036created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2037operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2038For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2039&_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2040.cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2041Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2042
2043If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2044a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2045&_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2046&'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2047then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2048number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2049makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2050directory, should this ever be necessary.
2051
2052If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2053&_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2054FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2055
2056
2057
2058.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2059The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2060unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2061output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2062appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2063each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2064get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2065.code
2066FULLECHO='' make -e
2067.endd
2068The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2069command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2070given in addition to the short output.
2071
2072
2073
2074.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2075.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2076The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2077consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2078values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2079more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2080convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2081order:
2082.display
2083&_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2084&_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2085&_Local/Makefile_&
2086&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2087&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2088&_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2089&_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2090.endd
2091.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2092.cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2093.cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2094where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2095architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2096process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2097and are often not needed.
2098
2099The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2100called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2101the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2102values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2103Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2104fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2105of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2106that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2107to find out what values are being used on your system.
2108
2109
2110&_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2111therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2112needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2113file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2114default values are.
2115
2116
2117.cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2118If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2119or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2120need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2121putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2122.cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2123when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2124formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2125compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2126called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2127Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2128default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2129containing the lines
2130.code
2131CC=cc
2132CFLAGS=-std1
2133.endd
2134If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2135these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2136
2137Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2138files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2139the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2140
2141
2142.cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2143.cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2144.cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2145.cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2146Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2147lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2148not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2149and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2150which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2151case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2152.code
2153LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2154LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2155LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2156.endd
2157and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2158&_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2159libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2160.cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2161However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2162the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2163files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2164binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2165errors.
2166
2167.cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2168.cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2169Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2170about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2171being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2172makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2173variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2174name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2175&'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2176with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2177syntax. For instance:
2178.code
2179LOOKUP_SQLITE=yes
2180LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2181AUTH_GSASL=yes
2182AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2183AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2184AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2185.endd
2186
2187.cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2188Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2189subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2190.code
2191EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2192.endd
2193must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2194chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2195
2196.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2197The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2198operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2199with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2200monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2201The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2202.code
2203X11=/usr/X11R6
2204XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2205XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2206.endd
2207These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2208example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2209.code
2210X11=/usr/openwin
2211XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2212XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2213.endd
2214If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2215definition of all three of these variables into your
2216&_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2217
2218.cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2219If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2220variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2221default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2222command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2223
2224.cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2225There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2226use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2227EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2228binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2229libraries.
2230
2231.cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2232The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2233files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2234necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2235&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2236
2237
2238.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2239.cindex "&_os.h_&"
2240.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2241The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2242&_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2243normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2244recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2245are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2246
2247
2248
2249.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2250.cindex "building Eximon"
2251A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2252where the files that are involved are
2253.display
2254&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2255&_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2256&_Local/eximon.conf_&
2257&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2258&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2259&_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2260.endd
2261.cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2262As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2263&_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2264&_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2265variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2266EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2267LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2268.ecindex IIDbuex
2269
2270
2271.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2272.cindex "installing Exim"
2273.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2274The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2275arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2276whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2277.cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2278The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2279going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2280&'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2281install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2282some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2283it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2284chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2285
2286.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2287Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2288in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2289exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2290by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2291is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2292alternative files, no default is installed.
2293
2294.cindex "system aliases file"
2295.cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2296One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2297default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2298The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2299SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2300If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2301and outputs a comment to the user.
2302
2303The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2304aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2305kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2306&_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2307Exim's configuration if necessary.
2308
2309The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2310and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2311running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2312directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2313other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2314over SMTP.
2315
2316It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2317distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2318command such as
2319.code
2320make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2321.endd
2322This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2323paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2324configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2325For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2326but this usage is deprecated.
2327
2328.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2329Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2330&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2331upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2332directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2333INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2334
2335For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2336to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2337installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2338for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2339called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2340of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2341from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2342
2343.cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2344If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2345real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2346command:
2347.code
2348make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2349.endd
2350The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2351script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2352the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2353directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2354command:
2355.code
2356(cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2357.endd
2358.cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2359There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2360
2361.ilist
2362&%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2363to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2364.next
2365&%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2366installed binary.
2367.endlist
2368
2369INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2370.code
2371make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2372.endd
2373The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2374to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2375without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2376.code
2377make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2378.endd
2379
2380
2381
2382.section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2383.cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2384Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2385reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2386distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2387&<<SECTavail>>&).
2388
2389If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2390source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2391install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2392
2393
2394
2395.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2396.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2397When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2398exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2399directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2400necessary.
2401
2402
2403
2404
2405.section "Testing" "SECID34"
2406.cindex "testing" "installation"
2407Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2408syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2409Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2410.code
2411exim -bV
2412.endd
2413If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2414Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2415the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2416other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2417Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2418example,
2419.display
2420&`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2421.endd
2422should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2423.display
2424&`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2425.endd
2426a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2427This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2428user agent. For example:
2429.code
2430exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2431From: user@your.domain.example
2432To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2433Subject: Testing Exim
2434
2435This is a test message.
2436^D
2437.endd
2438The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2439In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2440arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2441
2442.cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2443If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2444&'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2445of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2446&%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2447with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2448.display
2449&`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2450.endd
2451You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2452produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2453For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2454relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2455&<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2456
2457.cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2458.cindex "lock files"
2459One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2460local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2461&"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2462writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2463is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2464directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2465that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2466&(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2467approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2468&[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2469agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2470see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2471
2472One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2473the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2474&%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2475port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2476&'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2477incoming SMTP mail.
2478
2479Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2480be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2481within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2482that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2483production version.
2484
2485
2486.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2487.cindex "replacing another MTA"
2488Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2489general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2490is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2491operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2492binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2493normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2494or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2495.cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2496a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2497privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2498and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2499
2500.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2501.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2502Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2503example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2504&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2505described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2506as follows:
2507.code
2508sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2509send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2510mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2511newaliases /usr/bin/true
2512.endd
2513Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2514your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2515favourite user agent.
2516
2517You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2518have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2519various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2520command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2521use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2522&'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2523
2524
2525
2526.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2527.cindex "upgrading Exim"
2528If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2529version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2530call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2531to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2532new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2533version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2534configuration file.
2535
2536
2537
2538
2539.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2540.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2541The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2542.code
2543/etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2544.endd
2545If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2546fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2547for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2548(that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2549solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2550.code
2551pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2552.endd
2553to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2554
2555Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2556still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2557(the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2558
2559
2560
2561
2562. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2563. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2564
2565.chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2566.scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2567.scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2568Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2569each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2570options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2571some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2572combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2573The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2574
2575
2576.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2577.cindex "&'mailq'&"
2578If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2579were present before any other options.
2580The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2581standard output.
2582This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2583that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2584&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2585
2586.cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2587If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2588were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2589&%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2590format.
2591
2592.cindex "&'rmail'&"
2593If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2594&%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2595Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2596
2597.cindex "&'runq'&"
2598.cindex "queue runner"
2599If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2600were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2601option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2602
2603.cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2604.cindex "alias file" "building"
2605.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2606If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2607&%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2608This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2609the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2610command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2611
2612
2613.section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2614Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2615available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2616user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2617EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2618&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2619
2620.ilist
2621.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2622.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2623The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2624&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2625supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2626configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2627
2628.cindex '&"From"& line'
2629.cindex "envelope sender"
2630Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2631&"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2632Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2633See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2634users to set envelope senders.
2635
2636.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2637.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2638.cindex "header lines" "From:"
2639.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2640For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2641header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2642&'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2643
2644Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2645protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2646locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2647have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2648users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2649that are available to trusted users.
2650.next
2651.cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2652.cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2653The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2654Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2655The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2656
2657Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2658operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2659necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2660the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2661
2662By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2663Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2664However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2665option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2666
2667Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2668is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2669false.
2670.endlist
2671
2672
2673&*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2674edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2675getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2676&<<CHAPconf>>&.
2677
2678
2679
2680
2681.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2682Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2683of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2684a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2685format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2686on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2687with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2688outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2689
2690. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2691. Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2692. options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2693. creates a man page for the options.
2694. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2695
2696.literal xml
2697<!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2698.literal off
2699
2700
2701.vlist
2702.vitem &%--%&
2703.oindex "--"
2704.cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2705This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2706therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2707rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2708
2709.vitem &%--help%&
2710.oindex "&%--help%&"
2711This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2712The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2713no arguments.
2714
2715.vitem &%--version%&
2716.oindex "&%--version%&"
2717This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2718displayed.
2719
2720.vitem &%-Ac%& &&&
2721 &%-Am%&
2722.oindex "&%-Ac%&"
2723.oindex "&%-Am%&"
2724These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2725ignored by Exim.
2726
2727.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2728.oindex "&%-B%&"
2729.cindex "8-bit characters"
2730.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2731This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2732clean; it ignores this option.
2733
2734.vitem &%-bd%&
2735.oindex "&%-bd%&"
2736.cindex "daemon"
2737.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2738.cindex "queue runner"
2739This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2740the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2741that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2742
2743The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2744(debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2745disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2746stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2747
2748By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2749all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2750ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2751&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2752
2753When a listening daemon
2754.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2755.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2756is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2757configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2758in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2759PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2760running as root.
2761
2762When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2763process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2764used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2765
2766The SIGHUP signal
2767.cindex "SIGHUP"
2768.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2769can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2770whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2771means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2772of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2773referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2774because these are reread each time they are used.
2775
2776.vitem &%-bdf%&
2777.oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2778This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2779from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2780
2781.vitem &%-be%&
2782.oindex "&%-be%&"
2783.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2784.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2785Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2786prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2787files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2788of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2789
2790If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2791to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2792used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2793function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2794test data. A line history is supported.
2795
2796Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2797continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2798continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2799string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2800configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2801message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2802is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2803
2804&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2805files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2806the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2807of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2808
2809Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2810defined and macros will be expanded.
2811Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2812available to admin users.
2813
2814.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2815.oindex "&%-bem%&"
2816.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2817.cindex "expansion" "testing"
2818This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2819of a file. For example:
2820.code
2821exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2822.endd
2823The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2824message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2825variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2826no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2827recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2828&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2829line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2830&%-be%&).
2831
2832.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2833.oindex "&%-bF%&"
2834.cindex "system filter" "testing"
2835.cindex "testing" "system filter"
2836This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2837tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2838system filters are recognized.
2839
2840.vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2841.oindex "&%-bf%&"
2842.cindex "filter" "testing"
2843.cindex "testing" "filter file"
2844.cindex "forward file" "testing"
2845.cindex "testing" "forward file"
2846.cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2847This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2848to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2849there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2850supplied.
2851
2852If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2853can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2854filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2855.code
2856exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2857.endd
2858This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2859variables that are used by the user filter.
2860
2861If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2862.code
2863# Exim filter
2864# Sieve filter
2865.endd
2866it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2867that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2868&<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2869redirection lists.
2870
2871The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2872detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2873with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2874separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2875
2876When testing a filter file,
2877.cindex "&""From""& line"
2878.cindex "envelope sender"
2879.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2880the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2881or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2882that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2883can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2884options).
2885
2886.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2887.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2888.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2889This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2890tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2891&$qualify_domain$&.
2892
2893.vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2894.oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2895This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2896tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2897process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2898suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2899actually being delivered.
2900
2901.vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2902.oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2903.cindex affix "filter testing"
2904This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2905file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2906prefix.
2907
2908.vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2909.oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2910.cindex affix "filter testing"
2911This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2912file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2913suffix.
2914
2915.vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2916.oindex "&%-bh%&"
2917.cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2918.cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2919.cindex "testing" "relay control"
2920.cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2921.cindex "policy control" "testing"
2922.cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2923This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2924standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2925after a full stop. For example:
2926.code
2927exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2928exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2929.endd
2930When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2931of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2932conversion to the canonical form is
2933&`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2934
2935Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2936include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2937This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2938messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2939test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2940
2941&*Warning 1*&:
2942.cindex "RFC 1413"
2943You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2944information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2945an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2946connection.
2947
2948&*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2949are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2950occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2951
2952Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2953written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2954lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2955can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2956and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2957session were authenticated.
2958
2959The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2960output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2961acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2962
2963Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2964plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2965specialized SMTP test program such as
2966&url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2967
2968.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2969.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2970This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2971verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2972updating the callout cache database.
2973
2974.vitem &%-bi%&
2975.oindex "&%-bi%&"
2976.cindex "alias file" "building"
2977.cindex "building alias file"
2978.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2979Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2980Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2981this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2982tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2983recognized.
2984
2985If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2986configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2987the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2988The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2989use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2990if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2991&%-bi%& is a no-op.
2992
2993. // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2994.vitem &%-bI:help%&
2995.oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2996.cindex "querying exim information"
2997We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2998information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2999consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3000synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3001options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3002
3003.vitem &%-bI:dscp%&
3004.oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3005.cindex "DSCP" "values"
3006This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3007recognised DSCP names.
3008
3009.vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3010.oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3011.cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3012This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3013Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3014useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3015&`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3016compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3017way to guarantee a correct response.
3018
3019.vitem &%-bm%&
3020.oindex "&%-bm%&"
3021.cindex "local message reception"
3022This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3023locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3024command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3025argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3026default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3027if no other conflicting option is present.
3028
3029If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3030qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3031options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3032suppressing this for special cases.
3033
3034Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3035the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3036
3037.cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3038The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3039action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3040
3041The format
3042.cindex "message" "format"
3043.cindex "format" "message"
3044.cindex "&""From""& line"
3045.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3046.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3047of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3048compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3049.code
3050From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3051From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3052.endd
3053(with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3054is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3055authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3056matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3057option, which can be changed if necessary.
3058
3059.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3060The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3061&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3062preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3063trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3064
3065.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3066.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3067.cindex "testing", "malware"
3068.cindex "malware scan test"
3069This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3070(depending on the used scanner interface),
3071using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3072this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3073the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3074not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3075will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3076
3077Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3078using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3079user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3080This option requires admin privileges.
3081
3082The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3083there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3084administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3085
3086.vitem &%-bnq%&
3087.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
3088.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3089By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3090without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3091is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3092envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3093&%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3094defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3095
3096Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3097being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3098content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3099header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3100syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3101
3102The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3103messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3104addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3105unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3106
3107
3108.vitem &%-bP%&
3109.oindex "&%-bP%&"
3110.cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3111.cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3112If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3113main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3114of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3115arguments, for example:
3116.code
3117exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3118.endd
3119.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3120.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3121.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3122However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3123configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3124users, the output is as in this example:
3125.code
3126mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3127.endd
3128If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3129output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3130
3131If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3132configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3133backward compatibility.)
3134If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3135is the name of the file that was actually used.
3136
3137.cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3138If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3139name will not be output.
3140
3141.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3142.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3143If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3144directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3145respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3146sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3147written directly into the spool directory.
3148
3149If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3150.code
3151exim -bP +local_domains
3152.endd
3153it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3154local part) and outputs what it finds.
3155
3156.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3157.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3158.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3159If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3160followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3161that driver are output. For example:
3162.code
3163exim -bP transport local_delivery
3164.endd
3165The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3166options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3167using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3168&%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3169settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3170&%authenticators%&.
3171
3172.cindex "environment"
3173If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3174variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3175variables.
3176
3177.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3178If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3179are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3180for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3181The output format is one item per line.
3182For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3183the exit status will be nonzero.
3184
3185.vitem &%-bp%&
3186.oindex "&%-bp%&"
3187.cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3188.cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3189This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3190standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3191just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3192admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3193to allow any user to see the queue.
3194
3195Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3196.code
319725m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3198 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3199 <other addresses>
3200.endd
3201.cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3202.cindex "size" "of message"
3203The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3204(in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3205identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3206envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3207&"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3208the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3209before the sender address.
3210
3211.cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3212If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3213&"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3214
3215The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3216displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3217been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3218expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3219displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3220complete.
3221
3222
3223.vitem &%-bpa%&
3224.oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3225This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3226that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3227alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3228of just &"D"&.
3229
3230
3231.vitem &%-bpc%&
3232.oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3233.cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3234This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3235to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3236&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3237
3238
3239.vitem &%-bpr%&
3240.oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3241This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3242chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3243lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3244going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3245
3246.vitem &%-bpra%&
3247.oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3248This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3249
3250.vitem &%-bpru%&
3251.oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3252This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3253
3254
3255.vitem &%-bpu%&
3256.oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3257This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3258addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3259forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3260router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3261
3262
3263.vitem &%-brt%&
3264.oindex "&%-brt%&"
3265.cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3266.cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3267This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3268arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3269and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3270.code
3271exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3272Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3273.endd
3274See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3275argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3276&'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3277contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3278retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3279with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3280rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3281sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3282used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3283.code
3284exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3285Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3286.endd
3287
3288.vitem &%-brw%&
3289.oindex "&%-brw%&"
3290.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3291.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3292This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3293a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3294complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3295would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3296&<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3297
3298.vitem &%-bS%&
3299.oindex "&%-bS%&"
3300.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3301.cindex "batched SMTP input"
3302This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3303for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3304submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3305input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3306input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3307&%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3308believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3309
3310The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3311dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3312provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3313
3314As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3315messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3316Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3317&%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3318
3319Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3320as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3321QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3322
3323.cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3324If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3325error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3326was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3327was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3328
3329More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3330&<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3331
3332.vitem &%-bs%&
3333.oindex "&%-bs%&"
3334.cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3335.cindex "local SMTP input"
3336This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3337on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3338policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3339Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3340messages to the MTA.
3341
3342In
3343.cindex "sender" "source of"
3344this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3345set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3346Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3347the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3348&%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3349&%-bnq%& option is used.
3350
3351.cindex "inetd"
3352The
3353&%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3354using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3355whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3356&'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3357above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3358Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3359the listening daemon.
3360
3361.vitem &%-bt%&
3362.oindex "&%-bt%&"
3363.cindex "testing" "addresses"
3364.cindex "address" "testing"
3365This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3366as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3367written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3368user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3369sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3370
3371If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3372right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3373
3374Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3375&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3376security issues.
3377
3378Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3379(compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3380written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3381&%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3382genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3383program.
3384
3385.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3386The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3387failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3388code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3389
3390.cindex "duplicate addresses"
3391&*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3392addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3393This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3394always shown.
3395
3396&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3397routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3398message,
3399.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3400you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3401&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3402default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3403whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3404those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3405doing such tests.
3406
3407.vitem &%-bV%&
3408.oindex "&%-bV%&"
3409.cindex "version number of Exim"
3410This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3411number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3412It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3413specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3414name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3415
3416As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3417configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3418values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3419detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3420alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3421realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3422dynamic testing facilities.
3423
3424.vitem &%-bv%&
3425.oindex "&%-bv%&"
3426.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3427.cindex "address" "verification"
3428This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3429taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3430not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3431happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3432(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3433including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3434
3435If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3436failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3437usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3438
3439If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3440right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3441
3442Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3443&[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3444security issues.
3445
3446Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3447that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3448router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3449verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3450address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3451
3452If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3453address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3454latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3455causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3456addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3457and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3458to succeed.
3459
3460When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3461and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3462considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3463
3464The
3465.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3466return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3467failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3468code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3469
3470If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3471address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3472sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3473calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3474
3475.vitem &%-bvs%&
3476.oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3477This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3478than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3479might happen.
3480
3481.vitem &%-bw%&
3482.oindex "&%-bw%&"
3483.cindex "daemon"
3484.cindex "inetd"
3485.cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3486This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3487similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3488and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3489
3490In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3491listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3492inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3493each port only when the first connection is received.
3494
3495If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3496which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3497
3498.vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3499.oindex "&%-C%&"
3500.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3501.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3502.cindex "alternate configuration file"
3503This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3504list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3505compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3506but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3507file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3508proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3509
3510When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3511from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3512runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3513However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3514file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3515which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3516listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3517CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3518not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3519
3520Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3521configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3522even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3523running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3524delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3525test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3526in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3527
3528If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3529prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3530must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3531However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3532CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3533usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3534unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3535
3536ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3537to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3538broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3539configuration file.
3540
3541The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3542syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3543caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3544require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3545specified by this option.
3546
3547
3548.vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3549.oindex "&%-D%&"
3550.cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3551This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3552(see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3553unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3554If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3555completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3556
3557If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3558colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3559supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3560not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3561the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3562to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3563regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3564
3565The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3566command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3567string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3568synonymous:
3569.code
3570exim -DABC ...
3571exim -DABC= ...
3572.endd
3573To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3574quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3575example:
3576.code
3577exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3578.endd
3579&%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3580Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3581
3582
3583.vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3584.oindex "&%-d%&"
3585.cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3586.cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3587This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3588error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3589database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3590filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3591writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3592return code.
3593
3594When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3595standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3596some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3597made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3598of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3599debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3600no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3601are:
3602.display
3603&`acl `& ACL interpretation
3604&`auth `& authenticators
3605&`deliver `& general delivery logic
3606&`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3607&`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3608&`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3609&`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3610&`filter `& filter handling
3611&`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3612&`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3613&`ident `& ident lookup
3614&`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3615&`lists `& matching things in lists
3616&`load `& system load checks
3617&`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3618 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3619&`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3620&`memory `& memory handling
3621&`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3622&`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3623&`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3624&`queue_run `& queue runs
3625&`receive `& general message reception logic
3626&`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3627&`retry `& retry handling
3628&`rewrite `& address rewriting
3629&`route `& address routing
3630&`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3631&`tls `& TLS logic
3632&`transport `& transports
3633&`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3634&`verify `& address verification logic
3635&`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3636.endd
3637The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3638for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3639tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3640is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3641generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3642turn everything off.
3643
3644.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3645.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3646The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3647with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3648unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3649rather than stderr.
3650
3651The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3652&`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3653However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3654daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3655automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3656run in parallel.
3657
3658The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3659of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3660in processing.
3661
3662.cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3663.cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3664The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3665UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3666When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3667Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3668
3669If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3670any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3671
3672.vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3673.oindex "&%-dd%&"
3674This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3675starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3676subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3677behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3678
3679.vitem &%-dropcr%&
3680.oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3681This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3682handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3683described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3684
3685.vitem &%-E%&
3686.oindex "&%-E%&"
3687.cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3688This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3689failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3690and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3691generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3692could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3693follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3694new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3695
3696.vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3697.oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3698There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3699called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3700example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3701form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3702
3703.vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3704.oindex "&%-F%&"
3705.cindex "sender" "name"
3706.cindex "name" "of sender"
3707This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3708message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3709entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3710their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3711between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3712
3713.vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3714.oindex "&%-f%&"
3715.cindex "sender" "address"
3716.cindex "address" "sender"
3717.cindex "trusted users"
3718.cindex "envelope sender"
3719.cindex "user" "trusted"
3720This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3721message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3722by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3723users to use it.
3724
3725Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3726trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3727options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3728of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3729domain.
3730
3731There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3732can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3733never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3734string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3735examples of shell commands:
3736.code
3737exim -f '<>' user@domain
3738exim -f "" user@domain
3739.endd
3740In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3741with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3742&%-bv%& options.
3743
3744Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3745it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3746refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3747though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3748
3749White
3750.cindex "&""From""& line"
3751space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3752given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3753locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3754&"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3755if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3756
3757.vitem &%-G%&
3758.oindex "&%-G%&"
3759.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3760This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3761.code
3762control = suppress_local_fixups
3763.endd
3764for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3765bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3766in future.
3767
3768As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3769this option.
3770
3771.vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3772.oindex "&%-h%&"
3773.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3774This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3775Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3776headers.)
3777
3778.vitem &%-i%&
3779.oindex "&%-i%&"
3780.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3781.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3782This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3783line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3784no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3785command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3786
3787.vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3788.oindex "&%-L%&"
3789.cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3790This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3791file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3792Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3793read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3794effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3795
3796The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3797
3798.vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3799.oindex "&%-M%&"
3800.cindex "forcing delivery"
3801.cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3802.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3803This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3804any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3805delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3806and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3807
3808Retry
3809.cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3810hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3811the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3812to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3813which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3814for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3815
3816The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3817not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3818produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3819use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3820
3821.vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3822.oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3823.cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3824.cindex "recipient" "adding"
3825This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3826message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3827id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3828active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3829can be used only by an admin user.
3830
3831.vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3832 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3833.oindex "&%-MC%&"
3834.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3835.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3836.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3837This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3838by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3839an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3840given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3841must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3842
3843.vitem &%-MCA%&
3844.oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3845This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3846by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3847connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3848
3849.vitem &%-MCD%&
3850.oindex "&%-MCD%&"
3851This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3852by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3853remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3854
3855.vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3856.oindex "&%-MCG%&"
3857This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3858by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3859alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3860
3861.vitem &%-MCK%&
3862.oindex "&%-MCK%&"
3863This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3864by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3865remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3866
3867.vitem &%-MCP%&
3868.oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3869This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3870by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3871which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3872
3873.vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3874.oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3875This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3876by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3877started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3878together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3879signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3880messages through the same SMTP connection.
3881
3882.vitem &%-MCS%&
3883.oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3884This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3885by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3886SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3887connection.
3888
3889.vitem &%-MCT%&
3890.oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3891This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3892by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3893host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3894
3895.vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3896.oindex "&%-MCt%&"
3897This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3898by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3899connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3900The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3901
3902.vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3903.oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3904.cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3905.cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3906This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3907but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3908that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3909provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3910order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3911However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3912respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3913overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3914If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3915&%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3916and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3917
3918.vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3919.oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3920.cindex "message" "changing sender"
3921.cindex "sender" "changing"
3922This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3923given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3924&"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3925be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3926is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3927This option can be used only by an admin user.
3928
3929.vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3930.oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3931.cindex "freezing messages"
3932.cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3933This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3934prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3935either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3936However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3937attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3938user.
3939
3940.vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3941.oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3942.cindex "giving up on messages"
3943.cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3944.cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3945This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3946including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3947their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3948is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3949Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3950user.
3951
3952.vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3953.oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3954.cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3955This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3956as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3957message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3958altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3959
3960.vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3961.oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3962.cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3963.cindex "recipient" "removing"
3964.cindex "removing recipients"
3965This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3966(&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3967the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3968addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3969(in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3970can be used only by an admin user.
3971
3972.vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3973.oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3974.cindex "removing messages"
3975.cindex "abandoning mail"
3976.cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3977This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3978bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3979the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3980only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3981placed in the queue.
3982
3983. .new
3984. .vitem &%-MS%&
3985. .oindex "&%-MS%&"
3986. .cindex REQUIRETLS
3987. This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
3988. It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
3989. a bounce message.
3990. .wen
3991
3992.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3993.oindex "&%-Mset%&"
3994.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3995.cindex "expansion" "testing"
3996This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3997string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3998the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3999&$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4000available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4001make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4002user. See also &%-bem%&.
4003
4004.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4005.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
4006.cindex "thawing messages"
4007.cindex "unfreezing messages"
4008.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4009.cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4010This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4011&"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4012messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4013by an admin user.
4014
4015.vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4016.oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
4017.cindex "listing" "message body"
4018.cindex "message" "listing body of"
4019This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4020written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4021
4022.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4023.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
4024.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4025.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4026This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4027be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4028only by an admin user.
4029
4030.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4031.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
4032.cindex "listing" "message headers"
4033.cindex "header lines" "listing"
4034.cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4035This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4036written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4037
4038.vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4039.oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
4040.cindex "listing" "message log"
4041.cindex "message" "listing message log"
4042This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4043the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4044
4045.vitem &%-m%&
4046.oindex "&%-m%&"
4047This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4048treats it that way too.
4049
4050.vitem &%-N%&
4051.oindex "&%-N%&"
4052.cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4053.cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4054This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4055level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4056it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4057had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4058database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4059than &"=>"&.
4060
4061Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4062user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4063words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4064which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4065address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4066routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4067the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4068for that message.
4069
4070.vitem &%-n%&
4071.oindex "&%-n%&"
4072This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4073For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4074When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4075option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4076
4077.vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4078.oindex "&%-O%&"
4079This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4080Exim.
4081
4082.vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4083.oindex "&%-oA%&"
4084.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4085This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4086alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4087description above.
4088
4089.vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4090.oindex "&%-oB%&"
4091.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4092.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4093.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4094This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4095be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4096transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4097
4098.vitem &%-odb%&
4099.oindex "&%-odb%&"
4100.cindex "background delivery"
4101.cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4102This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4103including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4104messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4105delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4106processes to finish.
4107
4108When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4109leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4110and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4111This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4112
4113If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4114(&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4115overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4116setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4117
4118.vitem &%-odf%&
4119.oindex "&%-odf%&"
4120.cindex "foreground delivery"
4121.cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4122This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4123accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4124&%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4125and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4126
4127The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4128process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4129during deliveries.
4130
4131However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4132false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4133
4134If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4135message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4136process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4137restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4138
4139
4140.vitem &%-odi%&
4141.oindex "&%-odi%&"
4142This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4143Sendmail.
4144
4145.vitem &%-odq%&
4146.oindex "&%-odq%&"
4147.cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4148.cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4149.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4150This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4151including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4152not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4153are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4154process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4155&%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4156conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4157forces queueing.
4158
4159.vitem &%-odqs%&
4160.oindex "&%-odqs%&"
4161.cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4162This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4163However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4164&%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4165configuration file is in effect.
4166
4167When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4168message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4169also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4170in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4171done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4172runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4173messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4174host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4175configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4176&%-qq%& option.
4177
4178.vitem &%-oee%&
4179.oindex "&%-oee%&"
4180.cindex "error" "reporting"
4181If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4182example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4183message.
4184
4185.cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4186Provided
4187this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4188exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4189is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4190This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4191
4192.vitem &%-oem%&
4193.oindex "&%-oem%&"
4194.cindex "error" "reporting"
4195.cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4196This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4197return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4198This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4199
4200.vitem &%-oep%&
4201.oindex "&%-oep%&"
4202.cindex "error" "reporting"
4203If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4204error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4205.cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4206The return code is 1 for all errors.
4207
4208.vitem &%-oeq%&
4209.oindex "&%-oeq%&"
4210.cindex "error" "reporting"
4211This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4212effect as &%-oep%&.
4213
4214.vitem &%-oew%&
4215.oindex "&%-oew%&"
4216.cindex "error" "reporting"
4217This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4218effect as &%-oem%&.
4219
4220.vitem &%-oi%&
4221.oindex "&%-oi%&"
4222.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4223This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4224line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4225single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4226lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4227&'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4228
4229.vitem &%-oitrue%&
4230.oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4231This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4232
4233.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4234.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
4235.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4236A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4237with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4238over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4239&%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4240other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4241
4242The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4243number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4244.code
4245exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4246.endd
4247An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4248followed by a colon and the port number:
4249.code
4250exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4251.endd
4252The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4253port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4254are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4255whichever one is last.
4256
4257.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4258.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
4259.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4260See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4261option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4262name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4263This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4264authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4265
4266.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4267.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
4268.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4269See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4270option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4271This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4272where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4273&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4274
4275.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4276.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
4277.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4278See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4279option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4280overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4281messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4282default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4283specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4284&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4285
4286.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4287.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4288.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4289See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4290option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4291using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4292&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4293
4294.vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4295.oindex "&%-oMm%&"
4296.cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4297See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4298option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4299delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4300messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4301abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4302running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4303
4304The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4305The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4306is sending the bounce.
4307
4308.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4309.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4310.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4311.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4312See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4313option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4314&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4315or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4316SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4317&<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4318one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4319be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4320
4321.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4322.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4323.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4324See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4325option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4326present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4327uses the name it is given.
4328
4329.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4330.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4331.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4332See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4333option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4334local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4335used, when there is no default.
4336
4337.vitem &%-om%&
4338.oindex "&%-om%&"
4339.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4340In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4341message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4342expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4343
4344.vitem &%-oo%&
4345.oindex "&%-oo%&"
4346.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4347This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4348whatever that means.
4349
4350.vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4351.oindex "&%-oP%&"
4352.cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4353.cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4354This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4355value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4356written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4357without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4358because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4359
4360.vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4361.oindex "&%-or%&"
4362.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4363This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4364set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4365by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4366described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4367
4368.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4369.oindex "&%-os%&"
4370.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4371.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4372This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4373applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4374the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4375for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4376
4377.vitem &%-ov%&
4378.oindex "&%-ov%&"
4379This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4380
4381.vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4382.oindex "&%-oX%&"
4383.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4384.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4385.cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4386This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4387is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4388of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4389in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4390file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4391
4392.vitem &%-pd%&
4393.oindex "&%-pd%&"
4394.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4395This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4396chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4397option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4398needed.
4399
4400.vitem &%-ps%&
4401.oindex "&%-ps%&"
4402.cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4403This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4404chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4405option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4406started.
4407
4408.vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4409.oindex "&%-p%&"
4410For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4411.display
4412&`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4413.endd
4414It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4415host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4416Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4417to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4418or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4419Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4420
4421.vitem &%-q%&
4422.oindex "&%-q%&"
4423.cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4424This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4425configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4426relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4427and &%-S%& options).
4428
4429.cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4430If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4431the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4432waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4433for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4434process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4435have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4436
4437If
4438.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4439.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4440.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4441the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4442passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4443proceeding.
4444
4445When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4446process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4447mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4448this to be repeated periodically.
4449
4450Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4451random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4452If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4453MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4454
4455It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4456order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4457&%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4458
4459.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4460The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4461behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4462appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4463
4464.vitem &%-qq...%&
4465.oindex "&%-qq%&"
4466.cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4467.cindex "queue" "routing"
4468.cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4469An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4470stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4471every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4472transports are run.
4473
4474.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4475The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4476is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4477complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4478place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4479delivered down a single SMTP
4480.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4481.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4482.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4483connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4484This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4485intermittently.
4486
4487.vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4488.oindex "&%-qi%&"
4489.cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4490If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4491those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4492delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4493&%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4494
4495.vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4496.oindex "&%-qf%&"
4497.cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4498.cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4499If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4500message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4501their retry times are tried.
4502
4503.vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4504.oindex "&%-qff%&"
4505.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4506If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4507frozen or not.
4508
4509.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4510.oindex "&%-ql%&"
4511.cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4512The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4513be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4514for later delivery.
4515
4516.vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4517.oindex "&%-qG%&"
4518.cindex queue named
4519.cindex "named queues"
4520.cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4521If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4522queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4523The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4524For a periodic queue run (see below)
4525append to the name a slash and a time value.
4526
4527If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4528will specify a queue to operate on.
4529For example:
4530.code
4531exim -bp -qGquarantine
4532mailq -qGquarantine
4533exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4534.endd
4535
4536.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4537When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4538lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4539starting message id. For example:
4540.code
4541exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4542.endd
4543Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4544second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4545are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4546.code
4547exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4548.endd
4549just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4550&%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4551that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4552mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4553are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4554queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4555
4556.vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4557.cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4558.cindex "periodic queue running"
4559When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4560starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4561(whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4562&%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4563single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4564combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4565.code
4566/usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4567.endd
4568Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4569process every 30 minutes.
4570
4571When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4572pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4573
4574.vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4575.oindex "&%-qR%&"
4576This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4577compatibility.
4578
4579.vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4580.oindex "&%-qS%&"
4581This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4582
4583.vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4584.oindex "&%-R%&"
4585.cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4586.cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4587.cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4588The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4589is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4590which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4591<&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4592
4593This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4594perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4595queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4596address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4597way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4598regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4599
4600If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4601you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4602.code
4603exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4604.endd
4605This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4606every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4607applied to each queue run.
4608
4609Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4610are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4611information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4612means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4613existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4614address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4615will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4616information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4617address will be skipped.
4618
4619.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4620If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4621all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4622&'ff'& is present.
4623
4624The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4625to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4626command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4627effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4628an arbitrary command instead.
4629
4630.vitem &%-r%&
4631.oindex "&%-r%&"
4632This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4633
4634.vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4635.oindex "&%-S%&"
4636.cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4637.cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4638This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4639message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4640conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4641has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4642
4643.vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4644.oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4645This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4646recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4647&"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4648
4649.vitem &%-t%&
4650.oindex "&%-t%&"
4651.cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4652.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4653.cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4654.cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4655When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4656input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4657from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4658from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4659takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4660
4661.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4662If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4663is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4664the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4665and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4666Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4667Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4668argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4669Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4670instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4671&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4672
4673.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4674If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4675recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4676lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4677with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4678&%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4679
4680RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4681message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4682added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4683not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4684nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4685In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4686are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4687once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4688&%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4689
4690.vitem &%-ti%&
4691.oindex "&%-ti%&"
4692This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4693compatibility with Sendmail.
4694
4695.vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4696.oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4697.cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4698.cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4699This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4700incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4701&%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4702&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4703
4704
4705.vitem &%-U%&
4706.oindex "&%-U%&"
4707.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4708Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4709documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4710syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4711set. Exim ignores this option.
4712
4713.vitem &%-v%&
4714.oindex "&%-v%&"
4715This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4716describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4717receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4718dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4719the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4720selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4721unconditional.
4722
4723.vitem &%-x%&
4724.oindex "&%-x%&"
4725AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4726National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4727It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4728this option.
4729
4730.vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4731.oindex "&%-X%&"
4732This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4733to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4734
4735.vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4736.oindex "&%-z%&"
4737This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4738Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4739Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4740under most shells.
4741.endlist
4742
4743.ecindex IIDclo1
4744.ecindex IIDclo2
4745
4746
4747. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4748. Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4749. line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4750. creates a man page for the options.
4751. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4752
4753.literal xml
4754<!-- === End of command line options === -->
4755.literal off
4756
4757
4758
4759
4760
4761. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4762. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4763
4764
4765.chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4766 "The runtime configuration file"
4767
4768.cindex "runtime configuration"
4769.cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4770.cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4771.cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4772.cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4773.cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4774Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4775binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4776because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4777control.
4778
4779If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4780writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4781The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4782errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4783not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4784actually alter the string.
4785
4786The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4787reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4788most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4789give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4790existing file in the list.
4791
4792.cindex "EXIM_USER"
4793.cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4794.cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4795.cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4796.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4797.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4798The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4799specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4800configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4801group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4802CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4803
4804&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4805to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4806easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4807CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4808who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4809
4810Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4811be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4812since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4813compromise the Exim user account.
4814
4815A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4816is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4817defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4818configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4819CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4820&<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4821configuration.
4822
4823
4824
4825.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4826.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4827A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4828option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4829&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4830unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4831CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4832is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4833is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4834installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4835specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4836
4837Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4838with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4839listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4840testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4841delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4842Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4843the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4844can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4845message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4846&%-M%&).
4847
4848If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4849prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4850start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4851There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4852filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4853
4854One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4855option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4856configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4857non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4858If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4859completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4860
4861The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4862to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4863necessarily be discarded.
4864WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4865considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4866values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4867is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4868transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4869values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4870
4871Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4872share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4873If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4874looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4875and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4876file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4877each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4878
4879In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4880different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4881help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4882
4883
4884
4885.section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4886.cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4887.cindex "format" "configuration file"
4888Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4889option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4890are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4891is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4892space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4893
4894.ilist
4895&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4896&<<CHAPACL>>&).
4897.next
4898.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4899&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4900are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4901.next
4902&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4903addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4904&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4905.next
4906&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4907define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4908&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4909.next
4910&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4911If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4912defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4913are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4914&<<CHAPretry>>&.
4915.next
4916&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4917when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4918chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4919.next
4920&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4921want to use this feature, you must set
4922.code
4923LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4924.endd
4925in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4926facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4927.endlist
4928
4929.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4930.cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4931.cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4932Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4933
4934Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4935leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4936# character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4937and does not introduce a comment.
4938
4939Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4940the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4941backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4942lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4943appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4944
4945A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4946default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4947change settings as required.
4948
4949The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4950described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4951respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4952items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4953onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4954described.
4955
4956
4957
4958.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4959.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4960.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4961.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4962.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4963You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
4964using this syntax:
4965.display
4966&`.include`& <&'filename'&>
4967&`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
4968.endd
4969on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
4970the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4971second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4972The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4973the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
4974is required.
4975
4976Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4977configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4978If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4979because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4980
4981The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4982comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4983for example:
4984.code
4985hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4986 .include /some/file
4987.endd
4988Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4989process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4990inclusion appears.
4991
4992
4993
4994.section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4995.cindex "macro" "description of"
4996.cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4997If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4998&"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4999definition, and must be of the form
5000.display
5001<&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5002.endd
5003The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5004in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5005continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5006space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5007a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5008
5009Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5010definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5011ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5012
5013.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5014Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5015files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5016scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5017replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5018for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5019the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5020define
5021.display
5022&`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5023&`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5024.endd
5025but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5026error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5027before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5028consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5029line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5030comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5031
5032
5033.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5034Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5035(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5036&'='&. For example:
5037.code
5038MAC = initial value
5039...
5040MAC == updated value
5041.endd
5042Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5043subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5044the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5045Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5046.code
5047MAC = initial value
5048...
5049MAC == MAC and something added
5050.endd
5051This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5052from a number of other files.
5053
5054.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5055The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5056&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5057used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5058using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5059file to be ignored.
5060
5061
5062
5063.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5064As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5065up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5066strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5067.code
5068ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5069 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5070.endd
5071This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5072.code
5073data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5074.endd
5075In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5076address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5077section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5078
5079
5080.section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5081Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5082differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5083All of these macros start with an underscore.
5084They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5085(see below).
5086
5087The following classes of macros are defined:
5088.display
5089&` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5090&` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5091&` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5092&` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5093&` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5094&` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5095&` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5096&` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5097&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5098&` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5099&` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5100&` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5101.endd
5102
5103Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5104
5105
5106.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5107.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5108.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5109You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5110&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5111portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5112read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5113
5114The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5115be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5116that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5117line. Thus:
5118.code
5119.ifdef AAA
5120message_size_limit = 50M
5121.else
5122message_size_limit = 100M
5123.endif
5124.endd
5125sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5126(or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5127otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5128is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5129obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5130
5131Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5132it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5133in this line"& will always be true.
5134
5135Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5136to clarify complicated nestings.
5137
5138
5139
5140.section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5141.cindex "common option syntax"
5142.cindex "syntax of common options"
5143.cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5144For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5145each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5146lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5147these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5148space) and then the value. For example:
5149.code
5150qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5151.endd
5152.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5153.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5154.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5155Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5156accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5157line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5158word &"hide"&. For example:
5159.code
5160hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5161.endd
5162For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5163.code
5164mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5165.endd
5166If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5167all instances of the same driver.
5168
5169The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5170that are found in option settings.
5171
5172
5173.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5174.cindex "format" "boolean"
5175.cindex "boolean configuration values"
5176.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5177.oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5178Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5179different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5180the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5181if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5182boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5183&"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5184the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5185.code
5186queue_only
5187queue_only = true
5188.endd
5189The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5190.code
5191no_queue_only
5192queue_only = false
5193.endd
5194You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5195
5196
5197
5198
5199.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5200.cindex "integer configuration values"
5201.cindex "format" "integer"
5202If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5203hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5204number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5205with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5206hexadecimal number.
5207
5208If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5209it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5210if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5211When the values
5212of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
52131024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5214and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5215used.
5216
5217
5218.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5219.cindex "integer format"
5220.cindex "format" "octal integer"
5221If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5222interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5223Such options are always output in octal.
5224
5225
5226.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5227.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5228.cindex "format" "fixed point"
5229If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5230integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5231
5232
5233
5234.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5235.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5236.cindex "format" "time interval"
5237A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5238the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5239
5240.table2 30pt
5241.irow &%s%& seconds
5242.irow &%m%& minutes
5243.irow &%h%& hours
5244.irow &%d%& days
5245.irow &%w%& weeks
5246.endtable
5247
5248For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5249intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5250is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5251
5252
5253
5254.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5255.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5256.cindex "format" "string"
5257If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5258or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5259consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5260the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5261removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5262Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5263appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5264therefore equivalent:
5265.code
5266trusted_users = uucp:mail
5267trusted_users = uucp:\
5268 # This comment line is ignored
5269 mail
5270.endd
5271.cindex "string" "quoted"
5272.cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5273If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5274double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5275continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5276
5277.table2 100pt
5278.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5279.irow &`\n`& "newline"
5280.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5281.irow &`\t`& "tab"
5282.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5283.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5284 character"
5285.endtable
5286
5287If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5288character, that character replaces the pair.
5289
5290Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5291insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5292trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5293current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5294in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5295and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5296
5297
5298.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5299.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5300Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5301by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5302circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5303is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5304strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5305However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5306backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5307within a quoted configuration string.
5308
5309
5310.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5311.cindex "user name" "format of"
5312.cindex "format" "user name"
5313.cindex "groups" "name format"
5314.cindex "format" "group name"
5315User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5316above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5317either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5318&[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5319
5320
5321.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5322.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5323.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5324.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5325The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5326default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5327the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5328&"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5329are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5330particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5331&<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5332
5333In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5334input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5335&<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5336in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5337on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5338start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5339example, the list
5340.code
5341local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5342.endd
5343contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5344
5345&*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5346list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5347colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5348be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5349
5350.section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5351.cindex "list separator" "changing"
5352.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5353Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5354introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5355with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5356character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5357above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5358.code
5359local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5360.endd
5361This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5362&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5363confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5364
5365.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5366.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5367It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5368code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5369must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5370are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5371sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5372interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5373generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5374.code
5375domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5376.endd
5377This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5378to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5379expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5380the value in quotes. For example:
5381.code
5382local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5383.endd
5384Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5385doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5386set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5387enclosing an empty list item.
5388
5389
5390
5391.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5392.cindex "list" "empty item in"
5393An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5394separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5395.code
5396senders = user@domain :
5397.endd
5398contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5399in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5400items, the second of which is empty:
5401.code
5402senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5403.endd
5404&*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5405are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5406would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5407just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5408.code
5409senders = :
5410.endd
5411In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5412is at the end of the list.
5413
5414
5415
5416
5417.section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5418.cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5419There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5420and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5421instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5422a sequence of lines like this:
5423.display
5424<&'instance name'&>:
5425 <&'option'&>
5426 ...
5427 <&'option'&>
5428.endd
5429In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5430followed by three options settings:
5431.code
5432localuser:
5433 driver = accept
5434 check_local_user
5435 transport = local_delivery
5436.endd
5437For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5438setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5439settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5440deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5441a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5442described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5443
5444You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5445the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5446
5447The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5448passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5449transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5450authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5451them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5452server.
5453
5454.cindex "generic options"
5455.cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5456Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5457and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5458same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5459&%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5460.cindex "private options"
5461The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5462they all have default values.
5463
5464The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5465precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5466this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5467
5468Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5469elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5470with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5471a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5472instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5473confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5474configuration lines:
5475.code
5476remote_smtp:
5477 driver = smtp
5478.endd
5479create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5480&(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5481different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5482instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5483thus:
5484.code
5485special_smtp:
5486 driver = smtp
5487 port = 1234
5488 command_timeout = 10s
5489.endd
5490The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5491these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5492lines.
5493
5494Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5495list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5496defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5497option.
5498
5499
5500
5501
5502
5503
5504. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5505. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5506
5507.chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5508.scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5509.cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5510The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5511is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5512the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5513configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5514of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5515itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5516initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5517mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5518
5519
5520
5521.section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5522All macros should be defined before any options.
5523
5524One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5525.code
5526# ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5527.endd
5528If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5529hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5530later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5531deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5532
5533In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5534to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5535given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5536
5537
5538.section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5539The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5540in the file, after the macros.
5541The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5542.code
5543# primary_hostname =
5544.endd
5545This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5546to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5547can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5548it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5549
5550The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5551.code
5552domainlist local_domains = @
5553domainlist relay_to_domains =
5554hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5555.endd
5556These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5557domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5558domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5559configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5560
5561The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5562later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5563on the local host.
5564
5565.cindex "@ in a domain list"
5566There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5567of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5568called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5569be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5570the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5571
5572The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5573list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5574controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5575domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5576domain is permitted.
5577
5578The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5579used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5580that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5581loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5582submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5583hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5584
5585Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5586we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5587and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5588
5589The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5590.code
5591acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5592acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5593.endd
5594These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5595during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5596command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5597respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5598&'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5599section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5600accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5601to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5602contents of a message to be checked.
5603
5604Two commented-out option settings are next:
5605.code
5606# av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5607# spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5608.endd
5609These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5610content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5611scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5612details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5613
5614Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5615.code
5616# tls_advertise_hosts = *
5617# tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5618# tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5619.endd
5620These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5621support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5622first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5623connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5624other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5625key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5626More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5627
5628Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5629.code
5630# daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5631# tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5632.endd
5633.cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5634.cindex "port" "for message submission"
5635.cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5636.cindex "submissions protocol"
5637.cindex "smtps protocol"
5638.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5639.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5640.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5641.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5642These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5643server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5644TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5645more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5646Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5647to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5648much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5649consequences).
5650RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5651which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5652RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5653which should be used in preference to 587.
5654You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5655these ports.
5656Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5657
5658Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5659.code
5660# qualify_domain =
5661# qualify_recipient =
5662.endd
5663The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5664complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5665receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5666the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5667you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5668addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5669
5670.cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5671The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5672addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5673(an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5674.code
5675# allow_domain_literals
5676.endd
5677The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5678Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5679quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5680try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5681people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5682&'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5683
5684The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5685.code
5686never_users = root
5687.endd
5688It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5689convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5690setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5691The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5692list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5693FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5694contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5695FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5696
5697When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5698Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5699line,
5700.code
5701host_lookup = *
5702.endd
5703specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5704in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5705information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5706or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5707Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5708because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5709unreachable.
5710
5711The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
57121413 (hence their names):
5713.code
5714rfc1413_hosts = *
5715rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5716.endd
5717These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5718Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5719terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5720of an incoming SMTP connection.
5721If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5722information, you can change this.
5723
5724This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5725and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5726.code
5727prdr_enable = true
5728.endd
5729
5730When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5731be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5732if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5733find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5734.code
5735# sender_unqualified_hosts =
5736# recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5737.endd
5738show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5739and recipient addresses, respectively.
5740
5741The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5742over the default:
5743.code
5744log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5745 +tls_certificate_verified
5746.endd
5747
5748The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5749.code
5750# percent_hack_domains =
5751.endd
5752It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5753This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5754anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5755
5756The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5757concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5758message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5759occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5760address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5761bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5762are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5763always bounce messages.
5764.code
5765ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5766timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5767.endd
5768The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5769discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5770message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5771after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5772bounce message ever lasts a week.
5773
5774Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5775large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5776directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5777many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5778Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5779not often needed).
5780.code
5781# split_spool_directory = true
5782.endd
5783
5784In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5785messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5786characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5787violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5788In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5789problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5790check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5791.code
5792# check_rfc2047_length = false
5793.endd
5794
5795If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
57968BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5797that are not 8-bit clean.
5798.code
5799# accept_8bitmime = false
5800.endd
5801
5802Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5803imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5804&%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5805&%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5806Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5807option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5808.code
5809# keep_environment = ^LDAP
5810# add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5811.endd
5812
5813
5814.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5815.cindex "default" "ACLs"
5816.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5817In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5818It starts with the line
5819.code
5820begin acl
5821.endd
5822and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5823&'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5824and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5825
5826.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5827The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5828RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5829are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5830rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5831result of the ACL processing.
5832.code
5833acl_check_rcpt:
5834.endd
5835This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5836ACL, and names it.
5837.code
5838accept hosts = :
5839.endd
5840This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5841But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5842names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5843list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5844host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5845important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5846
5847What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5848messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5849input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5850manner.
5851.code
5852deny message = Restricted characters in address
5853 domains = +local_domains
5854 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5855
5856deny message = Restricted characters in address
5857 domains = !+local_domains
5858 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5859.endd
5860These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5861characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5862Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5863&"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5864in Internet mail addresses.
5865
5866The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5867addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5868option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5869in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5870programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5871at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5872characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5873policy of being as safe as possible.
5874
5875The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5876to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5877first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5878&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5879reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5880&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5881
5882The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5883block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5884or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5885have to modify this rule.
5886
5887Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5888allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5889common convention of local parts constructed as
5890&"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5891the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5892with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5893filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5894that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5895is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5896
5897The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5898allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5899and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5900with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5901local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5902and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5903(or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5904.code
5905accept local_parts = postmaster
5906 domains = +local_domains
5907.endd
5908This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5909local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5910&'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5911reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5912&'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5913
5914The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5915by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5916in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5917.code
5918require verify = sender
5919.endd
5920This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5921ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5922address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5923see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5924addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5925used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5926discusses the details of address verification.
5927.code
5928accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5929 control = submission
5930.endd
5931This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5932hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5933verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5934that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5935second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5936is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5937messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5938&'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5939probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5940.code
5941accept authenticated = *
5942 control = submission
5943.endd
5944This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5945Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5946likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5947authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5948examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5949fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5950.code
5951require message = relay not permitted
5952 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5953.endd
5954This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5955one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5956.code
5957require verify = recipient
5958.endd
5959This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5960fails, the address is rejected.
5961.code
5962# deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5963# is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5964# $dnslist_text
5965# dnslists = black.list.example
5966#
5967# warn dnslists = black.list.example
5968# add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5969# a black list at $dnslist_domain
5970# log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5971.endd
5972These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5973sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5974from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5975line.
5976.code
5977# require verify = csa
5978.endd
5979This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5980authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5981records.
5982.code
5983accept
5984.endd
5985The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5986address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5987.code
5988acl_check_data:
5989.endd
5990This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5991of this ACL are commented out:
5992.code
5993# deny malware = *
5994# message = This message contains a virus \
5995# ($malware_name).
5996.endd
5997These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5998viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5999suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6000virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6001.code
6002# warn spam = nobody
6003# message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6004# X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6005# X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6006# X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6007.endd
6008These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6009SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6010and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6011&`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6012series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6013whatever the spam score.
6014.code
6015accept
6016.endd
6017This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6018
6019
6020.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6021.cindex "default" "routers"
6022.cindex "routers" "default"
6023The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6024by the line
6025.code
6026begin routers
6027.endd
6028Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6029messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6030accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6031matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6032manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6033.code
6034# domain_literal:
6035# driver = ipliteral
6036# domains = !+local_domains
6037# transport = remote_smtp
6038.endd
6039.cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6040This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6041support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6042you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6043&%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6044
6045Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6046macro has been defined, per
6047.code
6048.ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6049smarthost:
6050#...
6051.else
6052dnslookup:
6053#...
6054.endif
6055.endd
6056
6057If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6058command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6059perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6060skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6061
6062.code
6063smarthost:
6064 driver = manualroute
6065 domains = ! +local_domains
6066 transport = smarthost_smtp
6067 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6068 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6069 no_more
6070.endd
6071This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6072specified by the line
6073.code
6074domains = ! +local_domains
6075.endd
6076The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6077exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6078that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6079the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6080indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6081passed on to the following routers.
6082
6083The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6084specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6085While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6086be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6087
6088With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6089will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6090other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6091&<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6092are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6093and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6094&(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6095
6096.code
6097dnslookup:
6098 driver = dnslookup
6099 domains = ! +local_domains
6100 transport = remote_smtp
6101 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6102 no_more
6103.endd
6104The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6105
6106The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6107and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6108the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6109instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6110one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6111
6112The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6113DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6114router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6115specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6116in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6117the address fails and is bounced.
6118
6119The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6120be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6121encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6122whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6123Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6124email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6125continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6126out.
6127.code
6128system_aliases:
6129 driver = redirect
6130 allow_fail
6131 allow_defer
6132 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6133# user = exim
6134 file_transport = address_file
6135 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6136.endd
6137Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6138domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6139alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6140data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6141the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6142the next router.
6143
6144&_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6145often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6146file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6147&_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6148.code
6149userforward:
6150 driver = redirect
6151 check_local_user
6152# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6153# local_part_suffix_optional
6154 file = $home/.forward
6155# allow_filter
6156 no_verify
6157 no_expn
6158 check_ancestor
6159 file_transport = address_file
6160 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6161 reply_transport = address_reply
6162.endd
6163This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6164redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6165individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6166local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6167router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6168namely:
6169.code
6170# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6171# local_part_suffix_optional
6172.endd
6173.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6174show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6175is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6176by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6177variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6178presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6179the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6180
6181When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6182home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6183declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6184redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6185
6186.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6187Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6188files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6189is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6190of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6191filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6192separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6193
6194The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6195verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6196There are two reasons for doing this:
6197
6198.olist
6199Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6200checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6201unnecessary work.
6202.next
6203More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6204command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6205The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6206It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6207this time.
6208.endlist
6209
6210The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6211address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6212works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6213forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6214
6215The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6216forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6217auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6218.code
6219a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6220.endd
6221the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6222transport.
6223.code
6224localuser:
6225 driver = accept
6226 check_local_user
6227# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6228# local_part_suffix_optional
6229 transport = local_delivery
6230.endd
6231The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6232part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6233the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6234routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6235same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6236
6237
6238.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6239.cindex "default" "transports"
6240.cindex "transports" "default"
6241Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6242only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6243not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6244.code
6245begin transports
6246.endd
6247Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6248.code
6249remote_smtp:
6250 driver = smtp
6251 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6252.ifdef _HAVE_DANE
6253 dnssec_request_domains = *
6254 hosts_try_dane = *
6255.endif
6256.ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6257 hosts_try_prdr = *
6258.endif
6259.endd
6260This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6261The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6262The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6263with over-long lines. The built-in macro _HAVE_DANE guards configuration
6264to try to use DNSSEC for all queries and to use DANE for delivery;
6265see section &<<SECDANE>>& for more details.
6266
6267The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6268negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6269but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6270use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6271
6272The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6273with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6274usual federated system.
6275
6276.code
6277smarthost_smtp:
6278 driver = smtp
6279 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6280 multi_domain
6281 #
6282.ifdef _HAVE_TLS
6283 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6284 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6285 hosts_require_tls = *
6286 tls_verify_hosts = *
6287 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6288 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6289 # or not:
6290 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6291 #
6292 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6293 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6294 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6295 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6296 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6297 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6298 #
6299.ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6300 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6301.endif
6302.ifdef _HAVE_GNUTLS
6303 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6304.endif
6305.endif
6306.ifdef _HAVE_PRDR
6307 hosts_try_prdr = *
6308.endif
6309.endd
6310After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6311can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6312that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6313happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6314All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6315then no other options are defined.
6316If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6317and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6318used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6319Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6320from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6321mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6322the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6323to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6324ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6325You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6326should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6327
6328For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6329
6330All other options are defaulted.
6331.code
6332local_delivery:
6333 driver = appendfile
6334 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6335 delivery_date_add
6336 envelope_to_add
6337 return_path_add
6338# group = mail
6339# mode = 0660
6340.endd
6341This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6342traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6343local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6344directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6345under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6346show how this can be done.
6347
6348Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6349&'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6350similarly-named options above.
6351.code
6352address_pipe:
6353 driver = pipe
6354 return_output
6355.endd
6356This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6357redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6358option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6359be returned to the sender.
6360.code
6361address_file:
6362 driver = appendfile
6363 delivery_date_add
6364 envelope_to_add
6365 return_path_add
6366.endd
6367This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6368redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6369&(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6370.code
6371address_reply:
6372 driver = autoreply
6373.endd
6374This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6375filter files.
6376
6377
6378
6379.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6380.cindex "retry" "default rule"
6381.cindex "default" "retry rule"
6382The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6383Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6384introduced by the line
6385.code
6386begin retry
6387.endd
6388In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6389errors:
6390.code
6391* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6392.endd
6393This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
63942 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
63951.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6396is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6397measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6398
6399If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6400if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6401temporary errors into permanent errors.
6402
6403
6404.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6405The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6406.code
6407begin rewrite
6408.endd
6409contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6410rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6411
6412
6413
6414.section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6415.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6416The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6417.code
6418begin authenticators
6419.endd
6420defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6421configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6422which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6423standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6424mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6425to support most MUA software.
6426
6427The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6428.code
6429#PLAIN:
6430# driver = plaintext
6431# server_set_id = $auth2
6432# server_prompts = :
6433# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6434# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6435.endd
6436And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6437.code
6438#LOGIN:
6439# driver = plaintext
6440# server_set_id = $auth1
6441# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6442# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6443# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6444.endd
6445
6446The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6447in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6448&%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6449that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6450i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6451when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6452when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6453need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6454
6455The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6456password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6457To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6458expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6459
6460Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6461usercode and password are in different positions.
6462Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6463
6464.ecindex IIDconfiwal
6465
6466
6467
6468. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6469. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6470
6471.chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6472
6473.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6474.cindex "PCRE"
6475Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6476uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6477matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6478regular expressions is discussed in
6479online Perl manpages, in
6480many Perl reference books, and also in
6481Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6482O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6483. --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6484. --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6485. --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6486
6487The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6488are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6489description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6490the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6491the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6492case-insensitive.
6493
6494In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6495it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6496or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6497second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6498.code
6499domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6500.endd
6501The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6502precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6503of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6504regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6505backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6506normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6507matched.
6508
6509There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6510recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6511string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6512these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6513it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6514match anywhere in the subject string.
6515
6516In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6517you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6518.code
6519domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6520.endd
6521matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6522You need to use:
6523.code
6524domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6525.endd
6526if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6527$ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6528
6529
6530
6531. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6532. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6533
6534.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6535.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6536.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6537.cindex "lookup" "description of"
6538Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6539messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6540
6541.olist
6542A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6543cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6544lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6545can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6546&<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6547The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6548.next
6549Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6550way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6551returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6552succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6553chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6554The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6555.endlist
6556
6557String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6558that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6559involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6560if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6561time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6562chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6563
6564.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6565It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6566lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6567processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6568Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6569.code
6570domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6571domains = lsearch;/some/file
6572.endd
6573The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6574No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6575defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6576The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6577file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6578.code
6579192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6580192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6581.endd
6582When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6583possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6584
6585In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6586Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6587in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6588.code
6589domain1:
6590domain2:
6591.endd
6592Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6593matches the list item.
6594
6595It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6596Consider a file containing lines like this:
6597.code
6598192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6599.endd
6600If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6601first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6602causes a second lookup to occur.
6603
6604The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6605available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6606lookup is permitted.
6607
6608
6609.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6610.cindex "lookup" "types of"
6611.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6612Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6613
6614.ilist
6615The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6616and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6617lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6618.next
6619.cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6620The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6621key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6622Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6623.endlist
6624
6625The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6626the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6627default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6628.code
6629LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6630LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6631.endd
6632which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6633For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6634libraries and header files before building Exim.
6635
6636
6637
6638
6639.section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6640.cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6641.cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6642The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6643
6644.ilist
6645.cindex "cdb" "description of"
6646.cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6647.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6648&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6649string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6650indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6651re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6652aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6653tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6654.display
6655&url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6656&url(http://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6657&url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6658&url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6659.endd
6660. --- 2018-09-07: corpit.ru http:-only
6661A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6662because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6663However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6664you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6665.next
6666.cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6667.cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6668.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6669&(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6670DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6671zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6672&<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6673
6674.cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6675For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6676when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6677using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6678the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6679that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6680other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6681.next
6682.cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6683.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6684.cindex "sasldb2"
6685.cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6686&(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6687interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6688ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6689authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6690&_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6691&(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6692.next
6693.cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6694.cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6695.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6696.cindex "Courier"
6697.cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6698.cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6699&(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6700is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6701if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6702other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6703use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6704calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6705utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6706by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6707.next
6708.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6709.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6710&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6711whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6712contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6713the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6714symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6715lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6716&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6717.next
6718.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6719.cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6720&(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6721terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6722file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6723IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6724being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6725.code
67261.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6727192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6728"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6729"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6730.endd
6731The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6732file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6733key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6734&"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6735&(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6736
6737&*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6738&(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6739lookup types support only literal keys.
6740
6741&*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6742the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6743&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6744.next
6745.new
6746.cindex lookup json
6747.cindex json "lookup type"
6748.cindex JSON expansions
6749&(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6750An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6751The key is a list of subelement selectors
6752(colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6753which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6754of the JSON structure.
6755If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6756nunbered array element is selected.
6757Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6758The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6759or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6760is returned.
6761For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6762.wen
6763.next
6764.cindex "linear search"
6765.cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6766.cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6767.cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6768&(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6769line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6770end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6771letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6772in the file is used.
6773
6774White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6775line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6776continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6777space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6778junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6779colon, for example:
6780.code
6781baduser: :fail:
6782.endd
6783Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6784middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6785that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6786wildcarding of any kind.
6787
6788.cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6789.cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6790In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6791characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6792If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6793matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6794contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6795quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6796quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6797
6798.next
6799.cindex "NIS lookup type"
6800.cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6801.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6802&(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6803the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6804&(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6805reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6806aliases; the full map names must be used.
6807
6808.next
6809.cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6810.cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6811.cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6812.cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6813&(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6814&(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6815the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6816that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6817used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6818
6819.cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6820Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6821file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6822&`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6823
6824. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6825. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6826
6827.olist
6828The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6829.code
6830 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6831 *fish data for anythingfish
6832.endd
6833.next
6834The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6835example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6836.code
6837 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6838.endd
6839Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6840expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6841string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6842.code
6843 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6844.endd
6845The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6846expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6847For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6848.code
6849 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6850.endd
6851
6852If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6853either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6854ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6855colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6856escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6857
6858&*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6859match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6860is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6861takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6862&((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6863
6864.next
6865Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6866is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6867lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6868example:
6869.code
6870 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6871.endd
6872The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6873.endlist olist
6874
6875Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6876continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6877be followed by optional colons.
6878
6879&*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6880&((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6881lookup types support only literal keys.
6882
6883.next
6884.cindex "lookup" "spf"
6885If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6886(as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6887For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6888.endlist ilist
6889
6890
6891.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6892.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6893.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6894The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6895many of them are given in later sections.
6896
6897.ilist
6898.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6899.cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6900&(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6901are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6902records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6903.next
6904.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6905.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6906&(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6907.next
6908.cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6909.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6910&(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6911returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6912that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6913called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6914any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6915.next
6916.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6917.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6918&(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6919MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6920.next
6921.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6922.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6923&(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6924the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6925.next
6926.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6927.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6928&(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6929Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6930.next
6931.cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6932.cindex "passwd lookup type"
6933.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6934&(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6935lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6936success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6937lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6938password value. For example:
6939.code
6940*:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6941.endd
6942.next
6943.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6944.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6945&(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6946PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6947
6948.next
6949.cindex "Redis lookup type"
6950.cindex lookup Redis
6951&(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6952passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6953
6954.next
6955.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6956.cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6957&(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a filename followed by an SQL statement
6958that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6959
6960.next
6961&(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6962not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6963.next
6964.cindex "whoson lookup type"
6965.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6966. --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
6967&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6968allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6969address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6970obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6971at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6972superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6973&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6974.code
6975require condition = \
6976 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6977.endd
6978The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6979the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6980this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6981one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6982.endlist
6983
6984
6985
6986.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6987.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6988Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6989completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6990reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6991options such as a list of local domains.
6992
6993When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6994of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6995temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6996or may give up altogether.
6997
6998
6999
7000.section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7001.cindex "wildcard lookups"
7002.cindex "lookup" "default values"
7003.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7004.cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7005.cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7006In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7007that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7008
7009&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7010lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7011specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7012
7013If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7014and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7015provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7016
7017.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7018.cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7019.cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7020Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7021&%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7022character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7023by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7024that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7025take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7026For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7027.code
7028data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7029.endd
7030Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7031looks up these keys, in this order:
7032.code
7033jane@eyre.example
7034*@eyre.example
7035*
7036.endd
7037The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7038&(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7039complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7040Exim move on to try the next key.
7041
7042
7043
7044.section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7045.cindex "partial matching"
7046.cindex "wildcard lookups"
7047.cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7048.cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7049.cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7050The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7051match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7052being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7053information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7054domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7055a key in a DBM file is
7056.code
7057*.dates.fict.example
7058.endd
7059then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7060&'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7061by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7062file.
7063
7064&*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7065also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7066&<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7067
7068Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7069keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7070be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7071partial matching keys
7072beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7073Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7074unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7075
7076Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7077the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7078is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7079is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7080fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7081start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7082remains.
7083
7084A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7085by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7086&%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7087modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7088subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7089up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7090.code
70912250.dates.fict.example
7092*.2250.dates.fict.example
7093*.dates.fict.example
7094*.fict.example
7095.endd
7096As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7097finishes.
7098
7099.cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7100.cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7101The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7102changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7103formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7104parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7105.code
7106domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7107.endd
7108In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7109&`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7110components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7111other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7112.code
7113domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7114.endd
7115For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7116&`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7117
7118If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7119just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7120down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7121
7122.ilist
7123If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7124.next
7125If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7126example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7127.next
7128Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7129remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7130for &"*"& on its own.
7131.next
7132Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7133.endlist
7134
7135
7136If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7137&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7138this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7139specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7140prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7141lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7142&"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7143
7144The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7145in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7146dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7147in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7148subject key is always followed by a dot.
7149
7150
7151
7152
7153.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7154.cindex "lookup" "caching"
7155.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7156Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7157lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7158of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7159single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7160
7161For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7162another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7163many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7164the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7165closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7166own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7167
7168The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7169strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7170complete.
7171
7172
7173
7174
7175.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7176.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7177.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7178When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7179is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7180the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7181.code
7182[name=$local_part]
7183.endd
7184will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7185For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7186.code
7187[name="$local_part"]
7188.endd
7189but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7190NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7191rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7192of the following form is provided:
7193.code
7194${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7195.endd
7196For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7197.code
7198[name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7199.endd
7200See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7201operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7202lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7203
7204
7205
7206
7207.section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7208.cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7209.cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7210.cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7211The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7212of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7213an expansion string could contain:
7214.code
7215${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7216.endd
7217If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7218is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7219&`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7220&<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7221
7222The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7223and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7224If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7225
7226For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7227concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7228depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7229between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7230by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7231.code
7232${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7233.endd
7234It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7235white space is ignored.
7236For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7237an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7238separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7239
7240.cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7241When the type is PTR,
7242the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7243&%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7244.code
7245${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7246.endd
7247If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7248altered and nothing is added.
7249
7250.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7251.cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7252For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7253each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7254port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7255The field separator can be modified as above.
7256
7257.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7258.cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7259For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7260unless a field separator is specified.
7261To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7262For SPF records the
7263default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7264.code
7265${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7266${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7267${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7268.endd
7269It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7270white space is ignored.
7271
7272.cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7273For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7274successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7275Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7276specified.
7277.code
7278${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7279.endd
7280
7281.section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7282.cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7283.cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7284.cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7285Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7286each followed by a comma,
7287that may appear before the record type.
7288
7289The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7290temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7291a defer-option modifier.
7292The possible keywords are
7293&"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7294With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7295whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7296ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7297With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7298error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7299succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7300.code
7301${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7302${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7303.endd
7304Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7305yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7306
7307.cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7308Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7309The possible keywords are
7310&"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7311With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7312with the lookup.
7313With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7314is not labelled as authenticated data
7315is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7316The default is &"never"&.
7317
7318See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7319
7320.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7321.cindex "DNS" timeout
7322Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7323The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7324(e.g. &"5s"&).
7325The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7326
7327Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7328The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7329The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7330
7331.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7332.cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7333.cindex DNS TTL
7334Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7335The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7336value of the set of returned DNS records.
7337
7338
7339.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7340.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7341By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7342each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7343the pseudo-type MXH:
7344.code
7345${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7346.endd
7347In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7348returned.
7349
7350.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7351Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7352records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7353component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7354records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7355error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7356but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7357top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7358.code
7359${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7360${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7361.endd
7362Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7363the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7364the name servers for &%edu%&.
7365
7366You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7367top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7368sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7369given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7370for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7371such a list.
7372
7373.cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7374A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7375records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7376&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7377not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7378result of a successful lookup such as:
7379.code
7380${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7381.endd
7382has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7383The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7384authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7385
7386.cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7387The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7388and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7389(see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7390.code
7391${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7392.endd
7393
7394
7395.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7396In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7397However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7398&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7399the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7400.code
7401${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7402${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7403${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7404.endd
7405In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7406the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7407to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7408case, it does not treat it as a list.
7409
7410The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7411in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7412different separator can be specified, as described above.
7413
7414
7415
7416
7417.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7418.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7419.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7420.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7421The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7422become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7423implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7424contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7425the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7426it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7427indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7428your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7429.code
7430LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7431LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7432LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7433LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7434LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7435.endd
7436If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7437same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7438
7439There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7440the way they handle the results of a query:
7441
7442.ilist
7443&(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7444gives an error.
7445.next
7446&(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7447Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7448.next
7449&(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7450from all of them are returned.
7451.endlist
7452
7453
7454For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7455Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7456the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7457First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7458
7459
7460.section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7461.cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7462An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7463the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7464.code
7465data = ${lookup ldap \
7466 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7467 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7468.endd
7469.cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7470The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7471secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7472encrypted TLS connection is used.
7473
7474With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7475LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7476See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7477
7478Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7479controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7480&_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7481your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7482&_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7483certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7484running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7485methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7486&_exim.conf_&.
7487
7488
7489.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7490.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7491Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7492and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7493within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7494reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7495
7496The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7497filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7498the string:
7499.code
7500* => \2A
7501( => \28
7502) => \29
7503\ => \5C
7504.endd
7505in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7506to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7507.code
7508! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
7509.endd
7510are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7511.code
7512${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7513.endd
7514yields
7515.code
7516%20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7517.endd
7518Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7519.code
7520a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7521.endd
7522The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7523base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7524by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7525.code
7526, + " \ < > ;
7527.endd
7528It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7529before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7530is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7531.code
7532${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7533.endd
7534yields
7535.code
7536%5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7537.endd
7538Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7539.code
7540\ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7541.endd
7542There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7543authentication below.
7544
7545
7546.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7547.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7548The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7549is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7550an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7551by starting it with
7552.code
7553ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7554.endd
7555If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7556used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7557taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7558colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7559handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7560returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7561are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7562Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7563failures, and timeouts.
7564
7565For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7566of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7567&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7568doubled. For example
7569.code
7570ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7571.endd
7572If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7573to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7574the local host) is used.
7575
7576If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7577a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7578&`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7579to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7580not available.
7581
7582For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7583for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7584can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7585the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7586.code
7587ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7588.endd
7589When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7590&`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7591.code
7592${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7593.endd
7594When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7595a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7596specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7597socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7598&%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7599or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7600the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7601backup host.
7602
7603If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7604specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7605&%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7606
7607.ilist
7608Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7609interface.
7610.next
7611Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7612.endlist
7613
7614
7615Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7616&%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7617
7618
7619
7620.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7621.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7622The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7623information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7624be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7625spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7626when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7627them. The following names are recognized:
7628.display
7629&`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7630&`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7631&`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7632&`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7633&`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7634&`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7635&`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7636&`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7637.endd
7638The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7639&"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7640must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7641library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7642
7643.cindex LDAP timeout
7644.cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7645The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7646backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7647enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7648network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7649&'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7650LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7651if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7652SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7653Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7654
7655The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7656set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7657
7658The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7659to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7660default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7661server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7662different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7663different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7664alternate list (colon-separated).
7665
7666Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7667values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7668.code
7669${lookup ldap
7670 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7671 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7672 {$value}fail}
7673.endd
7674The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7675any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7676which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7677non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7678
7679The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7680connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7681on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7682
7683When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7684removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7685some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7686quoting has two advantages:
7687
7688.ilist
7689It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7690DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7691.next
7692It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7693.endlist
7694
7695For example, a setting such as
7696.code
7697USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7698.endd
7699should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7700
7701Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7702expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7703field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7704does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7705.code
7706PASS=${quote:$3}
7707.endd
7708The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7709SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7710&<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7711
7712
7713
7714.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7715.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7716The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7717as a sequence of values, for example
7718.code
7719cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7720.endd
7721The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7722search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7723the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7724values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7725you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7726directory.
7727
7728In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7729result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7730has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7731part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7732
7733If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7734strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7735quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7736backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7737Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7738(permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7739Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7740output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7741same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7742
7743Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7744LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7745&%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7746&%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7747(they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7748
7749.code
7750ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7751value1.1,value1,,2
7752
7753ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7754value two
7755
7756ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7757value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7758
7759ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7760attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7761
7762ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7763objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7764.endd
7765You can
7766make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7767results of LDAP lookups.
7768The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7769individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7770The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7771of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7772The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7773comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7774
7775
7776
7777
7778.section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7779.cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7780.cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7781NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7782and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7783contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7784of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7785values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7786.code
7787[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7788.endd
7789might return the string
7790.code
7791name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7792home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7793.endd
7794(split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7795.code
7796[name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7797.endd
7798would just return
7799.code
7800Martin Guerre
7801.endd
7802with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7803for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7804operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7805
7806
7807
7808.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7809.cindex "SQL lookup types"
7810.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7811.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7812.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7813.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7814.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7815.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7816.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7817.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7818.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7819.cindex lookup Redis
7820Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7821and SQLite
7822databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7823might be
7824.code
7825${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7826 {$value}fail}
7827.endd
7828If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7829field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7830.code
7831${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7832 {$value}}
7833.endd
7834might be
7835.code
7836home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7837.endd
7838Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7839quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7840field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7841.code
7842Mister X
7843.endd
7844If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7845with a newline between the data for each row.
7846
7847
7848.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7849.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7850.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7851.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7852.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7853.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7854.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7855.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7856.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7857.cindex "Redis lookup type"
7858.cindex lookup Redis
7859If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7860&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7861or &%redis_servers%&
7862option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7863information.
7864(For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7865queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7866&<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7867For all but Redis
7868each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7869items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7870Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7871name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7872.code
7873hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7874.endd
7875Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7876&"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7877option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7878.code
7879hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7880 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7881.endd
7882For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7883because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7884query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7885a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7886found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7887servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7888
7889For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7890own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7891If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7892information.
7893Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7894host, database number, and password.
7895.olist
7896The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7897port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7898higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7899.next
7900The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7901.next
7902The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7903.endlist
7904
7905The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7906convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7907respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7908itself are escaped with backslashes.
7909
7910The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7911escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7912
7913.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7914For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7915it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7916done by starting the query with
7917.display
7918&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7919.endd
7920Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7921.olist
7922If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7923global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7924of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7925taken from there.
7926.next
7927If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7928.endlist
7929The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7930Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7931successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7932
7933This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7934are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7935master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7936like this:
7937.code
7938mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7939 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7940 master/db/name/pw
7941.endd
7942In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7943.code
7944${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7945.endd
7946That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7947the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7948option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7949.code
7950${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7951.endd
7952
7953
7954.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7955For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7956causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7957socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7958An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7959the default value is &"exim"&.
7960The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7961.display
7962<&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7963 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7964.endd
7965Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7966the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7967
7968No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7969the queries.
7970
7971If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7972or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7973
7974&*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7975anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7976is zero because no rows are affected.
7977
7978
7979.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7980PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7981This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7982However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7983database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7984looks like this:
7985.code
7986hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7987.endd
7988In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7989given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7990visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7991
7992If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7993update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7994affected.
7995
7996.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7997.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7998.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7999SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8000addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8001daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
8002of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
8003separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
8004contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
8005.code
8006${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8007 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8008.endd
8009In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8010.code
8011domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8012 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8013.endd
8014The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8015quote, which it doubles.
8016
8017.cindex timeout SQLite
8018.cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8019The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8020internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8021update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8022are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8023waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8024to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8025option.
8026
8027.section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8028.cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8029.cindex "redis lookup type"
8030Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8031Examples:
8032.code
8033${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8034${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8035.endd
8036
8037As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8038Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8039of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8040master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8041servers.
8042
8043When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8044immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8045to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8046reached.
8047
8048.ecindex IIDfidalo1
8049.ecindex IIDfidalo2
8050
8051
8052. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8053. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8054
8055.chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8056 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8057 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8058.scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8059A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8060email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8061contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8062are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8063arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8064
8065Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8066host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8067different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8068general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8069
8070Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8071support all the complexity available in
8072domain, host, address and local part lists.
8073
8074
8075
8076.section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8077.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8078Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8079
8080&'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8081splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8082
8083The result of
8084expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8085into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8086but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8087&<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8088discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8089
8090
8091If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8092testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8093expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8094
8095If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8096other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8097misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8098the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8099expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8100.code
8101deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8102 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8103.endd
8104The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8105&`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8106senders based on the receiving domain.
8107
8108
8109
8110
8111.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8112.cindex "list" "negation"
8113.cindex "negation" "in lists"
8114Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8115leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8116defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8117it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8118(respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8119
8120The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8121subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8122subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8123subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8124was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8125.code
8126domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8127.endd
8128matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8129neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8130list is positive. However, if the setting were
8131.code
8132domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8133.endd
8134then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8135list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8136as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8137
8138Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8139the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8140item.
8141
8142
8143
8144.section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8145.cindex "list" "filename in"
8146If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8147filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8148processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8149filenames are not allowed,
8150and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8151Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8152lines:
8153
8154.ilist
8155For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8156file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8157.next
8158Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8159address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8160white space or the start of the line. For example:
8161.code
8162not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8163.endd
8164.endlist
8165
8166Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8167file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8168is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8169so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8170
8171If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8172within the file is inverted. For example, if
8173.code
8174hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8175.endd
8176and the file contains the lines
8177.code
8178!a.b.c
8179*.b.c
8180.endd
8181then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8182any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8183
8184
8185
8186.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8187As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8188to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8189confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8190an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8191sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8192non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8193always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8194
8195If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8196list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8197in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8198&(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8199
8200
8201
8202
8203.section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8204.cindex "named lists"
8205.cindex "list" "named"
8206A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8207which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8208particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8209places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8210the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8211a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8212locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8213.code
8214domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8215.endd
8216Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8217for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8218configured with the line
8219.code
8220domains = +local_domains
8221.endd
8222The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8223except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8224.code
8225dnslookup:
8226 driver = dnslookup
8227 domains = ! +local_domains
8228 transport = remote_smtp
8229 no_more
8230.endd
8231The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8232the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8233respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8234equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8235.code
8236hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8237addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8238.endd
8239A named list may refer to other named lists:
8240.code
8241domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8242domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8243domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8244.endd
8245&*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8246effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8247out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8248.code
8249domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8250domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8251.endd
8252The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8253list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8254means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8255.code
8256domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8257.endd
8258where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8259referenced lists if you can.
8260
8261Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8262address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8263lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8264.code
8265domains = +local_domains
8266.endd
8267on several of your routers
8268or in several ACL statements,
8269the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8270if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8271references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8272the same each time they are referenced.
8273
8274By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8275extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8276is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8277hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8278
8279
8280
8281.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8282.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8283.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8284At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8285configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8286write
8287.code
8288ALIST = host1 : host2
8289auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8290.endd
8291it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8292.code
8293auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8294.endd
8295Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8296list, and write
8297.code
8298hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8299auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8300.endd
8301the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8302.code
8303auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8304.endd
8305
8306
8307.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8308.cindex "list" "caching of named"
8309.cindex "caching" "named lists"
8310While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8311it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8312the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8313that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8314an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8315message. For example:
8316.code
8317domainlist special_domains = \
8318 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8319.endd
8320This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8321address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8322in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8323cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8324same list each time.
8325
8326By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8327cache the result anyway. For example:
8328.code
8329domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8330.endd
8331If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8332the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8333
8334
8335
8336.section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8337.cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8338.cindex "list" "domain list"
8339Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8340The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8341
8342.ilist
8343.cindex "primary host name"
8344.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8345.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8346.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8347.cindex "@ in a domain list"
8348If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8349as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8350possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8351differ only in their names.
8352.next
8353.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8354.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8355.cindex "domain literal"
8356If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8357in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8358only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8359&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8360control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8361In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8362.next
8363.cindex "@mx_any"
8364.cindex "@mx_primary"
8365.cindex "@mx_secondary"
8366.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8367If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8368has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8369.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8370&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8371are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8372local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8373but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8374preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8375
8376The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8377performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8378example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8379resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8380options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8381
8382Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8383patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8384list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8385ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8386on a router). For example:
8387.code
8388domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8389.endd
8390This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8391the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8392
8393The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8394host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8395contain negative items.
8396
8397Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8398be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8399list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8400.code
8401domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8402 an.other.domain : ...
8403.endd
8404so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8405involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8406.code
8407domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8408 an.other.domain ? ...
8409.endd
8410.next
8411.cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8412.cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8413.cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8414If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8415are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8416domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8417list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8418matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8419list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8420&'cipher.key.ex'&.
8421
8422.next
8423.cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8424.cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8425If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8426expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8427function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8428Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8429default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8430with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8431are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8432
8433&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8434must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8435use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8436it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8437expression by expansion, of course).
8438.next
8439.cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8440.cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8441If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8442semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8443must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8444&"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8445.code
8446domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8447.endd
8448The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8449key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8450only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8451is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8452or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8453&$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8454other statements in the same ACL.
8455
8456.next
8457Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8458&`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8459.code
8460domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8461.endd
8462This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8463works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8464
8465.next
8466.cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8467Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8468a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8469original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8470select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8471value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8472expansion variable.
8473.next
8474If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8475semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8476pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8477chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8478.code
8479hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8480 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8481.endd
8482In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8483example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8484whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8485&%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8486variable and can be referred to in other options.
8487.next
8488.cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8489If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8490between the pattern and the domain.
8491.endlist
8492
8493Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8494.code
8495domainlist funny_domains = \
8496 @ : \
8497 lib.unseen.edu : \
8498 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8499 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8500 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8501 nis;domains.byname : \
8502 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8503.endd
8504There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8505an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8506explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8507but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8508patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8509patterns earlier.
8510
8511
8512
8513.section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8514.cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8515.cindex "list" "host list"
8516Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8517example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8518may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8519two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8520pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8521You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8522involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8523
8524
8525.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8526.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8527.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8528If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8529involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8530process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8531not used.
8532
8533.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8534The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8535the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8536
8537
8538
8539.section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8540.cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8541If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8542the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8543&`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8544list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8545systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8546concerns.)
8547
8548The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8549inspecting its IP address:
8550
8551.ilist
8552If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8553with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8554to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8555&[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8556This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8557with the IP address of the subject host.
8558
8559If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8560lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8561ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8562temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8563what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8564
8565.next
8566.cindex "@ in a host list"
8567If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8568domain name, as just described.
8569
8570.next
8571If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8572subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8573IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8574be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8575separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8576without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8577IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8578that can never match a client host.
8579
8580.next
8581.cindex "@[] in a host list"
8582If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8583the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8584interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8585.code
8586accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8587accept hosts = @[]
8588.endd
8589.next
8590.cindex "CIDR notation"
8591If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8592example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8593host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8594included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8595specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8596significant end of the address.
8597
8598&*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8599of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8600address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8601addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8602.code
8603192.168.23.236/31
8604.endd
8605matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
860632 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8607matches.
8608
8609Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8610.code
8611recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8612 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8613.endd
8614The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8615appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8616For example:
8617.code
8618recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8619.endd
8620could make use of a file containing
8621.code
8622172.16.0.0/12
86233ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8624.endd
8625to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8626addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8627changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8628.code
8629recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8630 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
8631.endd
8632The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8633list.
8634.endlist
8635
8636
8637
8638.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8639 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8640.cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8641When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8642address, the pattern takes this form:
8643.display
8644&`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8645.endd
8646For example:
8647.code
8648hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8649.endd
8650The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8651IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8652letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8653&(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8654quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8655returned by the lookup is not used.
8656
8657.cindex "IP address" "masking"
8658.cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8659Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8660patterns of this form:
8661.display
8662&`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8663.endd
8664For example:
8665.code
8666net24-dbm;/networks.db
8667.endd
8668The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8669length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8670mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8671is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8672&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8673
8674When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8675of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8676terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8677to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8678recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8679(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8680For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8681converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8682addresses are always used.
8683
8684Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8685colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8686However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8687configurations.
8688
8689&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8690IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8691the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8692case the IP address is used on its own.
8693
8694
8695
8696.section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8697.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8698.cindex "unknown host name"
8699.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8700There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8701remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8702complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8703address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8704above.)
8705
8706If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8707patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8708Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8709DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8710Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8711effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8712Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8713
8714Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8715against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8716
8717By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8718if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8719&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8720are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8721security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8722for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8723Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8724discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8725found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8726
8727There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8728found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8729
8730.cindex "host" "alias for"
8731.cindex "alias for host"
8732As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8733of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8734
8735.ilist
8736.cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8737If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8738the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8739&'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8740requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8741expression.
8742.next
8743.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8744.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8745If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8746matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8747expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8748case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8749syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8750example,
8751.code
8752^(a|b)\.c\.d$
8753.endd
8754is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8755&'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8756that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8757string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8758part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8759.code
8760sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8761.endd
8762&*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8763&`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8764example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8765required.
8766.endlist
8767
8768
8769
8770
8771.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8772.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8773While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8774name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8775from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8776behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8777
8778&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8779apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8780
8781.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8782.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8783Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8784lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8785Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8786does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8787To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8788&`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8789not recognized in an indirected file).
8790
8791.ilist
8792If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8793cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8794.code
8795host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8796.endd
8797rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8798any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8799
8800.next
8801If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8802be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8803example:
8804.code
8805accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8806 192.168.4.5
8807.endd
8808accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8809whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8810name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8811.endlist
8812
8813Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8814list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8815list.
8816
8817.section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8818 "SECTmixwilhos"
8819.cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8820
8821This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8822as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8823wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8824
8825.ilist
8826If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8827IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8828addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8829.code
8830accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8831.endd
8832The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8833left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8834without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8835a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8836pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8837&%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8838if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8839
8840.next
8841If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8842address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8843.code
8844accept hosts = *.friend.example
8845accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8846.endd
8847If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8848&<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8849&`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8850this section.
8851.endlist
8852
8853
8854.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8855 "SECTtemdnserr"
8856.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8857.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8858.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8859A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8860&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8861host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8862&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8863section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8864host lists such as whitelists.
8865
8866
8867
8868.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8869 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8870.cindex "unknown host name"
8871.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8872If a pattern is of the form
8873.display
8874<&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8875.endd
8876for example
8877.code
8878dbm;/host/accept/list
8879.endd
8880a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8881lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8882is not used.
8883
8884&*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8885keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8886addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8887&<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8888two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8889lookup, both using the same file.
8890
8891
8892
8893.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8894If a pattern is of the form
8895.display
8896<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8897.endd
8898the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8899data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8900&$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8901.code
8902hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8903 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8904.endd
8905The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8906can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8907use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8908operator.
8909
8910If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8911looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8912&<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8913
8914Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8915host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8916&`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8917still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8918effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8919See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8920
8921
8922
8923
8924
8925.section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8926.cindex "list" "address list"
8927.cindex "address list" "empty item"
8928.cindex "address list" "patterns"
8929Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8930is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8931always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8932list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8933using this option setting:
8934.code
8935senders = :
8936.endd
8937The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8938data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8939detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8940and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8941
8942Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8943example:
8944.code
8945senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8946.endd
8947A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8948character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8949semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8950subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8951with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8952the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8953wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8954.code
8955deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8956 *@+hostile_domains:\
8957 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8958 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8959.endd
8960.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8961.cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8962If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8963specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8964treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8965
8966If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8967contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8968address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8969domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8970is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8971.code
8972deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8973.endd
8974
8975The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8976address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8977senders:
8978
8979.ilist
8980.cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8981.cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8982If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8983done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8984You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8985as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8986to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8987.code
8988deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8989 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8990.endd
8991The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8992start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8993
8994.next
8995.cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8996Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8997lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8998example:
8999.code
9000deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9001 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9002 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9003.endd
9004Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9005lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9006not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9007always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9008
9009Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9010cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9011panic log.
9012.cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9013However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9014&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9015default. For example, with this lookup:
9016.code
9017accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9018.endd
9019the file could contains lines like this:
9020.code
9021user1@domain1.example
9022*@domain2.example
9023.endd
9024and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9025that are tried is:
9026.code
9027nimrod@jaeger.example
9028*@jaeger.example
9029*
9030.endd
9031&*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9032would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9033
9034&*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9035.code
9036deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9037deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9038.endd
9039The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9040because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9041domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9042.endlist
9043
9044
9045The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9046If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9047always fails.
9048
9049
9050.ilist
9051.cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9052.cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9053.cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9054If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9055(for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9056split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9057it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9058from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9059of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9060
9061.cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9062The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9063keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9064patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9065even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9066with
9067.code
9068deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9069.endd
9070the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9071.code
9072baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9073.endd
9074to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9075
9076.cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9077If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9078has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9079may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9080but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9081surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9082.code
9083aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9084 spammer3 : spammer4
9085.endd
9086As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9087doubling.
9088
9089If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9090of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9091list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9092might have entries like
9093.code
9094aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9095xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9096*: ^\d{8}$
9097.endd
9098in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9099local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9100each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9101chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9102
9103.cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9104It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9105them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9106
9107.next
9108The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9109lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9110can only return a single list of local parts.
9111.endlist
9112
9113&*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9114in these two examples:
9115.code
9116senders = +my_list
9117senders = *@+my_list
9118.endd
9119In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9120example it is a named domain list.
9121
9122
9123
9124
9125.section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9126.cindex "case of local parts"
9127.cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9128.cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9129Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9130case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9131Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9132Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9133blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9134lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9135default.
9136
9137The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9138address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9139comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9140the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9141that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9142keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9143works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9144case-independent.
9145
9146.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9147To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9148an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9149part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9150longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9151lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9152performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9153become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9154
9155
9156
9157.section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9158.cindex "list" "local part list"
9159.cindex "local part" "list"
9160Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9161lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9162setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9163set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9164case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9165matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9166&%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9167option is case-sensitive from the start.
9168
9169If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9170comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9171only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9172Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9173that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9174&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9175Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9176types.
9177.ecindex IIDdohoadli
9178
9179
9180
9181
9182. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9183. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9184
9185.chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9186.scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9187Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9188them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9189
9190When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9191when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9192start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9193below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9194escape character, as described in the following section.
9195
9196Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9197dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9198options for which string expansion is performed are marked with &dagger; after
9199the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9200conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9201reasons.
9202
9203
9204
9205.section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9206.cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9207An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9208backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9209character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9210If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9211required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9212the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9213
9214.cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9215A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9216two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9217expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9218.code
9219deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9220.endd
9221On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9222without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9223string.
9224
9225
9226
9227.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9228.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9229A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9230expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9231carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9232octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9233backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9234encoding.
9235
9236These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9237in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9238and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9239
9240
9241.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9242.cindex "expansion" "testing"
9243.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9244.oindex "&%-be%&"
9245Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9246takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9247arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9248to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9249since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9250value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9251database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9252and &%nhash%&.
9253
9254Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9255instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9256using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9257
9258.oindex "&%-bem%&"
9259If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9260from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9261option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9262read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9263.code
9264exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9265.endd
9266The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9267Exim message identifier. For example:
9268.code
9269exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9270.endd
9271This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9272is therefore restricted to admin users.
9273
9274
9275.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9276.cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9277A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9278alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9279(which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9280used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9281instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9282the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9283that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9284its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9285from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9286taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9287being expanded.
9288
9289
9290
9291
9292.section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9293The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9294between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9295outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9296white space is significant.
9297
9298.vlist
9299.vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9300.cindex "expansion" "variables"
9301Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9302.code
9303$local_part
9304${domain}
9305.endd
9306The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9307characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9308&'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9309section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9310given, the expansion fails.
9311
9312.vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9313.cindex "expansion" "operators"
9314The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9315<&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9316.code
9317${lc:$local_part}
9318.endd
9319The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9320leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9321below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9322one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9323string easier to understand.
9324
9325.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9326This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9327expansion item below.
9328
9329
9330.vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9331.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9332.cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9333The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9334arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9335Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9336arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9337and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9338are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9339a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9340the result of the expansion.
9341If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9342the expansion result is an empty string.
9343If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9344
9345
9346.vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9347.cindex authentication "results header"
9348.cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9349.cindex authentication "expansion item"
9350This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9351&'Authentication-Results"'&
9352header line.
9353The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9354will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9355Methods that might be present in the result include:
9356.code
9357none
9358iprev
9359auth
9360spf
9361dkim
9362.endd
9363
9364Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9365.code
9366 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9367.endd
9368This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9369
9370
9371.vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9372 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9373.cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9374.cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9375.cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9376The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9377The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9378the certificate. Supported fields are:
9379.display
9380&`version `&
9381&`serial_number `&
9382&`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9383&`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9384&`notbefore `& time
9385&`notafter `& time
9386&`sig_algorithm `&
9387&`signature `&
9388&`subj_altname `& tagged list
9389&`ocsp_uri `& list
9390&`crl_uri `& list
9391.endd
9392If the field is found,
9393<&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9394otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9395variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9396is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9397
9398If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9399key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9400extracted is used.
9401
9402Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9403
9404The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9405output a Distinguished Name string which is
9406not quite
9407parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9408(the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9409RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9410a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9411result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9412The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9413a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9414Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9415
9416The field selectors marked as "time" above
9417take an optional modifier of "int"
9418for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9419Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9420in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9421
9422The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9423newline-separated by default,
9424(embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9425The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9426a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9427
9428The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9429prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9430Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9431which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9432if so the element tags are omitted.
9433
9434If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9435
9436.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9437 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9438.cindex &%dlfunc%&
9439This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9440This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9441.code
9442EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
9443.endd
9444set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9445object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9446(but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9447
9448There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9449a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9450included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9451are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9452must have the following type:
9453.code
9454int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9455.endd
9456Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9457function should return one of the following values:
9458
9459&`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9460into the expanded string that is being built.
9461
9462&`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9463from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9464
9465&`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9466taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9467
9468&`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9469
9470When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9471you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9472configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9473
9474
9475.vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9476.cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9477.cindex "environment" "values from"
9478The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9479removed.
9480This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9481If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9482and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9483
9484Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9485appear, for example:
9486.code
9487${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9488.endd
9489This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9490{<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9491
9492If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9493search failure.
9494If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9495search success.
9496
9497The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9498&%add_environment%& main section options.
9499
9500
9501.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9502 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9503.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9504.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9505The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9506white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9507must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9508The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9509.display
9510<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9511.endd
9512.vindex "&$value$&"
9513where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9514values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9515values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9516described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9517for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9518the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9519otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9520variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9521is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9522
9523If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9524key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9525extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9526yield &"2001"&:
9527.code
9528${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9529${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9530.endd
9531Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9532appear, for example:
9533.code
9534${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9535.endd
9536This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9537{<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9538
9539.vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9540 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9541 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9542 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9543.cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9544.cindex JSON expansions
9545The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9546white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9547must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9548The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9549.display
9550{ <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9551.endd
9552.vindex "&$value$&"
9553The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9554the spaces are optional.
9555Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9556For the &"json"& variant,
9557if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9558trailing quotes.
9559.new
9560For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9561leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9562.wen
9563. XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9564
9565The results of matching are handled as above.
9566
9567
9568.vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9569 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9570.cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9571.cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9572The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9573apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9574This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9575behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9576extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9577argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9578<&'string3'&> as before.
9579
9580The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9581separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9582The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9583counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9584number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9585number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9586expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9587provided. For example:
9588.code
9589${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9590.endd
9591yields &"42"&, and
9592.code
9593${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9594.endd
9595yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9596empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9597
9598
9599.vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9600 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9601 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9602 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9603.cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9604.cindex JSON expansions
9605The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9606apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9607
9608Field selection and result handling is as above;
9609there is no choice of field separator.
9610For the &"json"& variant,
9611if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9612trailing quotes.
9613.new
9614For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9615leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9616.wen
9617
9618
9619.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9620.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9621.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9622.vindex "&$item$&"
9623After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9624default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9625For each item
9626in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9627evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9628item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9629separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9630input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9631.code
9632${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9633.endd
9634yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9635to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9636
9637
9638.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9639.cindex "hash function" "textual"
9640.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9641This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9642early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9643(numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9644
9645The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9646<&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9647<&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9648use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9649.code
9650${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9651.endd
9652The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9653or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9654Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9655function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9656first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9657.code
9658abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9659.endd
9660If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9661letters appear. For example:
9662.display
9663&`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9664&`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9665&`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9666.endd
9667
9668.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9669 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9670 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9671 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9672 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9673 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9674 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9675 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9676.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9677.vindex "&$header_$&"
9678.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9679.vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9680.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9681.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9682.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9683.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9684Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9685.code
9686$header_reply-to:
9687.endd
9688The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9689internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9690lines) may be present.
9691
9692The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9693the data in the header line is interpreted.
9694
9695.ilist
9696.cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9697&%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9698processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9699
9700.next
9701.cindex "list" "of header lines"
9702&%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9703are multiple headers with a given name.
9704Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9705list-processing facilities can be used.
9706The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9707the content is &"raw"&.
9708
9709.next
9710.cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9711&%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9712or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9713character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9714&"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9715.cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9716produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9717what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9718
9719.next
9720&%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9721standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9722be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9723returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9724&[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9725a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9726.endlist ilist
9727
9728In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9729command of the following form:
9730.code
9731headers charset "UTF-8"
9732.endd
9733This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9734subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9735character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9736option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9737value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9738ISO-8859-1.
9739
9740Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9741any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9742&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9743if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9744
9745Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9746this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9747message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9748filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9749router or transport are not accessible.
9750
9751For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9752ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9753because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9754They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9755Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9756are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9757point they are added.
9758When any of the above ACLs ar
9759running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9760
9761Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9762following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9763this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9764white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9765expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9766expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9767section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9768header.)
9769
9770If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9771to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9772&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9773each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9774newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9775newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9776those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9777junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9778
9779
9780.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9781.cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9782.cindex &%hmac%&
9783This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9784shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9785RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9786&`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9787cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9788or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9789present. For example:
9790.code
9791${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9792.endd
9793For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9794produces:
9795.code
9796dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9797.endd
9798As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9799an Exim configuration:
9800.code
9801SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9802.endd
9803In a router or a transport you could then have:
9804.code
9805headers_add = \
9806 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9807 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9808 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9809.endd
9810Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9811&'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9812this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9813host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9814using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9815&'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9816
9817
9818.vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9819.cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9820.cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9821If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9822item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9823in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9824.code
9825${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9826.endd
9827The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9828true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9829be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9830case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9831&<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9832
9833If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9834is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9835cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9836.code
9837condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9838.endd
9839you can use
9840.code
9841condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9842.endd
9843
9844
9845
9846.vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9847.cindex expansion "imap folder"
9848.cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9849This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9850folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9851For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9852
9853
9854
9855.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9856.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9857.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9858The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9859strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9860you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9861change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9862some of the braces:
9863.code
9864${length_<n>:<string>}
9865.endd
9866The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9867of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9868&%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9869All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9870
9871
9872.vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9873 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9874.cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9875.cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9876.cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9877The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9878apart from an optional leading minus,
9879and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9880
9881After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9882default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9883
9884The first field of the list is numbered one.
9885If the number is negative, the fields are
9886counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9887The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9888then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9889
9890If the modulus of the
9891number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9892the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9893
9894For example:
9895.code
9896${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9897.endd
9898yields &"42"&, and
9899.code
9900${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9901.endd
9902yields &"result: 42"&.
9903
9904If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9905If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9906extracted is used.
9907You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9908
9909
9910.vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9911 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9912This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9913described in the next item.
9914
9915.vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9916 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9917.cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9918.cindex "file" "lookups"
9919.cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9920The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9921discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9922lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9923<&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9924
9925If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9926a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9927other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9928in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9929out by the system administrator.
9930
9931.vindex "&$value$&"
9932If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9933During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9934lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9935level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9936the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9937string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9938lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9939original lookup fails.
9940
9941If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9942data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9943expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9944the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9945appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9946to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9947{<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9948successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9949
9950For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9951search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9952type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9953&<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9954
9955.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9956If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9957and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9958They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9959
9960This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9961.code
9962${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9963.endd
9964This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9965the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9966.code
9967${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9968 {$value}fail}
9969.endd
9970
9971
9972.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9973.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9974.vindex "&$item$&"
9975After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9976default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9977For each item
9978in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9979expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9980for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9981setting is not included in the output. For example:
9982.code
9983${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9984.endd
9985expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9986value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9987and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9988
9989.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9990.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9991.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9992The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9993<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9994if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9995can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9996.code
9997${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9998.endd
9999The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10000the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10001processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10002slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10003example,
10004.code
10005${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10006.endd
10007returns the string &"6/33"&.
10008
10009
10010
10011.vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10012.cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10013.cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10014This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10015interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10016expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10017additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10018name of the subroutine, is nine.
10019
10020The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10021the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10022way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10023Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10024return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10025not its contents.
10026
10027If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10028with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10029Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10030
10031The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10032out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10033
10034
10035.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10036.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10037The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10038keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10039it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10040to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10041as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10042and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10043
10044.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10045 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10046.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10047This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10048checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10049yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10050empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10051prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10052version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10053variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10054
10055These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10056retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10057against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10058which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10059
10060The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10061string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10062result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10063whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10064is the expansion of the third argument.
10065
10066All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10067However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10068For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10069
10070.vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10071.cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10072.cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10073.cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10074The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10075then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10076the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10077newlines are left in the string.
10078String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10079you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10080the string expansion fails.
10081
10082The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10083locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10084
10085
10086
10087.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10088 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10089.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10090.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10091.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10092This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10093string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10094examples:
10095.code
10096${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10097${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10098.endd
10099For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10100For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10101a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10102number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10103optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10104example:
10105.code
10106${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10107.endd
10108Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10109one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10110both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10111unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10112and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10113is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10114extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10115.code
10116${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10117.endd
10118
10119The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10120and must be present if the argument is given.
10121Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10122Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
10123The first defines whether (the default)
10124or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
10125Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
10126.code
10127${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10128.endd
10129The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
10130.code
10131${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
10132.endd
10133The default is to not use TLS.
10134If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10135
10136A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10137that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10138turns them into spaces:
10139.code
10140${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10141.endd
10142As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10143happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10144addition, the following errors can occur:
10145
10146.ilist
10147Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10148.next
10149Failure to connect the socket;
10150.next
10151Failure to write the request string;
10152.next
10153Timeout on reading from the socket.
10154.endlist
10155
10156By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10157you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10158errors occurs. For example:
10159.code
10160${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10161 {socket failure}}
10162.endd
10163You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10164expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10165and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10166if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10167non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10168
10169The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10170locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10171
10172
10173.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10174.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10175.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10176.vindex "&$value$&"
10177.vindex "&$item$&"
10178This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10179<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10180separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10181Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10182assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10183list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10184them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10185iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10186added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
10187number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10188.code
10189${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10190.endd
10191The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10192can be found:
10193.code
10194${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10195.endd
10196At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10197restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
10198expansion items.
10199
10200.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10201This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10202expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10203
10204.vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10205 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10206.cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10207.cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10208The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10209split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10210in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10211executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10212a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10213
10214Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10215which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10216simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10217script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10218variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10219quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10220in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10221around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10222variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10223character.
10224
10225The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10226and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10227.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10228.vindex "&$value$&"
10229If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10230and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10231from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10232<&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10233expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10234&$value$&.
10235
10236If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10237can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10238command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10239of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10240
10241.vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10242The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10243In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10244troubleshoot:
10245.code
10246warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10247 log_message = Output of id: $value
10248.endd
10249If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10250shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10251.code
10252${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10253.endd
10254
10255.vindex "&$runrc$&"
10256The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10257remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10258.code
10259if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10260 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10261 ...
10262endif
10263.endd
10264If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10265the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10266commands.
10267
10268&*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10269option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10270testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10271by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10272
10273The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10274out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10275
10276
10277.vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10278.cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10279.cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10280This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10281option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10282modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10283into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10284a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10285.code
10286${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10287.endd
10288yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10289if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10290substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10291.code
10292${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10293.endd
10294yields &"defabc"&, and
10295.code
10296${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10297.endd
10298yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10299the regular expression from string expansion.
10300
10301The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10302rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10303
10304
10305.vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10306.cindex sorting "a list"
10307.cindex list sorting
10308.cindex expansion "list sorting"
10309After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10310default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10311The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10312of a two-argument expansion condition.
10313The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10314The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10315if the first value should sort before the second value.
10316The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10317the element being placed in &$item$&,
10318to give values for comparison.
10319
10320The item result is a sorted list,
10321with the original list separator,
10322of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10323
10324Examples:
10325.code
10326${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10327.endd
10328sorts a list of numbers, and
10329.code
10330${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10331.endd
10332will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10333
10334
10335.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10336.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10337.cindex "substring extraction"
10338.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10339The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10340<&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10341if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10342can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10343.code
10344${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10345.endd
10346The second number is optional (in both notations).
10347If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10348omitted.
10349
10350The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10351&%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10352length required. For example
10353.code
10354${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10355.endd
10356If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10357null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10358length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10359given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10360
10361The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10362from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10363the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10364.code
10365${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10366.endd
10367yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10368length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10369the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10370.code
10371${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10372.endd
10373yields an empty string, but
10374.code
10375${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10376.endd
10377yields &"1"&.
10378
10379When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10380is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10381string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10382no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10383.code
10384${substr_-1:abcde}
10385${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10386.endd
10387yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10388
10389All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10390
10391
10392
10393.vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10394 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10395.cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10396.cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10397This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10398argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10399matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10400replacement list. For example
10401.code
10402${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10403.endd
10404yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10405last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10406last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10407place.
10408
10409All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10410
10411.endlist
10412
10413
10414
10415.section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10416.cindex "expansion" "operators"
10417For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10418the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10419The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10420following operations can be performed:
10421
10422.vlist
10423.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10424.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10425.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10426The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10427header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10428not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10429
10430The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10431
10432
10433.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10434.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10435.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10436The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
104372822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10438operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10439result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10440doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10441Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10442
10443It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10444separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10445character. For example:
10446.code
10447${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10448.endd
10449expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10450first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10451separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10452separator explicitly:
10453.code
10454${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10455.endd
10456
10457Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10458expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10459address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10460processing lists.
10461
10462To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10463a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10464unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10465email address separator. For the example header line:
10466.code
10467From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10468.endd
10469The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10470properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10471It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10472example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10473de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10474The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10475quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10476.code
10477# exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10478=?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10479user@example.com
10480# exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10481Last:user@example.com
10482# exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10483user@example.com
10484# exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10485フィリップ@example.jp
10486.endd
10487
10488.vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10489.cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10490.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10491The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10492base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10493Only lowercase letters are used.
10494
10495.vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10496.cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10497.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10498The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10499The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10500
10501.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10502.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10503.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10504The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10505base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10506the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10507its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10508filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10509to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10510
10511.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10512.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10513.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10514The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10515environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10516identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10517string.
10518
10519.vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10520.cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10521.cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10522.cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10523.cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10524This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10525
10526If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10527returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10528
10529
10530.vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10531.cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10532.cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10533.cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10534This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10535
10536
10537.vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10538.cindex "domain" "extraction"
10539.cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10540The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10541from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10542
10543
10544.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10545.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10546.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10547If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10548escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10549significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10550is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10551
10552.vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10553.cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10554.cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10555If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10556they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10557Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10558
10559
10560.vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10561.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10562.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10563.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10564These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10565expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10566arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10567logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10568integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10569C programming language):
10570.table2 70pt 300pt
10571.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10572.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10573.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10574.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10575.irow "" "and (&&)"
10576.irow "" "xor (^)"
10577.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10578.endtable
10579Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10580space is permitted before or after operators.
10581
10582For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10583hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10584decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10585permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10586times, which often do have leading zeros.
10587
10588A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10589or 1024*1024*1024,
10590respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10591a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10592
10593.display
10594&`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10595&`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10596&`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10597&`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10598&`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
10599&`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10600&`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10601&`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10602&`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10603&`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
10604&`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10605.endd
10606
10607As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10608.code
10609deny message = Too many bad recipients
10610 condition = \
10611 ${if and { \
10612 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10613 { \
10614 < \
10615 {$recipients_count} \
10616 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10617 } \
10618 }{yes}{no}}
10619.endd
10620The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10621fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10622
10623
10624.vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10625.cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10626The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10627example,
10628.code
10629${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10630.endd
10631first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10632and then re-expands what it has found.
10633
10634
10635.vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10636.cindex "Unicode"
10637.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10638.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10639.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10640The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10641email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10642to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10643UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10644converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10645the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10646
10647Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10648ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10649For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10650way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10651characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10652single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10653translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10654
10655
10656.vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10657.cindex "hash function" "textual"
10658.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10659The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10660be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10661change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10662.code
10663${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10664.endd
10665See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10666abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10667
10668
10669
10670.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10671.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10672.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10673.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10674This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10675be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10676
10677
10678
10679.vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10680.cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10681.cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10682This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10683escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10684as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10685byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10686
10687
10688.vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10689.cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10690.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10691This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10692of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10693A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10694Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10695
10696.vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10697.cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10698.cindex "IP address" normalisation
10699.cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10700This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10701Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10702set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10703A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10704Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10705
10706
10707.vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10708.cindex "case forcing in strings"
10709.cindex "string" "case forcing"
10710.cindex "lower casing"
10711.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10712.cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10713This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10714.code
10715${lc:$local_part}
10716.endd
10717Case is defined per the system C locale.
10718
10719.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10720.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10721.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10722The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10723can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10724changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10725.code
10726${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10727.endd
10728See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10729&%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10730when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10731All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10732
10733
10734.vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10735.cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10736.cindex "list" "item count"
10737.cindex "list" "count of items"
10738.cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10739The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10740
10741
10742.vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10743.cindex "expansion" "named list"
10744.cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10745The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10746expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10747If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10748and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10749Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10750matching list is returned.
10751
10752
10753.vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10754.cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10755.cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10756The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10757extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10758empty.
10759The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10760
10761
10762.vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10763.cindex "masked IP address"
10764.cindex "IP address" "masking"
10765.cindex "CIDR notation"
10766.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10767.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10768If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10769slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10770expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10771masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10772the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10773.code
10774${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10775.endd
10776returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10777be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10778address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10779terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10780.code
10781${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10782.endd
10783returns the string
10784.code
107853ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10786.endd
10787Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10788
10789
10790.vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10791.cindex "MD5 hash"
10792.cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10793.cindex certificate fingerprint
10794.cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10795The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10796as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10797
10798If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10799returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10800
10801
10802.vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10803.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10804.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10805The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10806that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10807strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10808.code
10809${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10810.endd
10811See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10812
10813
10814.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10815.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10816.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10817.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10818The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10819is an empty string or
10820contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10821Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10822Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10823respectively For example,
10824.code
10825${quote:ab"*"cd}
10826.endd
10827becomes
10828.code
10829"ab\"*\"cd"
10830.endd
10831The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10832variable or a message header.
10833
10834.vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10835.cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10836This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10837required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10838example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10839If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10840(or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10841
10842This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10843will likely use the quoting form.
10844Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10845
10846
10847.vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10848.cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10849This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10850query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10851the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10852.code
10853${quote_ldap:two * two}
10854.endd
10855returns
10856.code
10857two%20%5C2A%20two
10858.endd
10859For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10860yields an unchanged string.
10861
10862
10863.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10864.cindex "random number"
10865This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10866supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10867on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10868If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10869If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10870for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10871Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10872srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10873random().
10874
10875
10876.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10877.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10878This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10879dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10880dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10881for DNS. For example,
10882.code
10883${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10884${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10885.endd
10886returns
10887.code
108884.2.0.192
10889f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10890.endd
10891
10892
10893.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10894.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10895.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10896.cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10897This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10898encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10899assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10900&%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10901contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10902characters
10903.code
10904? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10905.endd
10906it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10907string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10908characters.
10909
10910
10911.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10912.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10913.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10914.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10915This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10916bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10917character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10918not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10919
10920&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10921access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10922to use this operator as well.
10923
10924
10925
10926.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10927.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10928.cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10929.cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10930The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10931characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10932variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10933
10934
10935.vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10936.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10937.cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10938.cindex certificate fingerprint
10939.cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10940The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10941it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10942
10943If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10944returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10945
10946
10947.vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10948.cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10949.cindex certificate fingerprint
10950.cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10951.cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10952The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10953and returns
10954it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10955
10956If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10957returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10958
10959
10960.vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10961 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10962.cindex "SHA3 hash"
10963.cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10964.cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10965The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10966and returns
10967it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10968
10969If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10970the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10971with 256 being the default.
10972
10973The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10974compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
10975or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
10976The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
10977
10978
10979.vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10980.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10981.cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10982.cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10983The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10984function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10985expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10986series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10987except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10988a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
1098910-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10990&"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
10991can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
10992
10993The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
10994the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
10995systems for files larger than 2GB.
10996
10997.vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10998.cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
10999Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11000
11001
11002
11003.vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11004.cindex "expansion" "string length"
11005.cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11006.cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11007The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11008decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11009All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11010
11011
11012.vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11013.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11014.cindex "substring extraction"
11015.cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11016The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11017can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11018that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11019.code
11020${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11021.endd
11022See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11023abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11024All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11025
11026.vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11027.cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11028.cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11029This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11030seconds.
11031
11032.vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11033.cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11034.cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11035The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11036represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11037number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11038&`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
11039
11040.vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11041.cindex "case forcing in strings"
11042.cindex "string" "case forcing"
11043.cindex "upper casing"
11044.cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11045.cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11046This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11047Case is defined per the system C locale.
11048
11049.vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11050.cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11051.cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11052.cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11053.cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11054.cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11055This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11056In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11057final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11058If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11059the complexity will depend upon the task.
11060For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11061extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11062dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11063.code
11064condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11065.endd
11066(which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11067literal question mark).
11068
11069.vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11070 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11071 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11072 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11073.cindex expansion UTF-8
11074.cindex UTF-8 expansion
11075.cindex EAI
11076.cindex internationalisation
11077.cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11078.cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11079.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11080.cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11081These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11082For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11083.endlist
11084
11085
11086
11087
11088
11089
11090.section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11091.scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11092The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11093while expanding strings:
11094
11095.vlist
11096.vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11097.cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11098.cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11099Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11100condition.
11101
11102.vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11103.cindex "numeric comparison"
11104.cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11105There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11106are:
11107.display
11108&`= `& equal
11109&`== `& equal
11110&`> `& greater
11111&`>= `& greater or equal
11112&`< `& less
11113&`<= `& less or equal
11114.endd
11115For example:
11116.code
11117${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11118.endd
11119Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11120two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11121optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11122lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11123As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11124zero.
11125
11126In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11127<&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
1112810M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11129
11130
11131.vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11132 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11133.cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11134.cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11135The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11136arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11137Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11138arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11139and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11140are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11141a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11142the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11143If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11144If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11145
11146.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11147.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11148.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11149This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11150a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11151(case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11152false if zero.
11153An empty string is treated as false.
11154Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11155thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11156All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11157
11158When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11159make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11160For example:
11161.code
11162${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11163.endd
11164
11165
11166.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11167.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11168.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11169Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11170where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11171loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11172and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11173true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11174
11175Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11176
11177.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11178.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11179.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11180.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11181This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11182authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11183necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11184included in the binary.
11185
11186The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11187compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11188be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11189encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11190does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11191&[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11192Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11193string in LDAP form is:
11194.code
11195{md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11196.endd
11197If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11198be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11199.code
11200${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11201.endd
11202The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11203supported:
11204
11205.ilist
11206.cindex "MD5 hash"
11207.cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11208&%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11209printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11210length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11211(as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11212hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11213comparison fails.
11214
11215.next
11216.cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11217&%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11218printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11219length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11220If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11221SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11222
11223.next
11224.cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11225&%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11226only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11227systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11228whatever its length.
11229
11230.next
11231.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11232&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11233use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11234modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11235.endlist
11236Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11237&[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11238HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11239operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11240the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11241support &[crypt16()]&.
11242
11243Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11244it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11245turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11246&[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11247algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11248
11249However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11250functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11251Exim is seen as very low priority.
11252
11253If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11254comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11255determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11256default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11257function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11258
11259.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11260.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11261.cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11262The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11263variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11264variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11265.code
11266${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11267.endd
11268Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11269variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11270
11271.vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11272 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11273.cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11274This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11275exists in the message. For example,
11276.code
11277${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11278.endd
11279&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11280the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11281
11282.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11283 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11284.cindex "string" "comparison"
11285.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11286.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11287.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11288The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11289resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11290letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11291case is defined per the system C locale.
11292
11293.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11294.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11295.cindex "file" "existence test"
11296.cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11297The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11298condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11299is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11300users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11301
11302.vitem &*first_delivery*&
11303.cindex "delivery" "first"
11304.cindex "first delivery"
11305.cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11306.cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11307This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11308attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11309
11310
11311.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11312 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11313.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11314.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11315.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11316.vindex "&$item$&"
11317These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11318the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11319the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11320The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11321be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11322condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11323.ilist
11324For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11325the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11326items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11327.next
11328For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11329and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11330all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11331.endlist
11332Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11333items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11334that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11335list separator is changed to a comma:
11336.code
11337${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11338.endd
11339The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
11340being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11341
11342To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11343
11344.new
11345.vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11346 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11347 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11348 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11349.cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11350.cindex JSON expansions
11351.cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11352.cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11353.cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11354.cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11355As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11356be a JSON array.
11357The array separator is not changeable.
11358For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11359and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11360.wen
11361
11362
11363
11364.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11365 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11366.cindex "string" "comparison"
11367.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11368.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11369.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11370The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11371string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11372comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11373case-independent.
11374Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11375
11376.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11377 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11378.cindex "string" "comparison"
11379.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11380.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11381.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11382The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11383string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11384includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11385case-independent.
11386Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11387
11388.vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11389 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11390.cindex "string" "comparison"
11391.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11392Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11393strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11394is true.
11395For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11396
11397These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11398Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11399.code
11400${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11401 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11402${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11403 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11404.endd
11405
11406.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11407 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11408 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11409.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11410.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11411.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11412.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11413.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11414The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11415an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11416&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11417
11418For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11419which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11420colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11421hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11422component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11423
11424&*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11425values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11426check.
11427This is no longer the case.
11428
11429The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11430host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11431.code
11432${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11433.endd
11434to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11435
11436.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11437.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11438.cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11439.cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11440This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11441&<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11442queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11443query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11444password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11445server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11446with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11447will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11448of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11449this can be used.
11450
11451
11452.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11453 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11454.cindex "string" "comparison"
11455.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11456.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11457.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11458The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11459string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11460comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11461case-independent.
11462Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11463
11464.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11465 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11466.cindex "string" "comparison"
11467.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11468.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11469.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11470The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11471string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11472includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11473case-independent.
11474Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11475
11476
11477.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11478.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11479.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11480.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11481The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11482expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11483regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11484escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11485(curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11486premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11487&`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11488For example,
11489.code
11490${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11491.endd
11492If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11493backslashes is also required.
11494
11495The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11496The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11497metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11498and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11499the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11500metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11501All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11502but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11503
11504.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11505At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11506substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11507succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11508will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11509of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11510combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11511variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11512
11513.vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11514.cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11515See &*match_local_part*&.
11516
11517.vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11518.cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11519See &*match_local_part*&.
11520
11521.vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11522.cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11523This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11524be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11525address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11526list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11527.code
11528${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11529.endd
11530The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11531
11532.ilist
11533An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11534.next
11535A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11536.next
11537An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11538useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11539in a single test such as
11540. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11541. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11542. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11543. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11544.code
11545 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11546.endd
11547where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11548.next
11549The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11550.next
11551Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11552even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11553address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11554&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11555masks. For example:
11556.code
11557 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11558.endd
11559It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11560do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11561address mask, for example:
11562.code
11563 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11564.endd
11565However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11566just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11567.code
11568 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11569.endd
11570.endlist ilist
11571
11572Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11573Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11574
11575Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11576
11577.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11578.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11579.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11580.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11581.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11582This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11583possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11584condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11585example is:
11586.code
11587${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11588.endd
11589In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11590list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11591is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11592Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11593.code
11594${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11595.endd
11596.cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11597For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11598item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11599have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11600caselessly.
11601
11602Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11603Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11604
11605&*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11606hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11607how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11608matched using &%match_ip%&.
11609
11610.vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11611.cindex "PAM authentication"
11612.cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11613.cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11614.cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11615.cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11616&'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11617(&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11618available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11619distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11620the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11621.code
11622SUPPORT_PAM=yes
11623.endd
11624in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11625in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11626
11627The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11628colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11629The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11630taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11631The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11632from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11633request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11634
11635There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11636characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11637separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11638item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11639of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11640.code
11641server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11642.endd
11643For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11644.code
11645server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11646.endd
11647In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11648running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11649messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11650. --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11651
11652
11653.vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11654.cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11655.cindex "Cyrus"
11656.cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11657.cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11658This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11659This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11660that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11661deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11662
11663The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11664the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11665building Exim. For example:
11666.code
11667CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11668.endd
11669You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11670the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11671from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11672access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11673
11674The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11675password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11676configuration, you might have this:
11677.code
11678server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11679.endd
11680Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11681.code
11682server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11683.endd
11684.vitem &*queue_running*&
11685.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11686.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11687.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11688This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11689initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11690
11691
11692.vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11693.cindex "Radius"
11694.cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11695.cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11696Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11697set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11698the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11699support.
11700
11701With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11702library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11703this library, you need to set
11704.code
11705RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11706.endd
11707in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11708&%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11709.code
11710RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11711.endd
11712in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11713You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11714Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11715
11716The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11717Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11718the authentication is successful. For example:
11719.code
11720server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11721.endd
11722
11723
11724.vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11725 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11726.cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11727.cindex "Cyrus"
11728.cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11729.cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11730This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11731daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11732Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11733by a process that is not running as root.
11734
11735The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11736the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11737building Exim. For example:
11738.code
11739CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11740.endd
11741You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11742the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11743from the Cyrus SASL library.
11744
11745Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11746two are mandatory. For example:
11747.code
11748server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11749.endd
11750The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11751in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11752realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11753.endlist vlist
11754
11755
11756
11757.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11758.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11759Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11760and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11761conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11762sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11763the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11764
11765
11766.vlist
11767.vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11768.cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11769.cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11770The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11771any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11772For example,
11773.code
11774${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11775.endd
11776When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11777evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11778numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11779
11780.vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11781.cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11782.cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11783The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11784all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11785sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11786the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11787parsed but not evaluated.
11788.endlist
11789.ecindex IIDexpcond
11790
11791
11792
11793
11794.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11795.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11796This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11797of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11798support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11799
11800.vlist
11801.vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11802.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11803When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11804captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11805processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11806In the expansion condition case
11807they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11808values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11809variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11810precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11811Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11812matching condition.
11813
11814.vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11815Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11816any arguments are copied to these variables,
11817any unused variables being made empty.
11818
11819.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11820Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11821can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11822long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11823example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11824variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11825used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11826same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11827with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11828during subsequent delivery.
11829
11830.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11831These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11832are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11833received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11834message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11835also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11836message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11837and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11838delivery.
11839
11840.vitem &$acl_narg$&
11841Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11842this variable has the number of arguments.
11843
11844.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11845.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11846After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11847message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11848be preserved by coding like this:
11849.code
11850warn !verify = sender
11851 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11852.endd
11853You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11854&%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11855failure.
11856
11857.vitem &$address_data$&
11858.vindex "&$address_data$&"
11859This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11860value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11861and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11862the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11863for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11864user filter files.
11865
11866If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11867a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11868conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11869to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11870of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11871from the child's routing.
11872
11873If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11874sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11875&$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11876address.
11877
11878In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11879after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11880these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11881
11882.vitem &$address_file$&
11883.vindex "&$address_file$&"
11884When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11885to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11886is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11887default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11888.code
11889/home/r2d2/savemail
11890.endd
11891then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11892contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11893.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11894For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11895then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11896to the relevant file.
11897
11898.vitem &$address_pipe$&
11899.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11900When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11901this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11902
11903.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11904.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11905These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11906&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11907
11908.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11909.cindex "authentication" "id"
11910.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11911When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11912preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11913&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11914user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11915in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11916&$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11917
11918When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11919the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11920process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11921command line option.
11922This second case also sets up information used by the
11923&$authresults$& expansion item.
11924
11925.vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11926.cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11927.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11928When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11929will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11930id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11931available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11932A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11933authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11934the ACL's as well.
11935
11936
11937.vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11938.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11939.cindex "authentication" "sender"
11940.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11941.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11942When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11943SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11944described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11945&"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11946available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11947sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11948
11949.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11950When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11951value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11952name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11953can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11954
11955
11956.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11957.cindex "authentication" "failure"
11958.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11959This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11960command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11961possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11962(&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11963&"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11964is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11965negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11966an undefined mechanism.
11967
11968.vitem &$av_failed$&
11969.cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11970This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11971extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11972problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11973the ACL malware condition.
11974
11975.vitem &$body_linecount$&
11976.cindex "message body" "line count"
11977.cindex "body of message" "line count"
11978.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11979When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11980number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11981
11982.vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11983.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11984.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11985.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11986.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11987When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11988number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11989
11990.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
11991.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
11992This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
11993it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
11994chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
11995
11996.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
11997.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
11998This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
11999up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12000file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12001
12002.vitem &$caller_gid$&
12003.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12004.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12005The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12006not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12007&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12008incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12009
12010.vitem &$caller_uid$&
12011.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12012.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12013The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12014not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12015&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12016incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12017
12018.vitem &$callout_address$&
12019.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12020After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12021address that was connected to.
12022
12023.vitem &$compile_number$&
12024.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12025The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12026of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12027compilations of the same version of Exim.
12028
12029.vitem &$config_dir$&
12030.vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12031The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12032&$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12033contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12034&$config_dir$& is ".".
12035
12036.vitem &$config_file$&
12037.vindex "&$config_file$&"
12038The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12039
12040.vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12041Results of DKIM verification.
12042For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12043
12044.vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12045 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12046 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12047 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12048 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12049 &$dkim_algo$& &&&
12050 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12051 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12052 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12053 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12054 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12055 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12056 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12057 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12058 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12059 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12060 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12061 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12062 &$dkim_key_length$&
12063These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12064For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12065
12066.vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12067.vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12068When a message has been received this variable contains
12069a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12070For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12071
12072.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12073 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12074 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12075 &$dnslist_value$&
12076.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12077.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12078.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12079.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12080.cindex "black list (DNS)"
12081When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12082the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12083looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12084main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12085
12086.vitem &$domain$&
12087.vindex "&$domain$&"
12088When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12089contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12090case for &$domain$&.
12091
12092Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12093&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12094is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12095message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12096
12097When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12098RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12099have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12100at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12101the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12102which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12103
12104.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12105At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12106set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12107
12108The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12109
12110.ilist
12111When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12112the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12113&$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12114normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12115is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12116&$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12117the &(smtp)& transport.
12118
12119.next
12120When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12121&$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12122it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12123rewrite domains by file lookup.
12124
12125.next
12126With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12127&$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12128a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12129is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12130that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12131recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12132
12133.next
12134.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12135.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12136When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12137the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12138.endlist
12139
12140
12141.vitem &$domain_data$&
12142.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12143When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12144means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12145of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12146address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12147transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12148used.
12149
12150&$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12151domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12152the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12153to nothing.
12154
12155.vitem &$exim_gid$&
12156.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12157This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12158
12159.vitem &$exim_path$&
12160.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12161This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12162
12163.vitem &$exim_uid$&
12164.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12165This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12166
12167.vitem &$exim_version$&
12168.vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12169This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12170The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12171Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12172There may be other characters following the minor version.
12173
12174.vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12175This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12176inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12177be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12178characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12179See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12180
12181.vitem &$headers_added$&
12182.vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12183Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12184the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12185The headers are a newline-separated list.
12186
12187.vitem &$home$&
12188.vindex "&$home$&"
12189When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12190directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12191means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12192explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12193by a setting on the transport itself.
12194
12195When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12196of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12197&%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12198
12199.vitem &$host$&
12200.vindex "&$host$&"
12201If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12202list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12203to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12204to local and remote transports.
12205
12206.cindex "transport" "filter"
12207.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12208For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12209&$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12210particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12211using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12212&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12213is connected.
12214
12215When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12216&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12217client is connected.
12218
12219
12220.vitem &$host_address$&
12221.vindex "&$host_address$&"
12222This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12223for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12224when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12225
12226.vitem &$host_data$&
12227.vindex "&$host_data$&"
12228If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12229result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12230allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12231.code
12232deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12233message = $host_data
12234.endd
12235.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12236.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12237.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12238This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12239message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12240name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12241variables is set to &"1"&.
12242
12243.ilist
12244If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12245succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12246
12247.next
12248If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12249tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12250lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12251.endlist ilist
12252
12253Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12254single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12255names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12256is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12257&$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12258IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12259sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12260lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12261the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12262&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12263
12264.cindex authentication "expansion item"
12265Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12266&$authresults$& expansion item.
12267
12268
12269.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12270.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12271See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12272
12273.vitem &$host_port$&
12274.vindex "&$host_port$&"
12275This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12276for an outbound connection.
12277
12278.vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12279.vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12280This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12281directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12282working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12283to &$spool_directory$& later.
12284
12285.vitem &$inode$&
12286.vindex "&$inode$&"
12287The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12288option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12289of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12290a unique name for the file.
12291
12292.vitem &$interface_address$&
12293.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12294This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12295
12296.vitem &$interface_port$&
12297.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12298This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12299
12300.vitem &$item$&
12301.vindex "&$item$&"
12302This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12303conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12304&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12305empty.
12306
12307.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
12308.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12309This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12310contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12311lookup.
12312
12313.vitem &$load_average$&
12314.vindex "&$load_average$&"
12315This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12316is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12317variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12318
12319.vitem &$local_part$&
12320.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12321When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12322variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12323delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12324session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12325
12326Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12327&$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12328&$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12329because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12330once.
12331
12332.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12333.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12334.cindex affix variables
12335If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12336value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12337any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12338&$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12339
12340When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12341result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12342the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12343&$address_pipe$&).
12344
12345When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12346local part of the recipient address.
12347
12348When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12349&$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12350it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12351
12352In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12353the addresses
12354.code
12355"abc:xyz"@test.example
12356abc\:xyz@test.example
12357.endd
12358the value of &$local_part$& is
12359.code
12360abc:xyz
12361.endd
12362If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12363inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12364have:
12365.code
12366data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12367.endd
12368&*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12369to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12370&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12371
12372.vitem &$local_part_data$&
12373.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12374When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12375lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12376router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12377to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12378handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12379
12380&$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12381matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12382available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12383variable expands to nothing.
12384
12385.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12386.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12387.cindex affix variables
12388When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12389specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12390variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12391
12392.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12393.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12394When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12395specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12396variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12397
12398.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12399.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12400This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12401a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12402
12403.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12404.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12405See &$local_user_uid$&.
12406
12407.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12408.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12409This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12410&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12411are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12412and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12413router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12414are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12415
12416.vitem &$localhost_number$&
12417.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12418This contains the expanded value of the
12419&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12420been read.
12421
12422.vitem &$log_inodes$&
12423.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12424The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12425log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12426referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12427the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12428
12429.vitem &$log_space$&
12430.vindex "&$log_space$&"
12431The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12432partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12433whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12434ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12435the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12436
12437
12438.vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12439.vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12440This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12441a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12442.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12443It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12444&"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12445and &"yes"& if it was.
12446Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12447the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12448as authenticated data.
12449
12450.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12451.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12452This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12453&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12454&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12455contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12456without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12457variable is empty.
12458
12459.vitem &$malware_name$&
12460.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12461This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12462content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12463when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12464
12465.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12466.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12467.cindex "maximum" "line length"
12468.cindex "line length" "maximum"
12469This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12470received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12471character(s).
12472It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12473
12474.vitem &$message_age$&
12475.cindex "message" "age of"
12476.vindex "&$message_age$&"
12477This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12478of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12479delivery attempt.
12480
12481.vitem &$message_body$&
12482.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12483.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12484.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12485.vindex "&$message_body$&"
12486.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12487This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12488being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12489number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12490&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12491
12492.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12493By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12494easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12495this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12496zeros are always converted into spaces.
12497
12498.vitem &$message_body_end$&
12499.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12500.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12501.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12502This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12503body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12504&$message_body$&.
12505
12506.vitem &$message_body_size$&
12507.cindex "body of message" "size"
12508.cindex "message body" "size"
12509.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12510When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12511in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12512separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12513also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12514
12515If the spool file is wireformat
12516(see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12517the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12518
12519.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12520.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12521When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12522unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12523An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12524received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12525line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12526&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12527
12528.vitem &$message_headers$&
12529.vindex &$message_headers$&
12530This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12531is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12532lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12533same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12534
12535.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12536.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12537This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12538contents of header lines is done.
12539
12540.vitem &$message_id$&
12541This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12542
12543.vitem &$message_linecount$&
12544.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12545This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12546message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12547During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12548number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12549routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12550&'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12551lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12552from the body is not counted.
12553
12554As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12555appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12556&$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12557file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12558header and the body).
12559
12560Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12561.code
12562deny message = Too many lines in message header
12563 condition = \
12564 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12565.endd
12566In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12567message has not yet been received.
12568
12569This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12570
12571.vitem &$message_size$&
12572.cindex "size" "of message"
12573.cindex "message" "size"
12574.vindex "&$message_size$&"
12575When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12576most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12577message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12578deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12579expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12580doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12581precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12582&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12583
12584.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12585While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12586contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12587value may not, of course, be truthful.
12588
12589.vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12590A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12591available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12592details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12593
12594.vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12595These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12596of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12597
12598.vitem &$original_domain$&
12599.vindex "&$domain$&"
12600.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12601When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12602same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12603generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12604variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12605differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12606aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12607single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12608
12609If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12610filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12611part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12612
12613.vitem &$original_local_part$&
12614.vindex "&$local_part$&"
12615.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12616When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12617same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12618local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12619part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12620filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12621the original address.
12622
12623If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12624case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12625This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12626one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12627delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12628
12629If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12630filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12631part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12632
12633.vitem &$originator_gid$&
12634.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12635.cindex "sender" "gid"
12636.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12637.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12638This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12639message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12640gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12641normally the gid of the Exim user.
12642
12643.vitem &$originator_uid$&
12644.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12645.cindex "sender" "uid"
12646.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12647.vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12648The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12649messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12650For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12651user.
12652
12653.vitem &$parent_domain$&
12654.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12655This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12656above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12657
12658.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12659.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12660This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12661(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12662
12663.vitem &$pid$&
12664.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12665.vindex "&$pid$&"
12666This variable contains the current process id.
12667
12668.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12669.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12670.cindex "transport" "filter"
12671.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12672This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12673&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12674&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12675(described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12676It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12677variable"& error if encountered.
12678
12679.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12680.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12681This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12682configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12683a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12684&[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12685qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12686
12687
12688.vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12689 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12690 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12691 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12692 &$proxy_session$&
12693These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12694or SOCKS5 support.
12695For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12696
12697.vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12698.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12699This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12700current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12701
12702.vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12703This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12704which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12705&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12706
12707.vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12708This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12709which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12710&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12711
12712.vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12713This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12714which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12715&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12716
12717.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12718.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12719The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12720
12721.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12722.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12723The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12724or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12725
12726.vitem &$queue_name$&
12727.vindex &$queue_name$&
12728.cindex "named queues"
12729.cindex queues named
12730The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12731
12732.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12733.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12734When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12735RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12736RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12737
12738.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12739.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12740.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12741When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12742RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12743temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12744
12745.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12746.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12747When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12748RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12749permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12750
12751.vitem &$received_count$&
12752.vindex "&$received_count$&"
12753This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12754including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12755is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12756delivering.
12757
12758.vitem &$received_for$&
12759.vindex "&$received_for$&"
12760If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12761variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12762built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12763the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12764
12765.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12766.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12767As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12768variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12769is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12770&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12771the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12772option.
12773
12774As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12775could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
12776on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12777values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12778messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12779time.
12780For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12781
12782.vitem &$received_port$&
12783.vindex "&$received_port$&"
12784See &$received_ip_address$&.
12785
12786.vitem &$received_protocol$&
12787.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12788When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12789protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12790by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12791&"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12792(encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12793is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12794connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12795
12796Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12797automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12798&%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12799encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12800where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12801STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12802
12803The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12804messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12805identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12806
12807.vitem &$received_time$&
12808.vindex "&$received_time$&"
12809This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12810as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12811
12812.vitem &$recipient_data$&
12813.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12814This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12815condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12816until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12817.display
12818&`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12819&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12820.endd
12821&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12822method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12823The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12824expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12825
12826.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12827.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12828In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12829information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12830
12831.ilist
12832&"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12833was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12834
12835.next
12836&"route"&: Routing failed.
12837
12838.next
12839&"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12840or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12841MAIL).
12842
12843.next
12844&"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12845.next
12846
12847&"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12848.endlist
12849
12850The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12851rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12852
12853.vitem &$recipients$&
12854.vindex "&$recipients$&"
12855This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12856a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12857is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12858unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12859cases:
12860
12861.olist
12862In a system filter file.
12863.next
12864In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12865is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12866&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12867&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12868.next
12869From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12870.endlist
12871
12872
12873.vitem &$recipients_count$&
12874.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12875When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12876envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12877from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12878increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12879
12880
12881.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12882.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12883This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12884&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12885
12886.vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12887.cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12888When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12889these variables contain the
12890captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12891
12892
12893.vitem &$reply_address$&
12894.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12895When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12896&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12897contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12898white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12899decoding or character code translation takes place.
12900
12901.vitem &$return_path$&
12902.vindex "&$return_path$&"
12903When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12904the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12905in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12906same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12907mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12908for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12909address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12910that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12911the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12912envelope sender.
12913
12914.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12915.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12916This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12917
12918.vitem &$router_name$&
12919.cindex "router" "name"
12920.cindex "name" "of router"
12921.vindex "&$router_name$&"
12922During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12923
12924.vitem &$runrc$&
12925.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12926.vindex "&$runrc$&"
12927This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12928&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12929assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12930preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12931reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12932another.
12933
12934.vitem &$self_hostname$&
12935.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12936.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12937When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12938local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12939One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12940happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12941original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12942
12943.vitem &$sender_address$&
12944.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12945When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12946that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12947is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12948value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12949
12950.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12951.vindex "&$address_data$&"
12952.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12953If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12954sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12955distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12956after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12957longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12958
12959.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12960.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12961The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12962
12963.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12964.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12965The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12966
12967.vitem &$sender_data$&
12968.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12969This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12970in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12971value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12972this:
12973.display
12974&`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12975&`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12976.endd
12977&*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12978method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12979The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12980expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12981
12982.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12983.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12984When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12985name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12986brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12987enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12988issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12989looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12990&%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
12991start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
12992verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
12993the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
12994the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
12995
12996.vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
12997.vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
12998This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
12999.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13000done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13001
13002.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13003.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13004When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13005command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13006set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13007the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13008
13009.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13010.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13011When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13012this variable contains that
13013host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13014
13015.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13016.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13017This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13018driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13019received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13020&$authenticated_id$&.
13021
13022.vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13023.vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13024If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13025(by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13026otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13027resolver library states that both
13028the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13029other times, this variable is false.
13030
13031.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13032It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13033library, by setting:
13034.code
13035dns_dnssec_ok = 1
13036.endd
13037
13038Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13039validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13040
13041If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13042mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13043
13044This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13045DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13046all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13047is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13048
13049
13050.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13051.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13052When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13053host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13054other means, this variable is empty.
13055
13056.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13057If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13058&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13059A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13060via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13061any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13062&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13063
13064.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13065However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13066DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13067&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13068
13069Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13070host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13071in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13072is set to &"1"&.
13073
13074Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13075maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13076these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13077following are true:
13078
13079.ilist
13080A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13081.next
13082The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13083configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13084to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13085.next
13086Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13087that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13088&<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13089.next
13090The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13091In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13092EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13093.next
13094The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13095domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13096. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13097. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13098.code
13099 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13100.endd
13101which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13102IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13103.endlist
13104
13105
13106.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13107.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13108When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13109number that was used on the remote host.
13110
13111.vitem &$sender_ident$&
13112.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13113When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13114identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13115been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13116called Exim.
13117
13118.vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13119A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13120&%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13121&<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13122
13123.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13124.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13125.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13126.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13127This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13128either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13129there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13130there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13131the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13132followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13133first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13134the parentheses.
13135
13136There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13137was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13138address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13139all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13140into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13141
13142.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13143.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13144In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13145about the failure. The details are the same as for
13146&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13147
13148.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13149.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13150This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13151been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13152used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13153on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13154connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13155
13156.vitem &$sending_port$&
13157.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13158This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13159been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13160connections, see &$received_port$&.
13161
13162.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13163.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13164During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13165host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13166&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13167value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13168
13169.vitem &$smtp_command$&
13170.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13171During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13172entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13173the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13174.code
13175MAIL FROM:<>
13176MAIL FROM: <>
13177.endd
13178For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13179command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13180rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13181the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13182
13183.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13184.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13185.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13186While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13187argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13188space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13189somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13190
13191.vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13192.cindex SMTP "command history"
13193.vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13194A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13195received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13196are remembered.
13197
13198.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13199.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13200This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13201daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13202in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13203connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13204the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13205never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13206there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13207single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13208daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13209
13210.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13211These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13212that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13213filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13214example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13215message is junk mail.
13216
13217.vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13218A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13219is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13220&<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13221
13222.vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13223 &$spf_received$& &&&
13224 &$spf_result$& &&&
13225 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13226 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13227These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13228For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13229
13230.vitem &$spool_directory$&
13231.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13232The name of Exim's spool directory.
13233
13234.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13235.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13236The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13237being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13238If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13239is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13240
13241.vitem &$spool_space$&
13242.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13243The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13244Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13245variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13246find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13247value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13248megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13249.code
13250condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13251.endd
13252See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13253
13254
13255.vitem &$thisaddress$&
13256.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13257This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13258command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13259command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13260interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13261
13262.vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13263.vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13264Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13265on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13266this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13267If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13268The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13269when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13270
13271The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13272except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13273the outbound.
13274
13275.vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13276.vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13277Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13278on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13279this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13280If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13281
13282.vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13283.vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13284.cindex certificate variables
13285This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13286inbound connection when the message was received.
13287It is only useful as the argument of a
13288&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13289or a &%def%& condition.
13290
13291&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13292when a list of more than one
13293file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13294
13295.vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13296.vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13297This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13298inbound connection when the message was received.
13299It is only useful as the argument of a
13300&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13301or a &%def%& condition.
13302If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13303which is not the leaf.
13304
13305.vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13306.vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13307This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13308outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13309&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13310or a &%def%& condition.
13311
13312.vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13313.vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13314This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13315outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13316&%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13317or a &%def%& condition.
13318If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13319which is not the leaf.
13320
13321.vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13322.vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13323This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13324message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13325
13326The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13327except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13328the outbound.
13329
13330.vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13331.vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13332This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13333outbound SMTP connection was made,
13334and &"0"& otherwise.
13335
13336.vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13337.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13338.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13339When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13340connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13341example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13342received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13343&$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13344non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13345
13346The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13347but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13348becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13349
13350.new
13351.vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13352.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13353As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13354.wen
13355
13356.vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13357.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13358This variable is
13359cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13360and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13361&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13362details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13363
13364,new
13365.vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13366.vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13367As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13368.wen
13369
13370.vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13371.vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13372DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13373
13374.vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13375.vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13376When a message is received from a remote client connection
13377the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13378.code
133790 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
133801 No response to request
133812 Response not verified
133823 Verification failed
133834 Verification succeeded
13384.endd
13385
13386.vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13387.vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13388When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13389the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13390See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13391
13392.vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13393.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13394.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13395.cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13396When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13397connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13398the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13399&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13400If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13401which is not the leaf.
13402
13403The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13404except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13405the outbound.
13406
13407.vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13408.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13409When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13410connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13411the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13412&$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13413If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13414which is not the leaf.
13415
13416.vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13417.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13418.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13419.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13420When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13421Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13422If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13423some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13424will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13425a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13426used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13427
13428The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13429except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13430the outbound.
13431
13432.vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13433.vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13434.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13435During outbound
13436SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13437the transport.
13438
13439.vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13440.vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13441Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13442
13443.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13444.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13445The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13446files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13447
13448.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13449.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13450The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13451
13452.vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13453.vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13454The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13455
13456.vitem &$tod_full$&
13457.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13458A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13459+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13460positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13461values for those that are behind (west).
13462
13463.vitem &$tod_log$&
13464.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13465The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
134661995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13467
13468.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13469.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13470This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13471is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13472flag.
13473
13474.vitem &$tod_zone$&
13475.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13476This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13477-0500.
13478
13479.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13480.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13481This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13482by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13483
13484.vitem &$transport_name$&
13485.cindex "transport" "name"
13486.cindex "name" "of transport"
13487.vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13488During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13489
13490.vitem &$value$&
13491.vindex "&$value$&"
13492This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13493or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13494&*reduce*& expansion.
13495
13496.vitem &$verify_mode$&
13497.vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13498While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13499contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13500Otherwise, empty.
13501
13502.vitem &$version_number$&
13503.vindex "&$version_number$&"
13504The version number of Exim.
13505
13506.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13507.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13508This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13509delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13510
13511.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13512.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13513This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13514delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13515.endlist
13516.ecindex IIDstrexp
13517
13518
13519
13520. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13521. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13522
13523.chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13524.scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13525Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13526Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13527use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13528your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13529the line
13530.code
13531EXIM_PERL = perl.o
13532.endd
13533in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13534
13535
13536.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13537.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13538Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13539&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13540no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13541interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13542the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13543option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13544a newly created Perl interpreter.
13545
13546The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13547need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13548should usually be something like
13549.code
13550perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13551.endd
13552where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13553use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13554soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13555the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13556its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13557fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13558necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13559the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13560two ways:
13561
13562.ilist
13563.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13564Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13565a startup when Exim is entered.
13566.next
13567The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13568overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13569.endlist
13570
13571There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13572initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13573
13574.ilist
13575.oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13576.cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13577To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13578interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13579taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13580option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13581defaults to false.
13582
13583
13584.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13585When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13586of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13587by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13588forms:
13589.code
13590${perl{foo}}
13591${perl{foo}{argument}}
13592${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13593.endd
13594which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13595arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13596with an error message of the form
13597.code
13598Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13599.endd
13600The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13601it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13602return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13603an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13604by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13605that was passed to &%die%&.
13606
13607
13608.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13609Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13610is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13611the Perl code
13612.code
13613my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13614.endd
13615makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13616Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13617&$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13618
13619If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13620&'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13621expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13622an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13623
13624.cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13625.cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13626Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13627&'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13628debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13629&'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13630timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13631
13632
13633.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13634.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13635You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13636Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13637before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13638SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13639is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13640error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13641avoided, but the output is lost.
13642
13643.cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13644The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13645Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13646you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13647output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13648change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13649For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13650.code
13651$SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13652.endd
13653Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13654example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13655include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13656as the first subroutine argument.
13657.ecindex IIDperl
13658
13659
13660. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13661. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13662
13663.chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13664 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13665 "Starting the daemon"
13666.cindex "daemon" "starting"
13667.cindex "interface" "listening"
13668.cindex "network interface"
13669.cindex "interface" "network"
13670.cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13671.cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13672.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13673.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13674A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13675hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13676or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13677works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13678In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13679IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13680knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13681
13682.olist
13683When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13684and ports to listen on.
13685.next
13686When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13687are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13688processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13689same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13690when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13691local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13692option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13693as an error situation.
13694.next
13695When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13696for the outgoing connection.
13697.endlist
13698
13699
13700Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13701of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13702addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13703standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13704rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13705
13706In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13707interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13708options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13709chapter describes how they operate.
13710
13711When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13712actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13713
13714
13715
13716.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13717When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13718option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13719following options:
13720
13721.ilist
13722&%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13723or service names.
13724(For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13725.next
13726&%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13727listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13728.endlist
13729
13730The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13731described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13732it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13733colons. For example:
13734.code
13735local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13736 192.168.23.65 ; \
13737 ::1 ; \
13738 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13739.endd
13740There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13741in &%local_interfaces%&:
13742
13743.olist
13744The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13745on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13746.code
13747local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13748 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13749.endd
13750.next
13751The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13752with a colon separator, for example:
13753.code
13754local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13755 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13756.endd
13757.endlist
13758
13759When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13760default setting contains just one port:
13761.code
13762daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13763.endd
13764If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13765specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13766&%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13767&_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13768IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13769
13770
13771
13772.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13773The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13774as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13775case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13776instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13777default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13778.code
13779local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13780.endd
13781when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13782.code
13783local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13784.endd
13785Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13786
13787
13788
13789.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13790The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13791&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13792instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13793option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13794the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13795exim.
13796
13797The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13798changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
13799If there are any items that do not
13800contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13801&%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13802items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13803replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13804.code
13805-oX 1225
13806.endd
13807overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13808whereas
13809.code
13810-oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13811.endd
13812overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13813(However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13814value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13815
13816
13817
13818.section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13819.cindex "submissions protocol"
13820.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13821.cindex "smtps protocol"
13822.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13823.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13824Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13825&"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13826For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13827STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13828the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13829If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13830(Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13831the 465 TCP ports.
13832
13833If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13834service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13835proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13836
13837The common use of this option is expected to be
13838.code
13839tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13840.endd
13841per RFC 8314.
13842There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13843to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13844
13845&*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13846daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13847&%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13848because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13849connections via the daemon.)
13850
13851
13852
13853
13854.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13855.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13856IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13857can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13858interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13859address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13860percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13861adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13862.code
13863fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13864.endd
13865To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13866allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13867to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13868percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13869address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13870&[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13871.code
13872IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13873.endd
13874is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13875Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13876instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13877function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13878&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13879
13880.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13881.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13882Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13883run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13884using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13885connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13886.oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13887&%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13888activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13889that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13890etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13891to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13892
13893On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13894disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13895option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13896and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13897IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13898
13899
13900
13901.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13902The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13903.code
13904daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13905local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13906.endd
13907This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13908Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13909the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13910read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13911
13912To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13913.code
13914daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13915.endd
13916(leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13917.code
13918local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13919 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13920.endd
13921To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13922IPv4 loopback address only:
13923.code
13924local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13925.endd
13926To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13927.code
13928local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13929.endd
13930&*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13931
13932
13933
13934.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13935The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13936whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13937addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13938treated as local.
13939
13940For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13941the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13942available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13943(that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13944
13945Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13946many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13947email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13948interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13949&%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13950&"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13951used for listening. Consider this example:
13952.code
13953local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13954 192.168.53.235 ; \
13955 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13956
13957extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13958.endd
13959The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13960address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13961Exim is routing.
13962
13963In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13964address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13965desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13966these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13967This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13968during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13969host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13970addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13971
13972
13973
13974.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13975Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13976allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13977there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13978&%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13979description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13980details.
13981
13982
13983
13984
13985. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13986. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13987
13988.chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13989.scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13990.scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
13991The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
13992
13993.ilist
13994Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
13995&<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
13996.next
13997Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
13998&"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
13999section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14000.next
14001Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14002(with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14003&"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14004only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14005settings.
14006.endlist
14007
14008This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14009types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14010in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14011are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14012an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14013listed in more than one group.
14014
14015.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14016.table2
14017.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14018.row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14019.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14020.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14021.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14022.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14023.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14024.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14025.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14026.row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14027.row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14028.endtable
14029
14030
14031.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14032.table2
14033.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14034.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14035.row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14036.row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14037.row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14038.row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14039.endtable
14040
14041
14042
14043.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14044.table2
14045.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14046.row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14047.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14048.row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14049.row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14050.row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14051.row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14052.row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14053.row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14054.row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14055.row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14056.row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14057.endtable
14058
14059
14060
14061.section "Logging" "SECID99"
14062.table2
14063.row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14064.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14065.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14066.row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14067.row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14068.row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14069.row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14070.row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14071.row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14072.row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14073.row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14074.row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14075.row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14076.row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14077.row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14078.endtable
14079
14080
14081
14082.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14083.table2
14084.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14085.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14086.row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14087.row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14088.endtable
14089
14090
14091
14092.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14093.table2
14094.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14095.row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14096.row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14097.row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14098.row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14099.row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14100.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14101.row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14102.row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14103.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14104.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14105.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14106.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14107.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14108.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14109.endtable
14110
14111
14112
14113.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14114.table2
14115.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14116.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14117.endtable
14118
14119
14120
14121.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14122.table2
14123.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14124.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14125.row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14126.endtable
14127
14128
14129
14130.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14131.table2
14132.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14133.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14134.row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14135.row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14136.row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14137.row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14138.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14139.endtable
14140
14141
14142
14143.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14144.table2
14145.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14146.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14147.row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14148.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14149.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14150.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14151.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14152.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14153.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14154.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14155.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14156.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14157.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14158.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14159.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14160.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14161 connection"
14162.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14163.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14164.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14165.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14166.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14167.endtable
14168
14169
14170
14171.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14172.table2
14173.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14174.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14175.row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14176.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14177.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14178.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14179.row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14180.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14181.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14182.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14183.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14184.row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14185.row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14186.row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14187.row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14188.row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14189.row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14190.row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14191.row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14192.row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14193.row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14194.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14195 words""&"
14196.row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14197.row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14198.row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14199.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14200.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14201.row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14202.row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14203.row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14204.row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14205.row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14206.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14207.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14208.row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14209.row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14210.row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14211.row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14212.row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14213.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14214.row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14215.row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14216.endtable
14217
14218
14219
14220.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14221.table2
14222.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14223 item"
14224.row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14225 item"
14226.row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14227.row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14228.row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14229.endtable
14230
14231
14232
14233.section "TLS" "SECID108"
14234.table2
14235.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14236.row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14237.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14238.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14239.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14240.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14241.row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14242.row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14243.row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14244.row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14245.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14246.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14247.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14248.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14249.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14250.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14251.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14252.endtable
14253
14254
14255
14256.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14257.table2
14258.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14259.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14260.row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14261.row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14262.row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14263.row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14264.row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14265.row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14266.endtable
14267
14268
14269
14270.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14271.table2
14272.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14273.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14274.row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14275.row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14276.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14277.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14278.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14279.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14280.endtable
14281
14282
14283
14284
14285.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14286.table2
14287.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14288.endtable
14289
14290
14291
14292
14293
14294.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14295See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14296
14297.table2
14298.row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
14299.row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14300.row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14301.row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14302.row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14303.row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14304.row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14305.row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14306.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14307.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14308.row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14309.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14310.row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14311.row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14312.row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14313 connection"
14314.row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14315.row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14316.row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14317.row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14318.row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14319.row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14320.row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14321.row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14322.row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14323.row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14324.row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14325.row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14326.row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14327.row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14328.row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14329.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14330.endtable
14331
14332
14333
14334.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14335.table2
14336.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14337.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14338.row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14339.row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14340.row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14341.row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14342.row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14343.row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14344.row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14345.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14346.endtable
14347
14348
14349
14350.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14351.table2
14352.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14353.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14354.row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14355.row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14356 words""&"
14357.row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14358.row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14359.row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14360.row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14361.row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14362.row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14363.row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14364.row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14365.row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14366.row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14367.endtable
14368
14369
14370
14371.section "System filter" "SECID115"
14372.table2
14373.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14374.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14375 directory"
14376.row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14377.row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14378.row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14379.row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14380.row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14381.endtable
14382
14383
14384
14385.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14386.table2
14387.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14388.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14389.row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14390.row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14391.row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14392.row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14393.row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14394.row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14395.row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14396.row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14397.row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14398.row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14399.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14400.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14401.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14402.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14403.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14404.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14405.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14406.row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14407.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14408.row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14409.row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14410.row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14411.endtable
14412
14413
14414
14415.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14416.table2
14417.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14418.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14419.row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14420.row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14421.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14422.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14423.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14424.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14425.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14426.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14427.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14428.row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14429.row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14430.row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14431.row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14432.endtable
14433
14434
14435
14436.section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14437Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14438&dagger;.
14439
14440.option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14441.cindex "8BITMIME"
14442.cindex "8-bit characters"
14443.cindex "log" "selectors"
14444.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14445This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14446EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14447However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14448takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14449
14450Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14451feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14452It now defaults to true.
14453A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14454.display
14455&url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14456.endd
14457
14458To log received 8BITMIME status use
14459.code
14460log_selector = +8bitmime
14461.endd
14462
14463.option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14464.cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14465.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14466This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14467read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14468further details.
14469
14470.option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14471This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14472messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14473SMTP messages.
14474
14475.option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14476.cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14477.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14478This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14479non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14480
14481.option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14482.cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14483.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14484This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14485received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14486
14487.option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14488.cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14489This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14490See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14491
14492.option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14493.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14494This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14495processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14496acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14497
14498.option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14499.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14500.cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14501.cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14502.cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14503This option defines the ACL that,
14504if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14505is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14506processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14507acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14508
14509.option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14510.cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14511This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14512(by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14513of a received message.
14514See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14515
14516.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14517.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14518This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14519received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14520
14521.option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14522.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14523This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14524received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14525
14526.option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14527.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14528.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14529This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14530command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14531
14532
14533.option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14534.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14535This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14536received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14537
14538.option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14539.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14540This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14541a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14542&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14543
14544.option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14545.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14546This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14547extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14548section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14549
14550.option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14551.cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14552This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14553ends without a QUIT command being received.
14554See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14555
14556.option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14557This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14558received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14559further details.
14560
14561.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14562.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14563This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14564received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14565
14566.option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14567.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14568This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14569received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14570
14571.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14572.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14573This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14574received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14575
14576.option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14577.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14578This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14579received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14580
14581.option add_environment main "string list" empty
14582.cindex "environment" "set values"
14583This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14584currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14585See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14586
14587.option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14588.cindex "admin user"
14589This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14590current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14591colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14592programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14593admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14594not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14595To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14596
14597.option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14598.cindex "domain literal"
14599If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14600email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14601format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14602has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14603
14604Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14605format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14606addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14607&%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14608domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14609configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14610the local host's IP addresses.
14611
14612
14613.option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14614.cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14615It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14616and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14617MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14618that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14619practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14620&%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14621recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14622
14623.option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14624.cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14625.cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14626Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14627camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14628that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14629experiment if they wish.
14630
14631If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14632UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14633letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14634enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14635adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14636suitable setting is:
14637.code
14638dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14639 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14640.endd
14641Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14642.code
14643dns_check_names_pattern =
14644.endd
14645That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14646
14647
14648.option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14649.cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14650.cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14651If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14652response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14653Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14654Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14655advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14656authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14657&%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14658authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14659
14660Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14661and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14662not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14663authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14664to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14665which Exim advertises AUTH.
14666
14667.cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14668If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14669is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14670option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14671.code
14672auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14673.endd
14674.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14675If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14676the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14677expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14678
14679
14680.option auto_thaw main time 0s
14681.cindex "thawing messages"
14682.cindex "unfreezing messages"
14683If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14684new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14685this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14686being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14687saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14688
14689&*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14690&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14691thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14692
14693
14694.option av_scanner main string "see below"
14695This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14696It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14697.code
14698sophie:/var/run/sophie
14699.endd
14700If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14701before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14702
14703
14704.option bi_command main string unset
14705.oindex "&%-bi%&"
14706This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14707the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14708just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14709required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14710
14711
14712.option bounce_message_file main string unset
14713.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14714.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14715This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14716for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14717chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14718
14719
14720.option bounce_message_text main string unset
14721When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14722message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14723delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14724
14725.option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14726.cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14727This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14728bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14729causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14730value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14731message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14732error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14733point at which the error was detected are returned.
14734.cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14735
14736.option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14737.cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14738.cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14739.cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14740This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14741that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14742when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14743The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14744If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14745treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14746
14747The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14748during reception of a message.
14749In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14750
14751The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14752
14753
14754.option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14755If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14756bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14757&%bounce_return_body%&.
14758
14759
14760.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14761.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14762.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14763.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14764This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14765senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14766limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14767any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14768that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14769
14770When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14771greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14772added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14773to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14774size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14775messages.
14776
14777.option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14778.cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14779.cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14780.cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14781This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14782bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14783connection. A typical setting might be:
14784.code
14785bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14786.endd
14787which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14788.code
14789MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14790.endd
14791The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14792address.
14793
14794.option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14795.cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14796.cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14797This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14798domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14799section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14800
14801
14802.option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14803This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14804domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14805section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14806
14807
14808.option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14809This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14810address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14811section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14812
14813
14814.option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14815This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14816address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14817section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14818
14819
14820.option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14821This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14822callout verification. The default value is
14823.code
14824$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14825.endd
14826See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14827
14828
14829.option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14830See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14831
14832
14833.option check_log_space main integer 10M
14834See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14835
14836.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14837.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14838.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14839RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14840system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14841word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14842multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14843exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14844of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14845set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14846
14847
14848.option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14849See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14850
14851
14852.option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14853.cindex "checking disk space"
14854.cindex "disk space, checking"
14855.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14856The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14857message is accepted.
14858
14859.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14860.vindex "&$log_space$&"
14861.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14862.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14863When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14864want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14865testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14866&$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14867
14868
14869&%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14870either value is greater than zero, for example:
14871.code
14872check_spool_space = 100M
14873check_spool_inodes = 100
14874.endd
14875The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14876SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14877transit.
14878
14879&%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14880files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14881&%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14882
14883If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14884incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14885error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14886SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14887&%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14888&%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14889
14890The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14891number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14892If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14893
14894For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14895failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14896it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14897
14898There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14899Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14900high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14901may wish to deliberately disable them.
14902
14903.option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14904.cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14905.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14906The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14907these hosts.
14908Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14909
14910.option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14911.cindex "restricting access to features"
14912This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14913administrative user.
14914This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14915
14916.option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14917.cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14918.cindex memory debugging
14919This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14920management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14921it should normally be left as default.
14922
14923.option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14924.cindex "port" "for daemon"
14925.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14926This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14927listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14928backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14929
14930.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14931.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14932This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14933the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14934(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14935defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14936&%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14937
14938.option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14939See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14940
14941.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14942.cindex "warning of delay"
14943.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14944.cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14945When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14946intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14947after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14948string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14949message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14950between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14951with
14952.code
14953delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14954.endd
14955the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14956the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14957because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14958just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14959.code
14960delay_warning = 6h
14961.endd
14962messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14963a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14964.code
14965delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14966.endd
14967Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14968which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14969Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14970
14971.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14972.vindex "&$domain$&"
14973The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14974deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14975expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14976forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14977&"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14978not sent. The default is:
14979.code
14980delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14981 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14982 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14983 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14984 } {no}{yes}}
14985.endd
14986This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14987&'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14988&"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14989&"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
14990
14991.option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
14992.cindex "unprivileged delivery"
14993.cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
14994If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
14995delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
14996the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
14997of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
14998chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
14999
15000.option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15001.cindex "load average"
15002.cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15003When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15004becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15005ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15006See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15007
15008
15009.option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15010.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15011Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15012message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15013handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15014should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15015removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15016occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15017
15018.option disable_fsync main boolean false
15019.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15020This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15021ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15022a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15023build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15024really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15025distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15026
15027When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15028updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15029such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15030Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15031
15032
15033.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15034.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15035If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15036activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15037that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15038etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15039to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15040
15041
15042.option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15043.cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15044This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15045It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15046the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15047See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15048
15049
15050.option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15051.cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15052DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15053&"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15054keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15055incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15056may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15057anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15058This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15059by a setting such as this:
15060.code
15061dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15062.endd
15063This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15064&[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15065since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15066&(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15067when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15068options are applied after this global option.
15069
15070.option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15071.cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15072When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15073names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15074the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15075contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15076a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15077done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15078value of this option. The default pattern is
15079.code
15080dns_check_names_pattern = \
15081 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15082.endd
15083which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15084they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15085permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15086accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15087&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15088empty string.
15089
15090.option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15091This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15092DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15093
15094.option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15095This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15096reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15097section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15098
15099.option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15100.cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15101This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15102not do it internally.
15103As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15104If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15105
15106The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15107thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15108given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15109
15110
15111.option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15112.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15113.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15114If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15115DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15116default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15117
15118If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15119
15120
15121.option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15122.cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15123.cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15124.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15125When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15126looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15127(A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15128domain matches this list.
15129
15130This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15131not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15132servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15133
15134
15135.option dns_retrans main time 0s
15136.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15137.cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15138.cindex "DNS" timeout
15139The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15140retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15141defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15142time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15143totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15144take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15145parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15146but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15147to set in them.
15148See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15149
15150
15151.option dns_retry main integer 0
15152See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15153
15154
15155.option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15156.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15157.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15158If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15159(Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15160DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15161match with this expanded domain list.
15162
15163Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15164authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15165bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15166mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15167Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15168a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15169
15170Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15171to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15172zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15173
15174If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15175in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15176authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15177authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15178record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15179
15180.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15181.option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15182.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15183.cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15184.cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15185If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15186DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15187the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15188on.
15189
15190If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15191
15192OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15193means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15194is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15195
15196
15197.option drop_cr main boolean false
15198This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15199handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15200described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15201
15202.option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15203.cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15204.cindex "DSN" "success"
15205.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15206DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15207and accepted from, these hosts.
15208Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15209and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15210A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15211A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15212are sent.
15213
15214.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15215.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15216.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15217This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15218bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15219Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15220.code
15221dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15222.endd
15223The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15224panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15225
15226.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15227.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15228Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15229message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15230handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15231message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15232be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15233the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15234delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15235
15236
15237.option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15238.cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15239.cindex "copy of bounce message"
15240Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15241generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15242coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15243items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15244a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15245must be enclosed in double quotes.
15246
15247Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15248(see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15249the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15250items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15251are examined. For example:
15252.code
15253errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15254 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15255 postmaster@mydomain.example
15256.endd
15257.vindex "&$domain$&"
15258.vindex "&$local_part$&"
15259The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15260and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15261there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15262.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15263variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15264
15265
15266.option errors_reply_to main string unset
15267.cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15268By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15269.display
15270&`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15271.endd
15272.oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15273where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15274A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15275&(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15276overrides the default.
15277
15278Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15279&%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15280and warning messages. For example:
15281.code
15282errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15283.endd
15284The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15285address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15286&%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15287own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15288not used.
15289
15290
15291.option event_action main string&!! unset
15292.cindex events
15293This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15294For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15295
15296
15297.option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15298.cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15299.cindex "Exim group"
15300This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15301privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15302option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15303of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15304configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15305security issues.
15306
15307
15308.option exim_path main string "see below"
15309.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15310This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15311needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15312the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15313is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15314other place.
15315&*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15316you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15317where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15318settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15319
15320
15321.option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15322.cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15323.cindex "Exim user"
15324This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15325privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15326time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15327options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15328
15329Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15330&[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15331not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15332used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15333
15334
15335.option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15336This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15337routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15338&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15339
15340
15341. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15342. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15343
15344.option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15345 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15346.oindex "&%-t%&"
15347.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15348.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15349According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15350are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15351envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15352line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15353behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15354command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15355&%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15356argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15357addresses.
15358
15359
15360.option finduser_retries main integer 0
15361.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15362On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15363distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15364related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15365Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15366errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15367many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15368retries.
15369
15370.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15371You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15372a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15373search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15374
15375
15376
15377.option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15378.cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15379On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15380ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15381delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15382&%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15383feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15384warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15385freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15386is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15387supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15388message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15389freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15390log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15391logging that you require.
15392
15393
15394.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15395.cindex "HP-UX"
15396.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15397Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15398password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15399looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15400headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15401of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15402it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15403upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15404
15405When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15406expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15407login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15408user's name.
15409
15410.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15411Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15412pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15413name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15414.code
15415gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15416gecos_name = $1
15417.endd
15418
15419.option gecos_pattern main string unset
15420See &%gecos_name%& above.
15421
15422
15423.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15424This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15425server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15426implementations of TLS.
15427
15428
15429.option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15430This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15431the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15432
15433See
15434&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15435for documentation.
15436
15437
15438
15439.option headers_charset main string "see below"
15440This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15441&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15442default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15443ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15444insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15445
15446
15447
15448.option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15449.cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15450.cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15451This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15452section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15453&_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15454sections are rejected.
15455
15456
15457.option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15458.cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15459.cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15460This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15461all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15462header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15463zero means &"no limit"&.
15464
15465
15466
15467
15468.option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15469.cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15470.cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15471Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15472mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15473some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15474this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15475if you want to do semantic checking.
15476See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15477set.
15478
15479
15480.option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15481.cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15482.cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15483.cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15484This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15485all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15486hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15487.code
15488helo_allow_chars = _
15489.endd
15490Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15491
15492
15493.option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15494.cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15495.cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15496If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15497list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15498default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15499its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15500do.
15501
15502
15503.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15504.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15505.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15506By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15507&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15508to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15509condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15510Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15511to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15512necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15513encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15514Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15515
15516When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15517&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15518EHLO command either:
15519
15520.ilist
15521is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15522.next
15523.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15524.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15525matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15526calling host address, or
15527.next
15528when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15529.endlist
15530
15531However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15532fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15533be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15534
15535If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15536.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15537&$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15538
15539.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15540.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15541.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15542Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15543backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15544name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15545&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15546rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15547If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15548error.
15549
15550.option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15551.cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15552.cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15553This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15554manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15555&%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15556verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15557item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15558it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15559
15560This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15561delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15562configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15563domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15564&%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15565
15566A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15567messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15568time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15569retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15570
15571
15572.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15573.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15574Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15575is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15576&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15577option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15578default configuration file contains
15579.code
15580host_lookup = *
15581.endd
15582which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15583is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15584
15585After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15586has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15587this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15588
15589.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15590.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15591After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15592unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15593&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15594&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15595
15596
15597.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15598This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15599to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15600first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15601if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15602if you want.
15603
15604&*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15605multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15606&_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15607case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15608
15609
15610
15611.option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15612.cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15613If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15614as soon as the connection is made.
15615This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15616nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15617connections immediately.
15618
15619The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15620ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15621sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15622incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15623chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15624
15625
15626.option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15627.cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15628This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15629happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15630you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15631127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15632the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15633list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15634local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15635.code
15636hosts_connection_nolog = :
15637.endd
15638If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15639
15640
15641
15642.option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15643.cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15644This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15645connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15646
15647
15648.option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15649.cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15650.cindex "host" "treated as local"
15651If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15652if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15653records
15654or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15655host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15656
15657This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15658&`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15659section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15660&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15661that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15662chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15663interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15664
15665
15666.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15667.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15668This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15669to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15670The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15671
15672
15673
15674.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15675.cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15676.cindex "discarding bounce message"
15677This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15678that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15679suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15680
15681After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15682because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15683message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15684the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15685again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15686bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15687for frozen messages. For example,
15688.code
15689ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15690.endd
15691retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15692failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15693failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15694value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15695dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15696&%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15697
15698
15699.option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15700.cindex "&""From""& line"
15701.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15702Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15703the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15704message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15705such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15706match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15707process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15708&%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15709
15710
15711.option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15712See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15713
15714.option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15715.cindex "environment" "values from"
15716This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15717You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15718these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15719during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15720installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15721environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15722external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15723
15724Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15725(&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15726
15727WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15728FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15729unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15730that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15731
15732Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15733&%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15734current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15735anymore.
15736
15737See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15738environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15739transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15740details.
15741
15742
15743.option keep_malformed main time 4d
15744This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15745have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15746next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15747logged.
15748
15749
15750.option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15751.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15752.cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15753This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15754a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15755While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15756Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15757and constrained to be a directory.
15758
15759
15760.option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15761.cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15762.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15763This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15764a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15765While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15766Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15767and constrained to be a file.
15768
15769
15770.option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15771.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15772.cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15773This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15774Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15775Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15776
15777
15778.option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15779.cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15780.cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15781This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15782to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15783Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15784identity to be proven.
15785
15786
15787.option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15788.cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15789This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15790the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15791cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15792
15793
15794.option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15795.cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15796This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15797LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15798details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15799with LDAP support.
15800
15801
15802.option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15803.cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15804This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15805A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15806See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15807Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15808to hard/demand.
15809
15810
15811.option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15812.cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15813If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15814connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15815"STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15816of SSL-on-connect.
15817In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15818by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15819This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15820
15821
15822.option ldap_version main integer unset
15823.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15824This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15825LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15826-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15827the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15828has been built with LDAP support.
15829
15830
15831
15832.option local_from_check main boolean true
15833.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15834.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15835When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15836an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15837checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15838the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15839
15840&*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15841locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15842&%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15843
15844You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15845on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15846&'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15847and the default qualify domain.
15848
15849If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15850and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15851&'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15852&%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15853
15854.cindex "envelope sender"
15855These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15856is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15857&%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15858
15859For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15860request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15861has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15862
15863
15864
15865
15866.option local_from_prefix main string unset
15867When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15868matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15869ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15870done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15871appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15872&%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15873example, if
15874.code
15875local_from_prefix = *-
15876.endd
15877is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15878.code
15879From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15880.endd
15881will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15882matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15883qualify domain.
15884
15885
15886.option local_from_suffix main string unset
15887See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15888
15889
15890.option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15891This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15892listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15893&<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15894options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15895&%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15896&%local_interfaces%& is
15897.code
15898local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15899.endd
15900when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15901.code
15902local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15903.endd
15904
15905.option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15906.cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15907.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15908This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15909&<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15910the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15911message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15912non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15913
15914
15915
15916.option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15917.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15918When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15919an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15920do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15921also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15922See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15923&<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15924
15925
15926
15927
15928.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15929.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15930.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15931.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15932Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15933uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15934value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15935after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15936host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15937range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15938systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15939&$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15940characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15941time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15942section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15943
15944
15945
15946.option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15947.cindex "log" "file path for"
15948This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15949files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15950when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15951name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
15952or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15953they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15954Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15955section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15956used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15957variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15958configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15959&_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15960early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15961
15962
15963.option log_selector main string unset
15964.cindex "log" "selectors"
15965This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15966writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15967minus characters. For example:
15968.code
15969log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15970.endd
15971A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15972logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15973
15974
15975.option log_timezone main boolean false
15976.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15977.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15978.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15979By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15980timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15981in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15982avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15983&%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15984timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15985of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15986&$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15987another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15988
15989
15990.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
15991.cindex "too many open files"
15992.cindex "open files, too many"
15993.cindex "file" "too many open"
15994.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
15995.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
15996This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
15997lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
15998Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
15999file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16000recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16001actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16002as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16003open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16004&%lookup_open_max%&.
16005
16006
16007.option max_username_length main integer 0
16008.cindex "length of login name"
16009.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16010.cindex "limit" "user name length"
16011Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16012&[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16013this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16014an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16015
16016
16017.option message_body_newlines main bool false
16018.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16019.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16020.vindex "&$message_body$&"
16021.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16022By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16023the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16024option is set true, this no longer happens.
16025
16026
16027.option message_body_visible main integer 500
16028.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16029.cindex "message body" "visible size"
16030.vindex "&$message_body$&"
16031.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16032This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16033&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16034
16035
16036.option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16037.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16038If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16039(domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16040locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16041means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16042Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16043Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16044replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16045empty string, the option is ignored.
16046
16047
16048.option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16049If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16050the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16051message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16052take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16053the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16054it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16055yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16056before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16057that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16058means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16059colons will become hyphens.
16060
16061
16062.option message_logs main boolean true
16063.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16064.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16065If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16066&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16067Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16068minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16069per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16070which is not affected by this option.
16071
16072
16073.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16074.cindex "message" "size limit"
16075.cindex "limit" "message size"
16076.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16077This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16078value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16079to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16080TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16081optionally followed by K or M.
16082
16083&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16084other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16085the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16086error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16087&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16088
16089Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16090exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16091failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16092an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16093the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16094message that an individual transport can process.
16095
16096If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16097maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16098failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16099virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16100probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16101default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16102some problems may result.
16103
16104A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16105SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16106SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16107
16108
16109.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16110.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16111This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16112.code
16113SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16114.endd
16115in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16116moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16117and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16118standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16119lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16120
16121
16122.option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16123Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16124it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16125contains a full description of this facility.
16126
16127
16128
16129.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16130.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16131This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16132be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16133option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16134
16135
16136.option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16137This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16138message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16139recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16140It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16141safety precaution.
16142
16143When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16144list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16145the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16146contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16147can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16148
16149If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16150&%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16151example is
16152.code
16153never_users = root:daemon:bin
16154.endd
16155Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16156harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16157transport driver.
16158
16159
16160.option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
16161.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16162This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16163by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16164each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16165
16166This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16167available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16168The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16169the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16170list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16171&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16172names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16173
16174Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16175SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16176yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16177adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16178invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16179
16180The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16181
16182Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16183"+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16184with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16185some now infamous attacks.
16186
16187Examples:
16188.code
16189# Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16190openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16191 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16192
16193# Disable older protocol versions:
16194openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16195.endd
16196
16197Possible options may include:
16198.ilist
16199&`all`&
16200.next
16201&`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16202.next
16203&`cipher_server_preference`&
16204.next
16205&`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16206.next
16207&`ephemeral_rsa`&
16208.next
16209&`legacy_server_connect`&
16210.next
16211&`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16212.next
16213&`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16214.next
16215&`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16216.next
16217&`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16218.next
16219&`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16220.next
16221&`no_compression`&
16222.next
16223&`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16224.next
16225&`no_sslv2`&
16226.next
16227&`no_sslv3`&
16228.next
16229&`no_ticket`&
16230.next
16231&`no_tlsv1`&
16232.next
16233&`no_tlsv1_1`&
16234.next
16235&`no_tlsv1_2`&
16236.next
16237&`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16238.next
16239&`single_dh_use`&
16240.next
16241&`single_ecdh_use`&
16242.next
16243&`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16244.next
16245&`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16246.next
16247&`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16248.next
16249&`tls_d5_bug`&
16250.next
16251&`tls_rollback_bug`&
16252.endlist
16253
16254As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16255all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16256to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16257to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16258release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16259where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16260
16261
16262.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16263.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16264This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16265to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16266The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16267
16268
16269.option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16270.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16271.cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16272.cindex "address" "source-routed"
16273The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16274percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16275replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16276also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16277option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16278but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16279an ACL.
16280
16281&*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16282trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16283if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16284implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16285routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16286a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16287local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16288
16289
16290.option perl_at_start main boolean false
16291.cindex "Perl"
16292This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16293interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16294
16295
16296.option perl_startup main string unset
16297.cindex "Perl"
16298This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16299interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16300
16301.option perl_startup main boolean false
16302.cindex "Perl"
16303This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16304
16305
16306.option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16307.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16308This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16309data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16310&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16311PostgreSQL support.
16312
16313
16314.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16315.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16316.cindex "pid file, path for"
16317This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16318process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16319to the host name:
16320.code
16321pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16322.endd
16323If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16324spool directory.
16325The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16326option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16327of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16328
16329
16330.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16331.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16332This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16333PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16334control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16335&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16336for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16337that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16338not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16339
16340
16341.option prdr_enable main boolean false
16342.cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16343This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16344to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16345If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16346If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16347an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16348is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16349
16350.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16351.cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16352If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16353completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16354called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16355purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16356volume of mail. Use with care!
16357
16358
16359.option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16360.cindex "name" "of local host"
16361.cindex "host" "name of local"
16362.cindex "local host" "name of"
16363.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16364This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16365HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16366option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16367The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16368server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16369
16370If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16371name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16372contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16373&[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16374version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16375explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16376
16377
16378.option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16379.cindex "printing characters"
16380.cindex "8-bit characters"
16381By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
1638232&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16383when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16384sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16385is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16386characters.
16387
16388This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16389&(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16390the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16391described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16392Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16393standards.
16394
16395
16396.option process_log_path main string unset
16397.cindex "process log path"
16398.cindex "log" "process log"
16399.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16400This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16401&"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16402utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16403in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16404can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16405different spool directories.
16406
16407
16408.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16409.cindex "restricting access to features"
16410.oindex "&%-M%&"
16411.oindex "&%-R%&"
16412.oindex "&%-q%&"
16413The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16414admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16415&%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16416
16417
16418.option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16419.cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16420.cindex "address" "qualification"
16421This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16422addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16423recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16424are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16425also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16426locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16427
16428Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16429unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16430&%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16431addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16432necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16433addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16434&%primary_hostname%& value.
16435
16436
16437.option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16438This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16439addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16440
16441
16442
16443.option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16444.cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16445.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16446.cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16447This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16448A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16449domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16450next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16451
16452
16453.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16454.cindex "restricting access to features"
16455.oindex "&%-bp%&"
16456The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16457queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16458&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16459See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16460
16461
16462.option queue_only main boolean false
16463.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16464.cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16465If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16466whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16467next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16468delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16469
16470The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16471and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16472&%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16473&%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16474
16475
16476.option queue_only_file main string unset
16477.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16478.cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16479This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16480one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16481it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16482each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16483For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16484&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16485.code
16486queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16487.endd
16488causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16489&_/some/file_& exists.
16490
16491
16492.option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16493.cindex "load average"
16494.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16495.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16496If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16497all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16498happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16499the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16500the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16501false.
16502
16503Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16504option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16505determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16506&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16507
16508
16509.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16510.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16511When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16512because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16513all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16514This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16515threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16516connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16517circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16518where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16519should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16520re-evaluated for each message.
16521
16522
16523.option queue_only_override main boolean true
16524.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16525When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16526setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16527&%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16528to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16529
16530
16531.option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16532.cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16533If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16534in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16535must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16536single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16537and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16538single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16539the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16540avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16541&%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16542when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16543large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16544
16545
16546
16547.option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16548.cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16549This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16550can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16551but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16552start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16553very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16554however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16555started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16556
16557Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16558the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16559run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16560the daemon's command line.
16561
16562.cindex queues named
16563.cindex "named queues"
16564To set limits for different named queues use
16565an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16566
16567.option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16568.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16569.cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16570When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16571received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16572However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16573&%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16574message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16575has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16576when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16577over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16578SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16579&%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16580&%queue_domains%&.
16581
16582
16583.option receive_timeout main time 0s
16584.cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16585This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16586maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16587the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16588&%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16589controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16590
16591.option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16592.cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16593.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16594This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16595added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16596on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16597used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16598added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16599&"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16600header lines.
16601.new
16602The default setting is:
16603
16604.code
16605received_header_text = Received: \
16606 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16607 {${if def:sender_ident \
16608 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16609 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16610 by $primary_hostname \
16611 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
16612 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
16613 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16614 ${if def:sender_address \
16615 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16616 id $message_exim_id\
16617 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16618.endd
16619.wen
16620
16621The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16622support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16623locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16624header lines such as the following:
16625.code
16626Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16627by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16628(envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16629id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16630for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16631Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16632id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16633.endd
16634Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16635the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16636checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16637message was accepted.
16638
16639
16640.option received_headers_max main integer 30
16641.cindex "loop" "prevention"
16642.cindex "mail loop prevention"
16643.cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16644When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16645counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16646have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16647This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16648
16649
16650.option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16651.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16652.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16653This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16654recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16655qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16656affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16657addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16658host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16659or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16660option was not set.
16661
16662
16663.option recipients_max main integer 0
16664.cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16665.cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16666If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16667original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16668by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16669all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16670Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16671done.
16672
16673.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16674&*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16675RCPT commands in a single message.
16676
16677
16678.option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16679If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16680recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16681error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16682error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16683initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16684for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16685
16686
16687.option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16688.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16689This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16690hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16691does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16692message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16693have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16694deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16695deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16696each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16697same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16698&%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16699with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16700tagged with its process id.
16701
16702This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16703message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16704manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16705deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16706is received.
16707
16708.cindex "number of deliveries"
16709.cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16710If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16711need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16712are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16713daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16714fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16715runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16716delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16717then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16718&%remote_max_parallel%&.
16719
16720If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16721&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16722doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16723host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16724
16725
16726.option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16727.cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16728.cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16729When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16730domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16731.code
16732remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16733.endd
16734would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16735then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16736
16737
16738.option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16739.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16740This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16741database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16742host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16743past failures.
16744
16745
16746.option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16747.cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16748.cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16749Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16750intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16751straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16752retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16753the default value.
16754
16755
16756.option return_path_remove main boolean true
16757.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16758RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16759&'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16760The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16761MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16762in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16763&'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16764received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16765the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16766
16767
16768.option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16769This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16770
16771
16772.option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16773.cindex "RFC 1413"
16774.cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16775RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16776an item in the list.
16777The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16778for the system.
16779
16780.option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16781.cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16782.cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16783This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16784no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16785
16786
16787.option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16788.cindex "unqualified addresses"
16789.cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16790This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16791sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16792&%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16793not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16794it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16795&%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16796using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16797
16798.option set_environment main "string list" empty
16799.cindex "environment"
16800This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16801currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16802default list is empty,
16803
16804
16805.option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16806.cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16807.cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16808This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16809If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16810and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16811Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16812
16813
16814
16815.option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16816.cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16817This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16818TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16819connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16820other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16821still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16822this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16823connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16824tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16825hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16826
16827
16828
16829.option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16830.cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16831.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16832.cindex "inetd"
16833This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16834that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16835control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16836value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16837non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16838set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16839
16840A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16841has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16842that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16843and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16844
16845
16846.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16847.cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16848.cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16849Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16850the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16851check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16852client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16853client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16854
16855When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16856allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16857but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16858or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16859starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16860counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16861following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16862MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16863
16864
16865.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16866You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16867check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16868changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16869live with.
16870
16871
16872. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16873. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16874. We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16875. non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16876. zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16877. html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16878. inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16879. searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16880. the option name to split.
16881
16882.option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16883 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16884.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16885.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16886The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16887prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16888results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16889response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16890precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16891seen).
16892
16893
16894.option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16895.cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16896.cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16897This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16898host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16899expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16900reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16901connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16902is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16903of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16904required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16905
16906&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16907constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16908happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16909without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16910could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16911doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16912
16913
16914
16915.option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16916.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16917.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16918.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16919If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16920listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16921in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16922fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16923subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16924to all messages received in the same connection.
16925
16926A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16927if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16928also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16929various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16930
16931
16932. See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16933
16934.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16935 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16936.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16937.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16938This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16939automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16940the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16941and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16942number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
16943are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16944restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16945systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16946dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16947
16948
16949.option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16950.cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16951.cindex "host" "reserved"
16952When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16953number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16954that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16955&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16956restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16957of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16958of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16959the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16960individual host.
16961
16962For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16963set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16964connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16965provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16966
16967
16968.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16969.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16970.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16971.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16972This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16973several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16974is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16975responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16976incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16977
16978.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16979The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16980is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16981in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16982
16983If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16984expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16985used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16986panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16987value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16988For example:
16989.code
16990smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
16991 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
16992.endd
16993
16994Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
16995messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
16996verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
16997&%helo_data%& value.
16998
16999.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17000.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17001.cindex "banner for SMTP"
17002.cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17003.cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17004This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17005positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17006.code
17007smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17008 $version_number $tod_full
17009.endd
17010Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17011multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17012appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17013in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17014multiline response).
17015
17016
17017.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17018.cindex "checking disk space"
17019.cindex "disk space, checking"
17020.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17021When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17022option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17023spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17024leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17025is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17026
17027
17028.option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17029.cindex "connection backlog"
17030.cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17031.cindex "backlog of connections"
17032This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17033this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17034of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17035attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17036say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17037out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17038value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17039attacks by SYN flooding.
17040
17041
17042.option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17043.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17044.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17045The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17046the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17047synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17048fewer, but they still exist.
17049
17050Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17051for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17052client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17053SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17054for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17055input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17056does detect many instances.
17057
17058The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17059If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17060hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17061(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17062
17063
17064
17065.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17066.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17067.vindex "&$domain$&"
17068If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17069command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17070chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17071are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17072argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17073example:
17074.code
17075smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17076 $sender_host_address
17077.endd
17078A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17079complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17080run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17081a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17082receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17083the command.
17084
17085
17086.option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17087.cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17088When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17089one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17090section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17091
17092
17093.option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17094.cindex "load average"
17095If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17096accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17097If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17098the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17099systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17100&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17101
17102
17103
17104.option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17105.cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17106.cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17107Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17108particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17109.code
17110RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17111.endd
17112causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17113(The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17114example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17115too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17116dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17117
17118.cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17119When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17120&"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17121Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17122&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17123not count towards the limit.
17124
17125
17126
17127.option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17128.cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17129.cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17130If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17131Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17132that subvert web
17133clients
17134into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17135non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17136
17137
17138
17139.option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17140.cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17141.cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17142.cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17143Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17144can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17145recipients.
17146
17147Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17148facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17149&%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17150&<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17151
17152When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17153&%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17154rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17155respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17156values:
17157
17158.ilist
17159A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17160.next
17161An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17162fractional parts are allowed here.
17163.next
17164A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17165.next
17166A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17167because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17168.endlist
17169
17170For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17171first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17172.code
17173smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17174smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17175.endd
17176The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17177two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17178seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17179delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17180
17181
17182.option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17183See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17184
17185
17186.option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17187See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17188
17189
17190.option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17191.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17192.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17193This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17194input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17195data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17196the message is abandoned.
17197A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17198.code
17199SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17200SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17201.endd
17202The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17203means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17204
17205If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17206expanded before use and may depend on
17207&$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17208
17209
17210.oindex "&%-os%&"
17211The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17212&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17213this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17214of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17215timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17216
17217
17218.option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17219This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17220&%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17221
17222
17223.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17224.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17225.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17226In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17227&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17228reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17229to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17230policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17231&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17232example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17233.code
17234550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17235550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17236.endd
17237
17238
17239.option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17240.cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17241When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17242the availability thereof is advertised in
17243response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17244chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17245
17246
17247.option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17248This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17249extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17250See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17251
17252
17253
17254.option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17255This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17256See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17257
17258
17259
17260.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17261.cindex "multiple spool directories"
17262.cindex "spool directory" "split"
17263.cindex "directories, multiple"
17264If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17265subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17266sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17267subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17268arrival of the message.
17269
17270Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17271where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17272directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17273directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17274are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17275
17276It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17277changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17278&"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17279after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17280automatically deleted.
17281
17282When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17283changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17284trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17285sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17286sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17287spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17288particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17289if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17290entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17291
17292
17293.option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17294.cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17295This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17296it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17297configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17298string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17299&$primary_hostname$&.
17300
17301If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17302that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17303log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17304Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17305as failures in the configuration file.
17306
17307By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17308tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17309
17310.option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17311.cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17312If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17313for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17314Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17315Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17316option.
17317
17318The following variables will not have useful values:
17319.code
17320$max_received_linelength
17321$body_linecount
17322$body_zerocount
17323.endd
17324
17325Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17326and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17327(except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17328will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17329
17330Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17331(as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17332The transmission benefit is maintained.
17333
17334.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17335.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17336This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17337access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17338
17339.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17340.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17341This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17342variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17343is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17344&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17345
17346.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17347.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17348If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17349items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17350treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17351passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17352option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17353
17354
17355.option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17356.cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17357.cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17358If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17359ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17360MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17361domain causes a syntax error.
17362However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17363syntax checking.
17364
17365
17366.option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17367.cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17368When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17369separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17370be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17371separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17372nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17373particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17374both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17375containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17376Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17377the LOG_ALERT priority.
17378
17379
17380.option syslog_facility main string unset
17381.cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17382This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17383syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17384&"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17385If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17386details of Exim's logging.
17387
17388
17389.option syslog_pid main boolean true
17390.cindex "syslog" "pid"
17391If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17392omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17393the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17394to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17395into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17396
17397
17398
17399.option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17400.cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17401This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17402syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17403&<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17404
17405
17406
17407.option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17408.cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17409If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17410omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17411details of Exim's logging.
17412
17413
17414.option system_filter main string&!! unset
17415.cindex "filter" "system filter"
17416.cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17417.cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17418This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17419the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17420must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17421generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17422appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17423which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17424&<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17425A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17426
17427
17428.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17429.vindex "&$address_file$&"
17430This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17431&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17432implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17433During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17434
17435
17436.option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17437.cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17438This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17439command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17440the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17441
17442.option system_filter_group main string unset
17443.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17444This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17445gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17446with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17447
17448.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17449.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17450.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17451This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17452is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17453contains the pipe command.
17454
17455
17456.option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17457.cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17458This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17459is used in a system filter.
17460
17461
17462.option system_filter_user main string unset
17463.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17464If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17465delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17466process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17467Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17468is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17469configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17470specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17471&%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17472
17473If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17474under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17475transport option overrides.
17476
17477
17478.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17479.cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17480.cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17481.cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17482If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17483TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17484turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17485performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17486should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17487However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17488this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17489daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17490TCP_NODELAY.
17491
17492
17493.option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17494.cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17495.cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17496If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17497message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17498is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17499bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17500sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17501If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17502frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17503
17504&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17505frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17506messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17507
17508
17509.option timezone main string unset
17510.cindex "timezone, setting"
17511.cindex "environment" "values from"
17512The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17513running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17514created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17515to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17516.code
17517timezone = UTC
17518.endd
17519The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17520or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17521is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17522time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17523runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17524unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17525
17526
17527.option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17528.cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17529.cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17530.cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17531When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17532of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17533response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17534chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17535Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17536using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17537is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17538
17539
17540.option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17541.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17542.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17543The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17544files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17545needed.
17546The server's private key is also
17547assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17548&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17549
17550&*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17551receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17552use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17553option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17554
17555&*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17556separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) >to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17557
17558&*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17559when a list of more than one
17560file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17561
17562&*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17563when a list of more than one file is used.
17564
17565If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17566if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17567Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17568&<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17569
17570If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17571generated for every connection.
17572
17573.option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17574.cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17575.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17576This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17577be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17578
17579Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17580
17581&*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17582for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17583For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17584
17585See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17586
17587
17588.option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17589.cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17590The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17591the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17592interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17593suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17594
17595The value must be at least 1024.
17596
17597The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17598hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17599by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17600
17601If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17602number.
17603
17604Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17605little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17606larger prime than requested.
17607
17608
17609.option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17610.cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17611The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17612to be used by Exim.
17613
17614&*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17615local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17616other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17617"unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17618
17619If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17620then it names a file from which DH
17621parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17622PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17623OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17624fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17625loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17626and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17627
17628If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17629loaded by Exim.
17630
17631If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17632Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17633does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17634See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17635
17636If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17637a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17638
17639In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
176402.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17641in IKE is assigned number 23.
17642
17643Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17644of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17645sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17646the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17647&`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17648
17649The available standard primes are:
17650&`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17651&`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17652&`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17653&`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17654
17655The available additional primes are:
17656&`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17657
17658Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17659Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17660The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17661of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17662(the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17663
17664At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17665they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17666candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17667
17668The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17669to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17670whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17671tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17672need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17673userbase.
17674
17675Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17676is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17677applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17678used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17679mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17680prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17681acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17682
17683
17684.option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17685.cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17686This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17687It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17688
17689After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17690&`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17691for valid selections.
17692
17693For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17694&`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17695&`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17696
17697If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17698
17699
17700.option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17701.cindex TLS "certificate status"
17702.cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17703This option
17704must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17705status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17706Certificate Authority.
17707
17708Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17709
17710For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17711of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17712The ordering of the two lists must match.
17713
17714
17715.option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17716.cindex SSMTP
17717.cindex SMTPS
17718This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17719operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17720set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17721further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17722
17723
17724
17725.option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17726.cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17727The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17728files which contains the server's private keys.
17729If this option is unset, or if
17730the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17731key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17732&<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17733
17734See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17735
17736
17737.option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17738.cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17739.cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17740If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17741&"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17742support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17743TLS session.
17744
17745
17746.option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17747.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17748.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17749This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17750The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17751connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17752different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17753permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17754in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17755preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17756&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17757
17758
17759.option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17760.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17761.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17762See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17763
17764
17765.option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17766.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17767.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17768The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17769word "system"
17770or the absolute path to
17771a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17772match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17773
17774The "system" value for the option will use a
17775system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17776This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17777and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17778must be specified.
17779
17780The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17781preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17782
17783With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17784explicitly
17785either by file or directory
17786are added to those given by the system default location.
17787
17788These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17789than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17790the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17791connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17792Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17793use the explicit directory version.
17794
17795See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17796
17797A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17798being unset.
17799
17800
17801.option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17802.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17803.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17804This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17805certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17806&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17807either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17808&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17809
17810Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17811&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17812present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17813aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17814the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17815connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17816ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17817
17818A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17819matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17820certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17821abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17822state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17823such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17824but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17825certificate"&.
17826
17827Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17828certificates.
17829
17830
17831.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17832.cindex "trusted groups"
17833.cindex "groups" "trusted"
17834This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17835option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17836which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17837specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17838details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17839&%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17840are trusted.
17841
17842.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17843.cindex "trusted users"
17844.cindex "user" "trusted"
17845This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17846option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17847trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17848&<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17849If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17850Exim user are trusted.
17851
17852.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17853.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17854.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17855This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17856the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17857gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17858used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17859can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17860is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17861&%-F%& option.
17862
17863.option unknown_username main string unset
17864See &%unknown_login%&.
17865
17866.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17867.cindex "trusted users"
17868.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17869.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17870.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17871.cindex "envelope sender"
17872When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17873normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17874default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17875senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17876is used) is ignored.
17877
17878However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17879to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17880.code
17881exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17882.endd
17883.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17884The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17885other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17886users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17887patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17888identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17889users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17890followed by a hyphen
17891by a setting like this:
17892.code
17893untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17894.endd
17895If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17896restriction, you can use
17897.code
17898untrusted_set_sender = *
17899.endd
17900The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17901only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17902to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17903parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17904&'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17905necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17906overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17907described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17908
17909The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17910&"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17911&%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17912envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17913sender address.
17914
17915
17916.option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17917.cindex "&""From""& line"
17918.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17919Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17920an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17921particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17922of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17923matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17924&%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17925default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17926.code
17927From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17928From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17929.endd
17930The pattern can be seen by running
17931.code
17932exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17933.endd
17934It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17935year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17936regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17937&%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17938(&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17939&%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17940
17941
17942.option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17943See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17944
17945
17946.option warn_message_file main string unset
17947.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17948.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17949This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17950for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17951been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17952&%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17953&<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17954
17955
17956.option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17957.cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17958If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17959See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17960.ecindex IIDconfima
17961.ecindex IIDmaiconf
17962
17963
17964
17965
17966. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17967. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17968
17969.chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17970.scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17971.scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17972This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17973Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
17974
17975For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17976&<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17977which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17978provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17979&%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17980
17981
17982
17983.option address_data routers string&!! unset
17984.cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17985The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17986precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17987router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17988&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17989delivery of the address to be deferred.
17990
17991.vindex "&$address_data$&"
17992When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
17993accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
17994routers, and the eventual transport.
17995
17996&*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
17997that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
17998in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
17999either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18000put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18001
18002Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18003with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18004on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18005&$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18006&"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18007
18008The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18009for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18010you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18011.code
18012uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18013.endd
18014In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18015.code
18016file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18017.endd
18018This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18019lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18020
18021.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18022.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18023The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18024from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18025&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18026ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18027verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18028
18029
18030
18031.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18032.oindex "&%-bt%&"
18033.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18034If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18035by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18036your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18037having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18038routing.
18039
18040
18041
18042.option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18043.cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18044.cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18045This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18046routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18047&"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18048&%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18049value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18050includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18051well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18052you could put:
18053.code
18054cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18055.endd
18056on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18057and
18058.code
18059cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18060.endd
18061on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18062this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18063explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18064logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18065
18066
18067.option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18068.cindex "case of local parts"
18069.cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18070By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18071manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18072If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18073this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18074part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18075turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18076more details.
18077
18078.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18079.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18080.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18081The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18082router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18083an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18084is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18085addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18086and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18087
18088This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18089recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18090modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18091(see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18092
18093
18094
18095.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18096.cindex "local user, checking in router"
18097.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18098.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18099.vindex "&$home$&"
18100When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18101address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18102local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18103than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18104holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18105user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18106preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18107given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18108overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18109the router is skipped.
18110
18111If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18112or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18113setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18114two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18115setting to achieve this. For example:
18116.code
18117local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18118.endd
18119Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18120up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18121&%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18122
18123
18124
18125.option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18126.cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18127This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18128router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18129evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18130result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18131&"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18132router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18133
18134If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18135precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18136
18137This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18138All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18139
18140The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18141running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18142the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18143.code
18144condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18145.endd
18146Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18147.code
18148condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18149.endd
18150
18151A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18152.code
18153condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18154condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18155condition = foobar
18156.endd
18157
18158If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18159of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18160be specified using &%condition%&.
18161
18162Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18163are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18164they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18165parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18166ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18167Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18168Router rules processing behavior.
18169
18170This is best illustrated in an example:
18171.code
18172# If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18173# in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18174
18175$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18176true {yes} {no}}
18177
18178$ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18179 {yes} {no}}
18180.endd
18181In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18182&"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18183default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18184(which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18185string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18186with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18187resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18188&" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18189
18190In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18191&%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18192mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18193conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18194string characters.
18195
18196Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18197true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18198match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18199contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18200expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18201
18202
18203.option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18204.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18205If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18206option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18207the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18208If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18209output, and Exim carries on processing.
18210This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18211so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18212option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18213variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18214&%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18215are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18216The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18217
18218
18219
18220.option disable_logging routers boolean false
18221If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18222or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18223unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18224transport option of the same name.
18225
18226.option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18227.cindex "MX record" "security"
18228.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18229.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18230.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18231DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18232the dnssec request bit set.
18233This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18234
18235.option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18236.cindex "MX record" "security"
18237.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18238.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18239.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18240DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18241the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18242(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18243This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18244
18245
18246.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18247.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18248.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18249If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18250the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18251lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18252expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18253a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18254
18255
18256
18257.option driver routers string unset
18258This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18259to be used.
18260
18261
18262.option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18263.cindex "DSN" "success"
18264.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18265If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18266Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18267instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18268Not effective on redirect routers.
18269
18270
18271
18272.option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18273.cindex "envelope sender"
18274.cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18275If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18276transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18277there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18278message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18279provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18280expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18281
18282The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18283subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18284settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18285setting.
18286
18287If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18288the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18289address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18290expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18291
18292If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18293SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18294any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18295sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18296settings:
18297.code
18298errors_to =
18299errors_to = ""
18300.endd
18301An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18302this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18303no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18304address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18305overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18306
18307.vindex "&$address_data$&"
18308If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18309MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18310path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18311setting &%return_path%&.
18312
18313The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18314manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18315implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18316
18317
18318
18319.option expn routers&!? boolean true
18320.cindex "address" "testing"
18321.cindex "testing" "addresses"
18322.cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18323.cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18324If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18325as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18326want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18327on for the system alias file.
18328See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18329are evaluated.
18330
18331The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18332&<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18333an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18334
18335
18336
18337.option fail_verify routers boolean false
18338.cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18339Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18340&%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18341
18342
18343
18344.option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18345If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18346verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18347
18348
18349
18350.option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18351If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18352verifying a sender, verification fails.
18353
18354
18355
18356.option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18357.cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18358.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18359String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18360colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18361changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18362each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18363defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18364&<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18365
18366If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18367associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18368list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18369randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18370transport for further details.
18371
18372
18373.option group routers string&!! "see below"
18374.cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18375.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18376.cindex "transport" "local"
18377.cindex "router" "setting group"
18378When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18379specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18380process.
18381The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18382error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18383The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18384is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18385and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18386
18387
18388
18389.option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18390.cindex "header lines" "adding"
18391.cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18392This option specifies a list of text headers,
18393newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18394that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18395Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18396option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18397the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18398&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18399message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18400header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18401&"see"& the added header lines.
18402
18403The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18404&%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18405an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18406failures are treated as configuration errors.
18407
18408Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18409for a router; all listed headers are added.
18410
18411&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18412router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18413
18414.cindex "duplicate addresses"
18415.oindex "&%unseen%&"
18416&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18417additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18418For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18419address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18420modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18421circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18422which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18423avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18424
18425
18426
18427.option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18428.cindex "header lines" "removing"
18429.cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18430This option specifies a list of text headers,
18431colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18432that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18433Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18434option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18435the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18436section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18437the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18438to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18439&"see"& the original header lines.
18440
18441The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18442&%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18443the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18444errors.
18445
18446Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18447for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18448
18449&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18450router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18451
18452&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18453removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18454routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18455warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18456
18457&*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18458items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18459To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18460
18461
18462
18463.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18464.cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18465.cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18466Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18467entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18468IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18469address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18470like
18471.code
18472remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18473.endd
18474by setting
18475.code
18476ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18477.endd
18478on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18479discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18480attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18481domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18482Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18483router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18484
18485You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18486means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18487.code
18488ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18489ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18490.endd
18491The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18492in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18493
18494This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18495addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18496is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18497domain that is being routed.
18498
18499.vindex "&$host_address$&"
18500During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18501checked.
18502
18503.option initgroups routers boolean false
18504.cindex "additional groups"
18505.cindex "groups" "additional"
18506.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18507.cindex "transport" "local"
18508If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18509the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18510&[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18511any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18512and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18513
18514
18515
18516.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18517.cindex affix "router precondition"
18518.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18519.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18520If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18521one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18522section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18523evaluated.
18524
18525The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18526used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18527asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18528the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18529some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18530.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18531.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18532Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18533section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18534
18535.vindex "&$local_part$&"
18536.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18537During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18538running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18539expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18540the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18541a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18542command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18543This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18544the relevant transport.
18545
18546When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18547behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18548means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18549callout.
18550
18551The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18552&%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18553&%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18554to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18555immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18556.code
18557real_localuser:
18558 driver = accept
18559 local_part_prefix = real-
18560 check_local_user
18561 transport = local_delivery
18562.endd
18563For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18564router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18565.code
18566 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18567 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18568.endd
18569
18570If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18571both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18572are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18573separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18574
18575
18576.option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18577See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18578
18579
18580
18581.option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18582.cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18583.cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18584This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18585local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18586&%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18587mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18588character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18589parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18590&%username-foo%&.
18591
18592
18593.option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18594See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18595
18596
18597
18598.option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18599.cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18600.cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18601The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18602See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18603are evaluated, and
18604section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18605string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18606example:
18607.code
18608local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18609.endd
18610.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18611If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18612for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18613expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18614example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18615send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18616each virtual domain:
18617.code
18618postmaster:
18619 driver = redirect
18620 local_parts = postmaster
18621 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18622.endd
18623
18624
18625.option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18626.cindex "log" "delivery line"
18627.cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18628Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18629deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18630recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18631this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18632router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18633router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18634redirect addresses.
18635
18636
18637
18638.option more routers boolean&!! true
18639The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18640that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18641result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18642fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18643delivery to be deferred.
18644
18645If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18646further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18647.oindex "&%self%&"
18648However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18649means of the setting
18650.code
18651self = pass
18652.endd
18653or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18654does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18655case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18656
18657Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18658expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18659controls what happens next.
18660
18661
18662.option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18663.cindex "timeout" "of router"
18664.cindex "router" "timeout"
18665If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18666address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18667router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18668intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18669host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18670
18671There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18672lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18673applies to all of them.
18674
18675
18676
18677.option pass_router routers string unset
18678.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18679Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18680&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18681routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18682these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18683router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18684of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18685be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18686to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18687&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18688
18689
18690
18691.option redirect_router routers string unset
18692.cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18693Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18694generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18695example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18696point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18697
18698The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18699It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18700instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18701which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18702
18703
18704
18705.option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18706.cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18707.cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18708This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18709router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18710Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18711through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18712
18713Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18714be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
18715(&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18716If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18717failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18718
18719If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18720below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18721&"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18722existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18723preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18724
18725.cindex "NFS"
18726If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18727the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18728unavailable.
18729
18730This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18731options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18732look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18733full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18734these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18735to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18736that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18737transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
18738
18739During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18740facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18741This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18742operates as follows:
18743
18744If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18745characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18746comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18747but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18748used. For example:
18749.code
18750require_files = mail:/some/file
18751require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18752.endd
18753If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18754&%require_files%& condition fails.
18755
18756Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18757checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18758directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18759access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18760
18761&*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18762incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18763may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18764may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18765user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18766
18767&*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18768&[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18769without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18770is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18771check again in that process.
18772
18773The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18774be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18775existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18776circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18777not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
18778for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18779as if the file did not exist. For example:
18780.code
18781require_files = +/some/file
18782.endd
18783If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18784handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18785option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18786
18787
18788
18789.option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18790.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18791.cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18792When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18793in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18794domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18795other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18796Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18797latter kind.
18798
18799This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18800hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18801router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18802set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18803for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18804same name.
18805
18806The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18807appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18808independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18809
18810
18811
18812.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18813.cindex "router" "home directory for"
18814.cindex "home directory" "for router"
18815.vindex "&$home$&"
18816This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18817&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18818transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18819sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18820forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18821cause the router to defer.
18822
18823Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18824&%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18825place.
18826(See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18827are evaluated.)
18828While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18829&$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18830
18831When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18832the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18833delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18834of these values that is set:
18835
18836.ilist
18837The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18838.next
18839The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18840.next
18841The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18842.next
18843The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18844.endlist
18845
18846In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18847router, but not for the transport.
18848
18849
18850
18851.option self routers string freeze
18852.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18853.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18854This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18855list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18856and &(manualroute)& routers.
18857Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18858of remote hosts.
18859Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18860&(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18861host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18862The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18863&<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18864
18865Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18866example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18867error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18868reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18869freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18870cases:
18871
18872.vlist
18873.vitem &%defer%&
18874Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18875
18876.vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18877The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18878be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18879behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18880
18881.vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18882The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18883reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18884rewritten.
18885
18886.vitem &%pass%&
18887.oindex "&%more%&"
18888.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18889The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18890&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18891subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18892name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18893distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18894combination
18895.code
18896self = pass
18897no_more
18898.endd
18899ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18900Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18901be passed to the next router.
18902
18903.vitem &%fail%&
18904Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18905
18906.vitem &%send%&
18907.cindex "local host" "sending to"
18908The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18909setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18910makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18911is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18912different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18913.endlist
18914
18915
18916
18917.option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18918.cindex "router" "checking senders"
18919If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18920address matches something on the list.
18921See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18922are evaluated.
18923
18924There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18925dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18926setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18927to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18928set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18929verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18930SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18931matters.
18932
18933
18934.option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18935.cindex "IP address" "translating"
18936.cindex "packet radio"
18937.cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18938There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18939it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18940mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18941routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18942is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18943code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18944SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18945
18946.vindex "&$host_address$&"
18947The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18948by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18949expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18950For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18951If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18952address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18953up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18954produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18955addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18956.code
18957translate_ip_address = \
18958 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18959 {$value}fail}}
18960.endd
18961The file would contain lines like
18962.code
1896310.2.3.128/26 some.host
1896410.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18965.endd
18966You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18967are doing.
18968
18969
18970
18971.option transport routers string&!! unset
18972This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18973and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18974only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18975after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18976and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18977delivery is deferred.
18978
18979The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18980have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18981(see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18982
18983
18984
18985.option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18986.cindex "current directory for local transport"
18987This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18988to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18989explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18990file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
18991option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
18992overridden by a setting on the transport.
18993If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18994logged, and delivery is deferred.
18995See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
18996environment.
18997
18998
18999
19000
19001.option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19002.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19003This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19004local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19005configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19006pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19007string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19008setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19009If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19010logged, and delivery is deferred.
19011
19012If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19013&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19014the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19015the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19016is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19017
19018See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19019environment.
19020
19021
19022
19023
19024.option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19025.cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19026The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19027that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19028result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19029fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19030delivery to be deferred.
19031
19032When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19033address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19034overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19035&%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19036the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19037sometimes true and sometimes false).
19038
19039.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19040Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19041qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19042delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19043In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19044&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19045to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19046&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19047
19048&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19049this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19050only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19051no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19052a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19053duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19054duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19055&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19056so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19057&%redirect%& router may be of help.
19058
19059Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19060&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19061subsequent routers.
19062
19063
19064.option user routers string&!! "see below"
19065.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19066.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19067.cindex "transport" "local"
19068.cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19069.cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19070When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19071specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19072The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19073error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19074This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19075The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19076the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19077a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19078See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19079&<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19080
19081
19082
19083.option verify routers&!? boolean true
19084Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19085&%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19086
19087
19088.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19089.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19090.oindex "&%-bv%&"
19091.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19092If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19093delivering in cutthrough mode or
19094testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19095with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19096restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19097&%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19098
19099&*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19100SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19101accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19102user or group.
19103
19104
19105.option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19106If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19107addresses,
19108delivering in cutthrough mode
19109or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19110See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19111are evaluated.
19112See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19113
19114
19115.option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19116If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19117or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19118See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19119are evaluated.
19120See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19121.ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19122.ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19123
19124
19125
19126
19127
19128
19129. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19130. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19131
19132.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19133.cindex "&(accept)& router"
19134.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19135The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19136used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19137be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19138specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19139it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19140up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19141.code
19142localusers:
19143 driver = accept
19144 domains = mydomain.example
19145 check_local_user
19146 transport = local_delivery
19147.endd
19148The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19149&%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19150When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19151address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19152
19153
19154
19155
19156
19157
19158. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19159. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19160
19161.chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19162.scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19163.scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19164The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19165recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19166unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19167
19168If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19169SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19170MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19171However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19172records.
19173
19174MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19175looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19176When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19177except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19178IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19179generic option, the router declines.
19180
19181Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19182to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19183are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19184
19185.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19186.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19187.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19188If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19189address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19190happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19191
19192
19193.section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19194There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19195Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19196SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19197MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19198problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19199
19200For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19201&%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19202&(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19203an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19204domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19205such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19206proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19207look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19208case routing fails.
19209
19210
19211.section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19212.cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19213There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19214an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19215domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19216
19217The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19218is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19219
19220Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19221.ilist
19222The domain does not exist in DNS
19223.next
19224The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19225convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19226for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19227.next
19228Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19229.next
19230MX record points to a non-existent host.
19231.next
19232MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19233&%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19234.next
19235MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19236addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19237.next
19238The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19239&%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19240.next
19241&%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19242not be found in the MX records (see below)
19243.endlist
19244
19245
19246
19247
19248.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19249.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19250The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19251
19252.option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19253.cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19254If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19255(and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19256process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19257differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19258the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19259
19260
19261.option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19262.cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19263The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19264addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19265enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19266required. For example,
19267.code
19268check_srv = smtp
19269.endd
19270looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19271expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19272to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19273submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19274option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19275normal way.
19276
19277When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19278the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19279host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19280this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19281SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19282according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19283
19284When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19285the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19286records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19287this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19288defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19289and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19290have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19291trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19292
19293See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19294when there is a DNS lookup error.
19295
19296
19297
19298
19299.option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19300.cindex "MX record" "not found"
19301DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19302which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19303rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19304This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19305domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19306However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19307also being queued.
19308
19309
19310.option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19311.cindex IPv6 disabling
19312.cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19313The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19314or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19315(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19316only A records are used.
19317
19318.option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19319.cindex IPv4 preference
19320.cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19321The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19322or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19323(checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19324A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19325
19326.option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19327.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19328.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19329A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19330record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19331For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19332records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19333setting:
19334.code
19335mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19336.endd
19337This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19338has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19339the address record.
19340
19341
19342.option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19343If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19344DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19345&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19346
19347
19348
19349
19350.option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19351.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19352.cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19353When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19354lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19355single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19356called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19357&'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19358resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19359&'resolv.conf'&.
19360
19361
19362
19363.option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19364.cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19365.cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19366If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19367qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19368an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19369expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19370occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19371&%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19372any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19373header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19374
19375This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19376ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19377sense.
19378
19379When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19380servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19381making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19382some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19383name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19384header rewriting.
19385
19386
19387.option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19388.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19389Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19390to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19391options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19392default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19393servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19394any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19395
19396If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19397domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19398local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19399lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19400routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19401message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19402without processing them independently,
19403provided the following conditions are met:
19404
19405.ilist
19406No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19407&%headers_remove%&.
19408.next
19409The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19410the domain.
19411.endlist
19412
19413
19414
19415
19416.option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19417.cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19418When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19419lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19420applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19421the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19422domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19423up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19424&'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19425actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19426
19427Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19428record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19429local wildcard.
19430
19431
19432
19433.option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19434If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19435DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19436&<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19437
19438
19439
19440
19441.option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19442.cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19443If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19444added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19445if
19446.code
19447widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19448.endd
19449is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19450&'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19451&'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19452and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19453the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19454when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19455
19456
19457.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19458When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19459of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19460corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19461is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19462
19463These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19464for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19465such as that implied by
19466.code
19467domains = @mx_any
19468.endd
19469that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19470entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19471.ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19472.ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19473
19474
19475
19476
19477
19478
19479
19480
19481
19482. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19483. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19484
19485.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19486.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19487.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19488.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19489This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19490verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19491generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19492takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19493router handles the address
19494.code
19495root@[192.168.1.1]
19496.endd
19497by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19498consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19499are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19500.code
19501postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19502.endd
19503Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19504grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19505
19506.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19507If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19508declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19509&%self%& option determines what happens.
19510
19511The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19512controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19513also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19514Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19515
19516
19517
19518. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19519. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19520
19521.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19522.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19523.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19524The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19525Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19526not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19527must set
19528.code
19529ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19530.endd
19531in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19532
19533The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19534connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19535a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19536message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19537this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19538can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19539must not be specified for it.
19540
19541.cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19542.option hosts iplookup string unset
19543This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19544names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19545(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19546and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19547happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19548
19549
19550.option optional iplookup boolean false
19551If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19552is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19553delivery to the address is deferred.
19554
19555
19556.option port iplookup integer 0
19557.cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19558This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19559call.
19560
19561
19562.option protocol iplookup string udp
19563This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19564protocols is to be used.
19565
19566
19567.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19568This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19569default value is:
19570.code
19571$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19572.endd
19573The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19574query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19575
19576
19577.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19578If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19579returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19580string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19581in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19582&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19583whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19584up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19585
19586
19587.option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19588This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19589returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19590router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19591response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19592check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19593address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19594the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19595following could be used:
19596.code
19597response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19598reroute = $local_part@$1
19599.endd
19600
19601.option timeout iplookup time 5s
19602This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19603machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19604call. It does not apply to UDP.
19605
19606
19607
19608
19609. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19610. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19611
19612.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19613.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19614.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19615.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19616The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19617routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19618route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19619normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19620route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19621messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19622
19623The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19624it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19625has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19626include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19627&"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19628generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19629being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19630
19631.vindex "&$host$&"
19632In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19633router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19634an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19635transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19636with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19637passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19638host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19639text string.
19640
19641The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19642&%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19643or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19644any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19645below, following the list of private options.
19646
19647
19648.section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19649
19650.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19651The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19652
19653.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19654See &%host_find_failed%&.
19655
19656.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19657This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19658address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19659of the following values:
19660.code
19661decline
19662defer
19663fail
19664freeze
19665ignore
19666pass
19667.endd
19668The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19669error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19670forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19671&%pass_router%&),
19672.oindex "&%more%&"
19673overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19674router only if &%more%& is true.
19675
19676The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19677cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19678controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19679as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19680
19681The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19682state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19683generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19684
19685
19686.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19687.cindex "randomized host list"
19688.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19689If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19690is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19691overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19692crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19693same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19694(even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19695deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19696
19697When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19698into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19699set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19700item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19701.code
19702route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19703.endd
19704The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19705randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19706If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19707randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19708&%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19709
19710
19711.option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19712If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19713Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19714example:
19715.code
19716route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19717.endd
19718If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19719router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19720deferred.
19721
19722
19723.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19724This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19725unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19726that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19727
19728
19729.option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19730.cindex "address" "copying routing"
19731Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19732router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19733router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19734default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19735servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19736any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19737
19738If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19739domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19740local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19741lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19742&(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19743addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19744same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19745if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19746
19747
19748
19749
19750.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19751The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19752rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19753entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19754described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19755Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19756.display
19757<&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19758.endd
19759The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19760no options:
19761.code
19762route_list = \
19763 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19764 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19765.endd
19766The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19767list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19768usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19769single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19770pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19771&<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19772except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19773That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19774lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19775in a &%route_list%&).
19776
19777The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19778matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19779then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19780&%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19781
19782
19783
19784.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19785The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19786routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19787hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19788The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19789Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19790expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19791like this:
19792.code
19793dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19794thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19795.endd
19796This data can be accessed by setting
19797.code
19798route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19799.endd
19800Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19801decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19802requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19803possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19804be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19805
19806
19807
19808
19809.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19810A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19811always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19812declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19813and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
19814If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
19815The format of each item
19816in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19817as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
19818
19819If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19820variables are set during its expansion:
19821
19822.ilist
19823.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19824If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19825&$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19826.code
19827route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19828.endd
19829.next
19830&$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19831.next
19832&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19833
19834.next
19835.vindex "&$value$&"
19836If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19837looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19838.code
19839route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19840.endd
19841.endlist
19842
19843Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19844semicolon is the default route list separator.
19845
19846
19847
19848.section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19849Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19850optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19851is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19852specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19853by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19854
19855.ilist
19856Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19857the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19858be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19859.code
19860route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19861route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19862.endd
19863.next
19864When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19865colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19866enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19867number follows. For example:
19868.code
19869route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19870.endd
19871.endlist
19872
19873.section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19874When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19875the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19876delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19877option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19878transport.
19879
19880Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19881hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19882interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19883records in the DNS. For example:
19884.code
19885route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19886.endd
19887If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19888example:
19889.code
19890route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19891.endd
19892If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19893randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19894that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19895be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19896Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19897happens is controlled by the
19898.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19899&%self%& option of the router.
19900
19901A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19902hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19903lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19904below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19905preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19906randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19907defined by MX preferences.
19908
19909If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19910not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19911preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19912
19913If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19914depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19915is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19916Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19917
19918If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19919most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19920router.
19921
19922DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19923failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19924&%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19925
19926The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19927whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19928
19929
19930
19931.section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19932The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
19933One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19934&%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19935other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19936per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19937routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19938
19939.ilist
19940&%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19941setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19942.next
19943&%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19944overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19945.next
19946&%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19947find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19948also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19949.next
19950&%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19951no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19952timeout), delivery is deferred.
19953.next
19954&%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
19955.next
19956&%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
19957.endlist
19958
19959For example:
19960.code
19961route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19962 domain2 host4:host5
19963.endd
19964If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19965DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19966result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19967or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19968call.
19969
19970&*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19971called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19972instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19973lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19974function called.
19975
19976&*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
19977inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
19978option specified.
19979
19980
19981
19982If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19983&%host_find_failed%& option.
19984
19985.vindex "&$host$&"
19986When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19987The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
19988
19989
19990
19991.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
19992In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
19993transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
19994
19995.ilist
19996.cindex "smart host" "example router"
19997The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
19998&'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
19999named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20000.code
20001domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20002.endd
20003You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20004your first router something like this:
20005.code
20006smart_route:
20007 driver = manualroute
20008 domains = !+local_domains
20009 transport = remote_smtp
20010 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20011.endd
20012This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20013&'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20014they are tried in order
20015(but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20016Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20017.code
20018smart_route:
20019 driver = manualroute
20020 transport = remote_smtp
20021 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20022.endd
20023There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20024However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20025example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20026precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20027always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20028would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20029always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20030&%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20031
20032.next
20033.cindex "mail hub example"
20034A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20035records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20036the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20037machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20038&(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20039to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20040using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20041lookup is easier to manage.
20042
20043If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20044to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20045example:
20046.code
20047hub_route:
20048 driver = manualroute
20049 transport = remote_smtp
20050 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20051.endd
20052This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20053whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20054if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20055that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20056domain can be used to find the host:
20057.code
20058through_firewall:
20059 driver = manualroute
20060 transport = remote_smtp
20061 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20062.endd
20063The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20064hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20065data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20066next router.
20067
20068.next
20069.cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20070.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20071You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20072SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20073storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20074can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20075.code
20076save_in_file:
20077 driver = manualroute
20078 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20079 route_list = saved.domain.example
20080.endd
20081though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20082several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20083different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20084.code
20085save_in_file:
20086 driver = manualroute
20087 route_list = \
20088 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20089 *.saved.domain2.example \
20090 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20091 batch_pipe
20092.endd
20093.vindex "&$domain$&"
20094.vindex "&$host$&"
20095The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20096doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20097file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20098the address if the lookup fails.
20099
20100.next
20101.cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20102Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20103&(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20104one way it can be done:
20105.code
20106# Transport
20107uucp:
20108 driver = pipe
20109 user = nobody
20110 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20111 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20112 return_fail_output = true
20113
20114# Router
20115uucphost:
20116 transport = uucp
20117 driver = manualroute
20118 route_data = \
20119 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20120.endd
20121The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20122.code
20123darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20124.endd
20125It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20126makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20127&'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20128.endlist
20129.ecindex IIDmanrou1
20130.ecindex IIDmanrou2
20131
20132
20133
20134
20135
20136
20137
20138
20139. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20140. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20141
20142.chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20143.scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20144.scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20145.cindex "routing" "by external program"
20146The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20147and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20148mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20149However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20150&%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20151be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20152options:
20153.cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20154
20155.option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20156This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20157command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20158expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20159&<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20160
20161
20162.option command_group queryprogram string unset
20163.cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20164This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20165address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20166uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20167gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20168
20169
20170.option command_user queryprogram string unset
20171.cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20172This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20173command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20174it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20175using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20176not set, a value for the gid also.
20177
20178&*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20179root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20180However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20181usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20182is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20183the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20184gid.
20185
20186
20187.option current_directory queryprogram string /
20188This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20189before running the command.
20190
20191
20192.option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20193If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20194is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20195timeout.
20196
20197
20198The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20199the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20200containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20201the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20202field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20203
20204.ilist
20205&'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20206below).
20207.next
20208&'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20209&%no_more%& is set.
20210.next
20211&'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20212subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20213of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20214included in the SMTP response.
20215.next
20216&'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20217subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20218included in any SMTP response.
20219.next
20220&'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20221.next
20222&'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20223&%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20224.next
20225&'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20226new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20227or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20228.endlist
20229
20230When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20231number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20232the page):
20233.code
20234ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20235LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20236.endd
20237The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20238is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20239used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20240an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20241
20242The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20243As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20244in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20245&`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20246(see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20247
20248If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20249find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20250anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20251goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20252result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20253
20254.vindex "&$address_data$&"
20255If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20256variable. For example, this return line
20257.code
20258accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20259.endd
20260routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20261the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20262.ecindex IIDquerou1
20263.ecindex IIDquerou2
20264
20265
20266
20267
20268. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20269. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20270
20271.chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20272.scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20273.scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20274.cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20275.cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20276The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20277common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20278(usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20279files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20280redirected in several different ways:
20281
20282.ilist
20283It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20284independently.
20285.next
20286It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20287.next
20288It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20289.next
20290It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20291.next
20292It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20293.next
20294It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20295.next
20296It can be discarded.
20297.endlist
20298
20299The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20300However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20301files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20302&%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20303
20304If success DSNs have been requested
20305.cindex "DSN" "success"
20306.cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20307redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20308
20309
20310
20311.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20312The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20313expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20314contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20315options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20316aliases, in a configuration like this:
20317.code
20318system_aliases:
20319 driver = redirect
20320 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20321.endd
20322If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20323expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20324expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20325cause delivery to be deferred.
20326
20327A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20328&_.forward_& files, like this:
20329.code
20330userforward:
20331 driver = redirect
20332 check_local_user
20333 file = $home/.forward
20334 no_verify
20335.endd
20336If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20337empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20338is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20339yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20340comments.
20341
20342
20343
20344.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20345.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20346It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20347&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20348
20349.ilist
20350When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20351running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20352the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20353practice the router may not be able to operate.
20354.next
20355However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20356is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20357local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20358saves some resources.
20359.endlist
20360
20361
20362
20363
20364
20365
20366.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20367.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20368.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20369The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20370can be interpreted in two different ways:
20371
20372.ilist
20373If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20374&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20375&'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20376respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20377in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20378document is intended for use by end users.
20379.next
20380Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20381described in the next section.
20382.endlist
20383
20384When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20385in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20386generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20387configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20388for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20389
20390
20391
20392.section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20393.cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20394When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20395comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20396addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20397&<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20398disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20399depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20400commas or newlines.
20401If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20402quotes.
20403
20404Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20405also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20406next newline character is ignored.
20407
20408If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20409double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20410(but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20411&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20412removed.
20413
20414.vindex "&$local_part$&"
20415&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20416and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20417of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20418special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20419&'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20420setting:
20421.code
20422data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20423.endd
20424
20425
20426.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20427.cindex "routing" "loops in"
20428.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20429.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20430A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20431consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20432automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20433is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20434Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20435as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20436complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20437
20438.cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20439Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20440filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20441mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20442&'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20443.code
20444cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20445.endd
20446.cindex "backslash in alias file"
20447.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20448For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20449preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20450it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20451synonymously.
20452
20453If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
204542822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20455domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20456addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20457force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20458
20459Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20460Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20461contains:
20462.code
20463Sam.Reman: spqr
20464.endd
20465Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20466messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20467this forward file:
20468.code
20469Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20470.endd
20471With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20472&(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20473second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20474and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20475should really contain
20476.code
20477spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20478.endd
20479but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20480below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20481&(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20482
20483
20484
20485.section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20486In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20487lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20488
20489.ilist
20490.cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20491.cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20492An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20493as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20494command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20495Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20496which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20497
20498Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20499the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20500the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20501in double quotes, for example:
20502.code
20503"|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20504.endd
20505since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20506quote just the command. An item such as
20507.code
20508|"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20509.endd
20510is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20511
20512Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20513of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20514redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20515quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20516string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20517are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20518data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20519transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20520an &%accept%& router.
20521
20522.next
20523.cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20524.cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20525An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20526parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20527.code
20528/home/world/minbari
20529.endd
20530is treated as a filename, but
20531.code
20532/s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20533.endd
20534is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
20535the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20536forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20537filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20538
20539Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20540which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20541
20542.cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20543However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20544bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20545instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20546
20547.next
20548.cindex "included address list"
20549.cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20550If an item is of the form
20551.code
20552:include:<path name>
20553.endd
20554a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20555point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20556out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20557by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20558item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20559the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20560.code
20561list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20562.endd
20563It must be given as
20564.code
20565list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20566.endd
20567.next
20568.cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20569.cindex "delivery" "discard"
20570.cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20571.cindex "black hole"
20572.cindex "abandoning mail"
20573Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20574&%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20575the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20576.code
20577:blackhole:
20578.endd
20579can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20580done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20581&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20582
20583&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20584delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20585are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20586database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20587&_/dev/null_&.
20588
20589.next
20590.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20591.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20592.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20593.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20594.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20595An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20596redirection items of the form
20597.code
20598:defer:
20599:fail:
20600.endd
20601respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20602to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20603text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20604associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20605.code
20606X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20607.endd
20608In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20609of a
20610.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20611VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20612default.
20613.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20614The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20615the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20616
20617.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20618By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20619&':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20620space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20621followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20622code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20623incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20624suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20625&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20626ignored.
20627
20628.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20629In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20630default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20631therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20632
20633Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20634not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20635normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20636as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20637lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20638
20639During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20640containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20641whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
20642subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20643deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20644rules still apply.
20645
20646.next
20647.cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20648Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20649chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20650for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20651&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20652router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20653results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20654.endlist
20655
20656
20657.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20658.cindex "duplicate addresses"
20659.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20660.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20661Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20662to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20663routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20664aliasing scheme of the type
20665.code
20666pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20667localpart1: pipe
20668localpart2: pipe
20669.endd
20670does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20671when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20672discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20673such as
20674.code
20675localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20676localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20677.endd
20678does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20679the pipes are distinct.
20680
20681
20682
20683.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20684.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20685.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20686When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20687leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20688afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20689delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20690members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20691can be used to avoid this.
20692
20693
20694.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20695.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20696If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20697error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20698for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20699detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20700deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20701
20702
20703
20704.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20705
20706.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20707The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20708
20709
20710.option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20711Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20712data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20713
20714
20715.option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20716.cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20717If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20718and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20719
20720
20721.option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20722.cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20723.cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20724Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20725&"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20726are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20727lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20728
20729It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20730the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20731
20732
20733The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20734&%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20735&%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20736files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20737true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20738
20739
20740
20741.option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20742.cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20743Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20744This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20745default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20746let ordinary users do.
20747
20748
20749
20750.option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20751This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20752as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20753Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20754configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20755for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20756
20757When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20758is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20759the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20760and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20761domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20762&_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20763.code
20764\Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20765.endd
20766Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20767&"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20768originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20769(having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20770&"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20771&%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20772file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20773original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20774
20775
20776.option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20777When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20778when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20779&%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20780&%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20781deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20782is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20783&%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20784
20785
20786
20787.option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20788When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20789this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20790permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20791option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20792&%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20793
20794
20795.option data redirect string&!! unset
20796This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20797set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20798list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20799expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20800has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20801
20802When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20803filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20804terminated with newline characters. For example:
20805.code
20806data = #Exim filter\n\
20807 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20808.endd
20809If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20810you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20811choice into a newline.
20812
20813
20814.option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20815A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20816ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20817specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20818configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20819
20820
20821.option file redirect string&!! unset
20822This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20823is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20824use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20825failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20826must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20827data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20828entirely of comments), the router declines.
20829
20830.cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20831If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20832runs a check on the containing directory,
20833unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20834If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20835happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20836is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20837not, the router declines.
20838
20839
20840.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20841.vindex "&$address_file$&"
20842A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20843ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20844specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20845configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20846it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
20847
20848
20849.option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20850When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20851relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20852relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20853relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20854
20855
20856.option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20857.cindex "restricting access to features"
20858.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20859If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20860redirection list.
20861
20862
20863.option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20864.cindex "restricting access to features"
20865.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20866If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20867&%allow_filter%& is true.
20868
20869
20870
20871
20872.option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20873.cindex "restricting access to features"
20874.cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20875.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20876.cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20877.cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20878If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20879specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20880conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20881set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20882locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20883
20884
20885.option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20886.cindex "restricting access to features"
20887.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20888If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20889make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20890functions.
20891
20892.option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20893.cindex "restricting access to features"
20894.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20895.cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20896If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20897make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20898
20899.option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20900.cindex "restricting access to features"
20901.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20902If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20903permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20904under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20905&_.forward_& files).
20906
20907
20908.option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20909.cindex "restricting access to features"
20910.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20911If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20912to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20913
20914
20915.option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20916.cindex "restricting access to features"
20917.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20918This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20919it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20920of the embedded Perl support.
20921
20922
20923.option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20924.cindex "restricting access to features"
20925.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20926If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20927to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20928
20929
20930.option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20931.cindex "restricting access to features"
20932.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20933If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20934to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20935
20936
20937.option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20938.cindex "restricting access to features"
20939.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20940If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20941message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20942files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20943&%one_time%& is set.
20944
20945
20946.option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20947.cindex "restricting access to features"
20948.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20949If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20950to make use of &%run%& items.
20951
20952
20953.option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20954.cindex "restricting access to features"
20955.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20956If this option is true, items of the form
20957.code
20958:include:<path name>
20959.endd
20960are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20961
20962
20963.option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20964.cindex "restricting access to features"
20965.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20966.cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20967If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20968specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20969forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20970
20971
20972.option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20973.cindex "restricting access to features"
20974.cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20975If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20976&%allow_filter%& is true.
20977
20978
20979.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20980.option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20981If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20982of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20983the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20984
20985
20986
20987
20988.option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20989.cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20990If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
20991generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
20992generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
20993bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
20994bounce may well quote the generated address.
20995
20996
20997.option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
20998.cindex "EACCES"
20999If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21000EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21001file did not exist.
21002
21003
21004.option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21005.cindex "ENOTDIR"
21006If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21007ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21008router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21009
21010Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21011router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21012(the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21013against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21014is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21015is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21016a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21017that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21018
21019
21020
21021.option include_directory redirect string unset
21022If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21023redirection list must start with this directory.
21024
21025
21026.option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21027This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21028&%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21029
21030
21031.option one_time redirect boolean false
21032.cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21033.cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21034.cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21035.cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21036.cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21037Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21038files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21039of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21040is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21041but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21042message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21043lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21044before they subscribed.
21045
21046If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21047deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21048&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21049&"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21050attempt.
21051
21052&*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21053router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21054reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21055permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21056
21057&*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21058to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21059and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21060
21061&*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21062&%one_time%&.
21063
21064The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21065addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21066addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21067&%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21068typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21069expansion.
21070
21071
21072.option owners redirect "string list" unset
21073.cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21074.cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21075.cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21076.cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21077This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21078This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21079See &%check_owner%& above.
21080
21081
21082.option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21083This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21084The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21085&%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21086
21087
21088.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21089.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21090A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21091starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21092transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21093name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21094When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21095
21096
21097.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21098.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21099If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21100generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21101in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21102expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21103to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21104&$qualify_recipient$&.
21105
21106This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21107but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21108not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21109addresses.
21110
21111.option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21112.cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21113.cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21114.cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21115If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21116set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21117without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21118address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21119&%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21120this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21121
21122
21123.option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21124If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21125any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21126the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21127only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21128&%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21129
21130
21131.option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21132A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21133&%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21134by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21135transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21136are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21137
21138
21139.option rewrite redirect boolean true
21140.cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21141If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21142subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21143and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21144
21145
21146.option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21147The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21148:subaddress part of an address.
21149
21150.option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21151The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21152of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21153(including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21154
21155
21156.option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21157.cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21158To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21159&%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21160(do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21161&%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21162needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21163
21164
21165
21166.option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21167.cindex "forward file" "broken"
21168.cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21169.cindex "alias file" "broken"
21170.cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21171.cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21172.cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21173.cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21174If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21175non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21176&%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21177giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21178are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21179&%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21180be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21181&%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21182
21183If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21184errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21185the following routers.
21186
21187If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21188error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21189taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21190so it is passed to the following routers.
21191
21192.cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21193Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21194action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21195&%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21196
21197&%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21198lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21199option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21200notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21201.code
21202userforward:
21203 driver = redirect
21204 allow_filter
21205 check_local_user
21206 file = $home/.forward
21207 file_transport = address_file
21208 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21209 reply_transport = address_reply
21210 no_verify
21211 skip_syntax_errors
21212 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21213 syntax_errors_text = \
21214 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21215 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21216 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21217 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21218 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21219 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21220 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21221 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21222 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21223 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21224.endd
21225You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21226&`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21227put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21228.code
21229real_localuser:
21230 driver = accept
21231 check_local_user
21232 local_part_prefix = real-
21233 transport = local_delivery
21234.endd
21235For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21236router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21237.code
21238 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21239 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21240.endd
21241
21242
21243.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21244See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21245
21246
21247.option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21248See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21249.ecindex IIDredrou1
21250.ecindex IIDredrou2
21251
21252
21253
21254
21255
21256
21257. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21258. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21259
21260.chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21261 "Environment for local transports"
21262.scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21263.scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21264.scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21265Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21266transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21267in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21268mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21269
21270Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21271some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21272transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21273&<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21274
21275The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21276different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21277settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21278or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21279configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21280
21281
21282
21283.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21284.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21285.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21286If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21287simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21288the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21289rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21290time.
21291
21292However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21293locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21294.code
21295my_transport:
21296 driver = pipe
21297 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21298.endd
21299This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21300messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21301&%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21302file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21303
21304
21305
21306
21307.section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21308.cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21309.cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21310All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21311overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21312set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21313delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21314group (set by the transport). For example:
21315.code
21316# Routers ...
21317# User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21318local_users:
21319 driver = accept
21320 check_local_user
21321 transport = group_delivery
21322
21323# Transports ...
21324# This transport overrides the group
21325group_delivery:
21326 driver = appendfile
21327 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21328 group = mail
21329.endd
21330If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21331address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21332gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21333set.
21334
21335.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21336When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21337function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21338&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21339by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21340for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21341
21342.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21343The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21344is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21345receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21346original gid is also used.
21347
21348This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21349following that is set is used:
21350
21351.ilist
21352A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21353.next
21354A &%group%& setting of the router;
21355.next
21356A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21357&%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21358.next
21359The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21360.next
21361In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21362the uid is the creator's uid;
21363.next
21364The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21365.endlist
21366
21367If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21368no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21369This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21370The first of the following that is set is used:
21371
21372.ilist
21373A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21374.next
21375In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21376.next
21377A &%user%& setting of the router;
21378.next
21379A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21380.next
21381The Exim uid.
21382.endlist
21383
21384Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21385&%never_users%& list.
21386
21387
21388
21389
21390
21391.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21392.cindex "current directory for local transport"
21393.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21394.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21395.cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21396Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21397the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21398However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21399are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21400for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21401
21402.ilist
21403The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21404.next
21405The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21406.next
21407The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21408.next
21409The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21410.endlist
21411
21412The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21413
21414.ilist
21415The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21416.next
21417The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21418.endlist
21419
21420
21421If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21422value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21423directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21424
21425
21426
21427.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21428.vindex "&$domain$&"
21429.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21430.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21431Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21432variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21433deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21434at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21435other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21436never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21437and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21438.ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21439.ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21440.ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21441
21442
21443
21444
21445
21446
21447
21448. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21449. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21450
21451.chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21452.scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21453.scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21454.scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21455The following generic options apply to all transports:
21456
21457
21458.option body_only transports boolean false
21459.cindex "transport" "body only"
21460.cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21461.cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21462If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21463mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21464or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21465&%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21466automatically suppress them.
21467
21468
21469.option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21470.cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21471This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21472transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21473If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21474logged, and delivery is deferred.
21475
21476
21477.option disable_logging transports boolean false
21478If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21479deliveries by the transport or for any
21480transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21481what you are doing.
21482
21483
21484.option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21485.cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21486If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21487option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21488transport is run.
21489If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21490output, and Exim carries on processing.
21491This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21492so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21493option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21494variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21495one.
21496The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21497transport and the router that called it.
21498
21499.option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21500.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21501If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21502This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21503header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21504requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21505safely be resent to other recipients.
21506
21507
21508.option driver transports string unset
21509This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21510There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21511
21512
21513.option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21514.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21515If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21516This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21517delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21518configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21519address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21520header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21521its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21522resent to other recipients.
21523
21524
21525.option event_action transports string&!! unset
21526.cindex events
21527This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21528For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21529
21530
21531.option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21532.cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21533This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21534value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21535&%user%& (see below).
21536
21537
21538.option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21539.cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21540.cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21541This option specifies a list of text headers,
21542newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21543which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21544portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21545&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21546routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21547is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21548errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21549
21550Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21551for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21552
21553
21554.option headers_only transports boolean false
21555.cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21556.cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21557.cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21558If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21559exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21560transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21561checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21562
21563
21564.option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21565.cindex "header lines" "removing"
21566.cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21567This option specifies a list of header names,
21568colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
21569these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21570in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21571routers.
21572Each list item is separately expanded.
21573If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21574is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21575errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21576
21577Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21578for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21579
21580&*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21581items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21582To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21583
21584
21585
21586.option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21587.cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21588.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21589This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21590that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21591option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21592the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21593message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21594example,
21595.code
21596headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21597 x@y w@z
21598.endd
21599changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21600&'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21601header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21602only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21603the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21604filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21605affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21606envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21607change envelope recipients at this time.
21608
21609
21610.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21611.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21612.vindex "&$home$&"
21613This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21614overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21615placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21616used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21617&%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21618&%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21619for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21620deferred.
21621
21622
21623.option initgroups transports boolean false
21624.cindex "additional groups"
21625.cindex "groups" "additional"
21626.cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21627If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21628transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21629to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21630
21631
21632.option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21633.cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21634.cindex transport "parallel processes"
21635.cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21636.cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21637If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21638it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21639The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21640
21641.cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21642Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21643incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21644is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21645Obviously there is scope for
21646records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21647guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21648
21649If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21650relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21651start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21652may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21653are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21654
21655
21656.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21657.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21658.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21659.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21660This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21661expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21662digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21663including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21664delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21665message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21666the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21667ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21668&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21669delivered.
21670
21671
21672
21673.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21674.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21675.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21676.cindex "local part" "prefix"
21677.cindex "local part" "suffix"
21678When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21679affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21680form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21681that contains
21682.code
21683local_part_prefix = *-
21684.endd
21685routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21686is delivered with
21687.code
21688RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21689.endd
21690This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21691recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21692whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21693deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21694&(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21695
21696
21697.option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21698.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21699When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21700in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21701is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21702deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21703part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21704temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21705deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21706
21707However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21708as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21709(For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21710this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21711
21712For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21713the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21714on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21715
21716
21717.option return_path transports string&!! unset
21718.cindex "envelope sender"
21719.cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21720.cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21721If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21722the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21723that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21724designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21725SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21726only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21727header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21728
21729&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21730&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21731
21732.vindex "&$return_path$&"
21733The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21734either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21735&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21736replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21737option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21738section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21739
21740&*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21741remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21742the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21743This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21744&%errors_to%& in a router.
21745
21746
21747
21748.option return_path_add transports boolean false
21749.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21750If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21751Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21752mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21753have easy access to it.
21754
21755RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21756the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21757header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21758option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21759incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21760recipients.
21761
21762
21763.option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21764See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21765
21766
21767.option shadow_transport transports string unset
21768.cindex "shadow transport"
21769.cindex "transport" "shadow"
21770A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21771another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21772
21773Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21774&%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21775string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21776passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21777expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21778cause a log line to be written.
21779
21780The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21781subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21782provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21783is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21784ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21785of the form
21786.code
21787ST=<shadow transport name>
21788.endd
21789If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21790parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21791purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21792provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21793headers that some sites insist on.
21794
21795
21796.option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21797.cindex "transport" "filter"
21798.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21799This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21800at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21801individual users or via a system filter.
21802If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21803
21804When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21805&%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21806the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21807input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21808command must be specified as an absolute path.
21809
21810The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21811terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21812SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21813lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21814settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21815&(pipe)& transports.
21816
21817The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21818standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21819destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21820filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21821are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21822
21823The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21824care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21825test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21826SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21827
21828.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21829A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21830at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21831message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21832a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21833not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21834
21835.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21836A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21837being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21838support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21839at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21840more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21841the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21842additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21843
21844.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21845The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21846the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21847parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21848Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21849section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21850to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21851of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21852an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21853&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21854
21855.vindex "&$host$&"
21856.vindex "&$host_address$&"
21857The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21858transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21859which the message is being sent. For example:
21860.code
21861transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21862 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21863.endd
21864
21865Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21866generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21867command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21868.ilist
21869If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21870part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21871expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21872example:
21873.code
21874transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21875.endd
21876This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21877&(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21878stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21879the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21880&`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21881Exim tried to expand the first one.
21882.next
21883Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21884expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21885arguments. Consider this example:
21886.code
21887transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21888 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21889.endd
21890The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21891if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21892.code
21893transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21894 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21895.endd
21896.endlist
21897
21898The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21899For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21900normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21901A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21902serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21903the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21904bounced from a transport filter.
21905
21906If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21907passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21908message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21909
21910
21911.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21912.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21913When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21914that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21915temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21916&(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21917way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21918error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21919becomes a temporary error.
21920
21921
21922.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21923.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21924.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21925This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21926run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21927given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21928associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21929option is not set.
21930
21931For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21932specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21933&%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21934
21935.cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21936For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21937sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21938to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21939retry data.
21940.ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21941.ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21942.ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21943
21944
21945
21946
21947
21948
21949. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21950. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21951
21952.chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21953 "Address batching"
21954.cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21955The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21956one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21957remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21958normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21959transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21960copy of the message is delivered each time.
21961
21962.cindex "batched local delivery"
21963.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21964.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21965In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21966local transport, for example:
21967
21968.ilist
21969In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21970delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21971recipients saves space.
21972.next
21973In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21974a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21975.next
21976In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21977to a scanner program or
21978to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21979acceptable.
21980.endlist
21981
21982These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21983(&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21984repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21985
21986The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21987delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21988(no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21989&%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21990(that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
21991to certain conditions:
21992
21993.ilist
21994.vindex "&$local_part$&"
21995If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
21996batching is possible.
21997.next
21998.vindex "&$domain$&"
21999If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22000addresses with the same domain are batched.
22001.next
22002.cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22003If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22004addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22005customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22006including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22007from taking place.
22008.next
22009Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22010delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22011group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22012be the same.
22013.endlist
22014
22015In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22016both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22017is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22018course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22019option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22020&"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22021&%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22022.code
22023check_string = "."
22024escape_string = ".."
22025.endd
22026when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22027given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22028&%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22029
22030.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22031If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22032&'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22033that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22034transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22035addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22036
22037.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22038.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22039If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22040transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22041the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22042of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22043argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22044delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22045are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22046
22047
22048
22049
22050. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22051. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22052
22053.chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22054.scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22055.scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22056.cindex "directory creation"
22057.cindex "creating directories"
22058The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22059file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22060files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22061format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22062University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22063being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22064to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22065delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22066supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22067directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22068
22069The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22070default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22071SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22072included.
22073
22074.cindex "quota" "system"
22075Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22076also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22077system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22078
22079If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22080partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22081modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22082creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22083
22084Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22085file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22086private options.
22087
22088The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22089users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22090putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22091&"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22092option).
22093
22094
22095
22096.section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22097The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22098the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22099the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22100normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22101
22102.vindex "&$address_file$&"
22103.vindex "&$local_part$&"
22104However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22105directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22106forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22107user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22108the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22109name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22110operation. There are two cases:
22111
22112.ilist
22113If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22114must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22115common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22116different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22117default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22118name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22119&%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22120.next
22121If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22122used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22123contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22124.endlist
22125
22126
22127.cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22128.cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22129As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22130have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22131form:
22132.code
22133save folder23
22134.endd
22135or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22136.code
22137require "fileinto";
22138fileinto "folder23";
22139.endd
22140In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22141must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22142case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22143is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22144way of handling this requirement:
22145.code
22146file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22147 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
22148 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22149 {$address_file} \
22150 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22151 }} \
22152 }
22153.endd
22154With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22155location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22156&_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22157
22158&*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22159&_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22160the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22161you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22162&%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22163path to the transport.
22164
22165&*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22166the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22167
22168
22169
22170
22171.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22172.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22173
22174
22175
22176.option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22177.cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22178.cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22179.cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22180Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22181regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22182delivery is deferred.
22183
22184
22185.option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22186.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22187.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22188By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22189that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22190are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22191what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22192are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22193
22194
22195.option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22196See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22197However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22198happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22199file.
22200
22201
22202.option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22203See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22204
22205
22206.option check_group appendfile boolean false
22207When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22208option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22209delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22210file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22211
22212
22213.option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22214When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22215is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22216process is running.
22217
22218
22219.option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22220.cindex "&""From""& line"
22221As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22222matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22223replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22224a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22225contains is significant.
22226
22227If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22228are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22229configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22230&">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22231&%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22232
22233The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22234suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22235&"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22236if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22237.cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22238.cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22239.code
22240check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22241escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22242message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22243message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22244.endd
22245.option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22246.cindex "directory creation"
22247When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22248directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22249is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22250
22251The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22252operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22253example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22254is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22255in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22256
22257
22258
22259.option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22260This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22261by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22262directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22263delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22264beneath.
22265
22266The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22267&"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22268set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22269given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22270are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22271by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22272&%file_must_exist%&.
22273
22274
22275.option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22276This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22277or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22278redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22279
22280When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22281into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22282appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22283(see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22284&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22285
22286
22287.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22288.cindex "base62"
22289.vindex "&$inode$&"
22290When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22291&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22292whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22293.code
22294q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22295.endd
22296This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22297inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22298option.
22299
22300
22301.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22302If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22303&%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22304
22305
22306.option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22307See &%check_string%& above.
22308
22309
22310.option file appendfile string&!! unset
22311This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22312&%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22313of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22314specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22315&%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22316&%file%&.
22317
22318.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22319.cindex "locking files"
22320.cindex "lock files"
22321If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22322mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22323
22324The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22325path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22326examples:
22327.code
22328file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22329file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22330file = $home/inbox
22331.endd
22332.cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22333In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22334is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22335create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22336deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22337run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22338
22339
22340
22341.option file_format appendfile string unset
22342.cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22343This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22344before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22345start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22346colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22347second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22348string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22349transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22350this added to it:
22351.code
22352file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22353 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22354.endd
22355Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22356a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22357to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22358to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22359is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22360match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22361delivery is deferred.
22362
22363
22364.option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22365If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22366A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22367If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22368
22369
22370.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22371.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22372.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22373.cindex "locking files"
22374By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22375when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22376sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22377Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22378for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22379deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22380mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22381misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22382
22383On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22384not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22385is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22386and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22387
22388If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22389timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22390retries is
22391.code
22392(lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22393.endd
22394rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22395which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22396&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22397
22398You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22399local deliveries because of errors of the form
22400.code
22401failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22402.endd
22403
22404.option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22405This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22406&%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22407&%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22408
22409
22410.option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22411This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22412for details of locking.
22413
22414
22415.option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22416This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22417is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22418
22419
22420.option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22421This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22422used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22423
22424
22425.option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22426.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22427When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22428exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22429accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22430
22431
22432.option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22433.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22434.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22435If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22436number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22437followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22438external source that maintains the data.
22439
22440
22441.option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22442.cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22443.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22444If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22445size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22446This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22447maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22448it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22449
22450
22451
22452.option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22453.cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22454If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22455file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22456transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22457&(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22458&%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22459directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22460SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22461&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22462
22463
22464.option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22465.cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22466.cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22467This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22468a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22469directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22470calculation. The default value is:
22471.code
22472maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22473.endd
22474This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22475(directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22476&_Trash_&
22477folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22478.code
22479maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22480.endd
22481This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22482directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22483calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22484directly into that directory.
22485
22486
22487.option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22488This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22489&"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22490
22491
22492.option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22493This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22494section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22495
22496
22497.option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22498.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22499The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22500If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22501creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22502quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22503value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22504&<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22505
22506.option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22507.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22508.cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22509The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22510effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22511matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22512containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22513delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22514&_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22515See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22516
22517
22518.option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22519.cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22520If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22521new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22522SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22523below for further details.
22524
22525
22526.option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22527This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22528section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22529
22530
22531.option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22532This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22533section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22534
22535
22536.option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22537.cindex "locking files"
22538.cindex "file" "locking"
22539.cindex "file" "MBX format"
22540.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22541This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22542set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22543the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22544traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22545IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22546
22547&*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22548automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22549empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22550combination:
22551.code
22552mbx_format = true
22553message_prefix =
22554message_suffix =
22555.endd
22556If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22557&%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22558is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22559&%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22560interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22561should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22562going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22563mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22564
22565If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22566the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22567(this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22568append messages to it.
22569
22570
22571.option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22572.cindex "&""From""& line"
22573The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22574The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22575in which case it is:
22576.code
22577message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22578 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22579.endd
22580&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22581&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22582
22583.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22584The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22585The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22586in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22587setting
22588.code
22589message_suffix =
22590.endd
22591&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22592&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22593
22594.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22595If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22596has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22597permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22598if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22599a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22600value, and this option is ignored.
22601
22602
22603.option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22604This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22605mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22606true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22607continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22608
22609
22610.option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22611If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22612successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22613on users about incoming mail.
22614
22615
22616.option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22617.cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22618This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22619or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22620is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22621all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22622individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22623&%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22624have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22625
22626As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22627multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22628For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22629
22630A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22631may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22632If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22633become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22634Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22635the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22636
22637The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22638(decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22639for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22640and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22641large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22642be handled.
22643
22644The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22645quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22646
22647&*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22648
22649The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22650the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22651be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22652fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22653system quota failures.
22654
22655By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22656mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22657last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22658during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22659refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22660message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22661changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22662for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22663continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22664delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22665
22666
22667.option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22668This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22669into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22670called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22671delivery directory.
22672
22673
22674.option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22675This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22676number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22677can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22678failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22679&"no quota"&.
22680
22681The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22682quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22683
22684.option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22685See &%quota%& above.
22686
22687
22688.option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22689This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22690for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22691these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22692If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
22693captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22694file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22695
22696This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22697&-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22698facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22699the file length to the filename. For example:
22700.code
22701maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22702quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22703.endd
22704An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22705number of lines in the message.
22706
22707The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22708filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22709sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
22710
22711Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22712
22713
22714.option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22715See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22716&%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22717.code
22718quota_warn_message = "\
22719 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22720 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22721 This message is automatically created \
22722 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22723 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22724 a warning threshold that is\n\
22725 set by the system administrator.\n"
22726.endd
22727
22728
22729.option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22730.cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22731.cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22732.cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22733This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22734resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22735size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22736threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22737may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22738sign. For example:
22739.code
22740quota = 10M
22741quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22742.endd
22743If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22744percent sign is ignored.
22745
22746The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22747and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22748warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22749the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22750can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22751&'From:'& line, the default is:
22752.code
22753From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22754.endd
22755.oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22756If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22757option.
22758
22759The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22760are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22761percentage.
22762
22763
22764.option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22765.cindex "envelope sender"
22766If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22767format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22768you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22769so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22770for details of batch SMTP.
22771
22772
22773.option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22774.cindex "carriage return"
22775.cindex "linefeed"
22776This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22777(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22778of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22779of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22780
22781&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22782(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22783in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22784carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22785have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22786changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22787
22788
22789.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22790This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22791exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22792&%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22793that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22794&%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22795
22796
22797.option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22798This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22799the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22800&[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22801each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22802
22803This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22804&[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22805where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22806both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22807
22808.cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22809Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22810have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22811&[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22812the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22813error.
22814
22815&*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22816is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22817
22818
22819.option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22820If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22821appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22822&[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22823sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22824&[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22825delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22826
22827.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22828In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22829necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22830achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22831file corruption.
22832
22833The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22834It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22835except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22836
22837
22838.option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22839This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22840set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22841locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22842of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22843are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22844the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22845rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22846does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22847
22848You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22849&%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22850MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22851without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22852
22853
22854
22855
22856.section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22857.cindex "appending to a file"
22858.cindex "file" "appending"
22859Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22860
22861.ilist
22862If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22863return is given.
22864
22865.next
22866.cindex "directory creation"
22867If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22868&%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22869&%directory_mode%& option.
22870
22871.next
22872If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22873indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22874transport.
22875
22876.next
22877.cindex "file" "locking"
22878.cindex "locking files"
22879.cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22880If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22881reliably over NFS, as follows:
22882
22883.olist
22884Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22885current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22886as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22887.next
22888Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
22889.next
22890If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22891Unlink the hitching post name.
22892.next
22893Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22894then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22895of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22896restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22897.next
22898If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22899up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22900mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22901lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22902existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22903it before trying again.
22904.endlist olist
22905
22906.next
22907A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22908so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22909than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22910
22911.next
22912.cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22913.cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22914If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22915&%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22916checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22917is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22918ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22919directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22920idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22921checked.
22922
22923.next
22924If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22925and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22926different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22927delivery is deferred.
22928
22929.next
22930If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22931If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22932is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22933permissions.
22934
22935.next
22936The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22937If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22938hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22939
22940.next
22941If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22942changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22943have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22944
22945.next
22946If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22947option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22948directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22949open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22950except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22951set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22952the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22953that prevents link following.
22954
22955.next
22956.cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22957If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22958existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22959being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22960after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22961
22962.next
22963If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22964
22965.next
22966.cindex "file" "locking"
22967.cindex "locking files"
22968Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22969are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22970&%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22971However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22972file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22973.code
22974/tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22975.endd
22976using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22977the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22978the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22979
22980If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22981depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22982&%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22983
22984If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22985&%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22986to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22987delivery is deferred.
22988
22989If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22990&[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
22991waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
22992immediately. It retries up to
22993.code
22994(lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
22995.endd
22996times (rounded up).
22997.endlist
22998
22999At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23000and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23001
23002
23003.section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23004.cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23005.cindex "&""From""& line"
23006When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23007delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23008activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23009&%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23010router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23011configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23012ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23013
23014No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23015locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23016separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23017of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23018newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23019&%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23020any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23021
23022If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23023the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23024different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23025deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23026
23027
23028.cindex "maildir format"
23029.cindex "mailstore format"
23030There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23031done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23032&%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23033formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23034SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23035
23036.cindex "directory creation"
23037In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23038sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23039option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23040constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23041the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23042&%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23043deferred.
23044
23045
23046
23047.section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23048.cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23049If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23050it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23051directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23052directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23053&_new_& subdirectory.
23054
23055In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23056<&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23057Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23058before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23059filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23060opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23061Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23062
23063Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23064called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23065do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23066path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23067&%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23068contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23069&_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23070&_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23071
23072These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23073and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23074folders. Consider this example:
23075.code
23076maildir_format = true
23077directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
23078 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23079 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23080maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23081.endd
23082If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23083delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23084the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23085not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23086&_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23087&_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23088
23089However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23090delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23091does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23092&_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23093directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23094
23095&*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23096not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23097&_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23098
23099.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23100.cindex "maildir++"
23101If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23102&%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23103the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23104Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23105down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23106the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23107amount of space used.
23108
23109One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23110computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23111checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23112needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23113use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23114of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23115
23116
23117
23118
23119.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23120If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23121When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23122tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23123name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23124the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23125
23126
23127.vindex "&$message_size$&"
23128Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23129&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23130happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23131variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23132forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23133be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23134Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23135empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23136colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23137maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23138backwards compatibility).
23139
23140For one common implementation, you might set:
23141.code
23142maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23143.endd
23144but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23145
23146It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23147as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23148&[stat()]& each message file.
23149
23150
23151.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23152.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23153.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23154If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23155storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23156within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23157creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23158the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23159to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23160
23161The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23162messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23163in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23164value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23165is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23166need to know the quota.
23167
23168If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23169file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23170
23171A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23172maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23173See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23174details.
23175
23176
23177.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23178.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23179If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23180files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23181message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23182this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23183contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23184itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23185
23186During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23187&_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23188&_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23189mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23190file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23191the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23192
23193The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23194option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23195the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23196There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23197greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23198appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23199
23200If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23201failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23202configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23203&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23204
23205
23206.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23207If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23208file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23209messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23210section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23211.code
23212directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23213.endd
23214might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23215then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23216expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23217.ecindex IIDapptra1
23218.ecindex IIDapptra2
23219
23220
23221
23222
23223
23224
23225. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23226. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23227
23228.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23229.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23230.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23231The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23232the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23233automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23234&'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23235to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23236
23237If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23238&%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23239delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23240that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23241another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23242
23243
23244The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23245&"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23246directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23247message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23248empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23249
23250The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23251by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23252passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23253transport is run as a consequence of a
23254&%mail%&
23255or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23256supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23257that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23258case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23259is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23260&%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23261
23262&(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23263command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23264gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23265&<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23266
23267There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23268that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23269&(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23270address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23271separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23272the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23273message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23274
23275Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23276message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23277immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23278the transport defers.
23279Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23280controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23281
23282If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23283&%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23284of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23285&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23286
23287.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23288If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23289the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23290as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23291is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23292problems. They are just discarded.
23293
23294
23295
23296.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23297.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23298
23299.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23300This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23301message when the message is specified by the transport.
23302
23303
23304.option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23305This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23306when the message is specified by the transport.
23307
23308
23309.option file autoreply string&!! unset
23310The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23311is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23312string comes first.
23313
23314
23315.option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23316If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23317subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23318
23319
23320.option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23321If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23322option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23323
23324
23325.option from autoreply string&!! unset
23326This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23327specified by the transport.
23328
23329
23330.option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23331This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23332when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23333&"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23334
23335
23336.option log autoreply string&!! unset
23337This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23338the message is specified by the transport.
23339
23340
23341.option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23342If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23343used.
23344
23345
23346.option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23347If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23348item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23349discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23350generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23351
23352
23353
23354.option once autoreply string&!! unset
23355This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23356recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23357This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23358
23359If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23360By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23361is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23362However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23363message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23364this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23365prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23366infinity.
23367
23368If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23369and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23370greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23371Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23372regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23373
23374In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23375which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23376be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23377means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23378unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23379file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23380
23381
23382.option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23383See &%once%& above.
23384
23385
23386.option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23387See &%once%& above.
23388After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23389
23390
23391.option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23392This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23393specified by the transport.
23394
23395
23396.option return_message autoreply boolean false
23397If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23398message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23399configuration option.
23400
23401
23402.option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23403This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23404specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23405automatic responses. For example:
23406.code
23407subject = Re: $h_subject:
23408.endd
23409There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23410subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23411bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23412non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23413small.
23414
23415
23416
23417.option text autoreply string&!! unset
23418This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23419message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23420the text comes first.
23421
23422
23423.option to autoreply string&!! unset
23424This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23425when the message is specified by the transport.
23426.ecindex IIDauttra1
23427.ecindex IIDauttra2
23428
23429
23430
23431
23432. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23433. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23434
23435.chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23436.cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23437.cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23438.cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23439.cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23440The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23441specified command
23442or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23443This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23444transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23445implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23446to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23447has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23448.code
23449TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
23450.endd
23451.cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23452is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23453included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23454as follows:
23455
23456.option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23457See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23458
23459
23460.option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23461This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23462Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23463good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23464batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23465
23466
23467.option command lmtp string&!! unset
23468This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23469is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23470arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23471number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23472is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23473LMTP protocol.
23474
23475.option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23476.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23477If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23478commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23479in its response to the LHLO command.
23480
23481.option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23482This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23483be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23484delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23485
23486
23487.option timeout lmtp time 5m
23488The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23489respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23490is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23491LMTP transport:
23492.code
23493lmtp:
23494 driver = lmtp
23495 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23496 batch_max = 20
23497 user = exim
23498.endd
23499This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23500necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23501
23502
23503
23504. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23505. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23506
23507.chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23508.scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23509.scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23510The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23511running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23512pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23513(such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23514their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23515following ways:
23516
23517.ilist
23518.vindex "&$local_part$&"
23519A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23520transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23521contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23522is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23523.next
23524.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23525If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23526transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23527more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23528(because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23529(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23530that are routed to the transport.
23531.next
23532.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23533A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23534alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23535pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23536&%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23537(&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23538this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23539.endlist
23540
23541
23542The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23543deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23544implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23545
23546In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23547&_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23548other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23549transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23550directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23551details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23552for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23553
23554
23555.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23556If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23557delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23558any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23559write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23560Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23561of "1" to enforce serialization.
23562
23563
23564
23565
23566.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23567.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23568If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23569have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23570the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23571in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23572later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23573logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23574&"local delivery failed"&.
23575
23576If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23577the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23578will be sent as normal.
23579
23580If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23581script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23582value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23583apply in this case.
23584
23585If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23586return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23587asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23588a non-existent command may be the problem.
23589
23590The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23591set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23592error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23593return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23594included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23595similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23596failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23597&%temp_errors%&.
23598
23599
23600
23601.section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23602.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23603The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23604by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23605&%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23606run.
23607
23608.cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23609Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23610double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23611way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23612
23613String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23614traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23615expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23616For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23617quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23618.code
23619command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23620.endd
23621will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23622arguments. You have to write
23623.code
23624command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23625.endd
23626to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23627argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23628result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23629interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23630generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23631expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23632example:
23633.code
23634command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23635.endd
23636
23637.cindex "transport" "filter"
23638.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23639.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23640Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23641&`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
23642This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23643place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23644transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23645inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23646avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23647&(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23648
23649If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23650for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23651is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23652argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23653&'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23654the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23655should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23656run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23657
23658After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23659in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23660message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23661standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23662read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23663may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23664control what is done with it.
23665
23666Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23667in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23668taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23669explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23670where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23671under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23672an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23673works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23674as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23675&%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23676with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23677
23678
23679
23680.section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23681.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23682.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23683The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23684This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23685the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23686environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23687to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23688.display
23689&`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23690&`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23691&`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23692&`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23693&`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23694&`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23695&`LOGNAME `& see below
23696&`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23697&`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23698&`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23699&`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23700&`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23701&`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23702&`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23703&`USER `& see below
23704.endd
23705When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23706router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23707called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23708the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23709removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23710LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23711same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23712
23713.cindex "HOST"
23714HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23715associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23716pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23717the router.
23718
23719.cindex "HOME"
23720If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23721for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23722by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23723user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23724
23725
23726.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23727.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23728
23729
23730
23731.option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23732.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23733The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23734permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23735permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23736paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23737&%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23738in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23739the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23740&%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23741otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23742example, if
23743.code
23744allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23745.endd
23746and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23747&_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23748&%use_shell%& is set.
23749
23750
23751.option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23752See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23753
23754
23755.option batch_max pipe integer 1
23756This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23757See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23758
23759
23760.option check_string pipe string unset
23761As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23762&%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23763by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23764&%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23765any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23766of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23767the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23768ignored.
23769
23770
23771.option command pipe string&!! unset
23772This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23773obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23774set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23775the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23776Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23777&<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23778
23779
23780.option environment pipe string&!! unset
23781.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23782.cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23783This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23784command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23785a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23786environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23787
23788
23789.option escape_string pipe string unset
23790See &%check_string%& above.
23791
23792
23793.option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23794.cindex "exec failure"
23795.cindex "failure of exec"
23796.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23797Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23798any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23799is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23800frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23801
23802
23803.option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23804.cindex "signal exit"
23805.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23806Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23807a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23808frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23809
23810
23811.option force_command pipe boolean false
23812.cindex "force command"
23813.cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23814Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23815the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23816is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23817useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23818command. For example:
23819.code
23820command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23821force_command
23822.endd
23823
23824Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23825&%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23826separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23827
23828
23829.option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23830If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23831run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23832Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23833from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23834&%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23835
23836&*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23837See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23838
23839
23840.option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23841.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23842If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23843one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23844and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23845written to the main log.
23846
23847
23848.option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23849If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23850stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23851the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23852failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23853option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23854be set.
23855
23856
23857.option log_output pipe boolean false
23858If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23859stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23860the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23861exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23862
23863
23864.option max_output pipe integer 20K
23865This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23866standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23867process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23868catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23869the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23870&%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23871exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23872
23873
23874.option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23875The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23876The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23877.code
23878message_prefix = \
23879 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23880 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
23881.endd
23882.cindex "Cyrus"
23883.cindex "&%tmail%&"
23884.cindex "&""From""& line"
23885This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23886However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23887or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23888setting
23889.code
23890message_prefix =
23891.endd
23892&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23893&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23894
23895
23896.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23897The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23898The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23899The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23900.code
23901message_suffix =
23902.endd
23903&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23904&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23905
23906
23907.option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23908This option is expanded and
23909specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23910variable of the subprocess.
23911If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23912sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23913apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23914
23915
23916.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23917Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23918a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23919during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23920It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23921for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23922resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23923installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23924of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23925
23926
23927.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23928.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23929If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23930process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23931to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23932&%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23933accept the message is used.
23934
23935
23936.option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23937When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23938contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23939in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23940command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23941handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23942
23943
23944.option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23945If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23946return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23947is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23948However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23949message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23950&%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23951
23952
23953
23954.option return_output pipe boolean false
23955If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23956deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23957is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23958However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23959output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23960option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23961of them may be set.
23962
23963
23964
23965.option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23966.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23967This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23968asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23969and &%return_output%& is not set,
23970and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23971temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23972numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23973codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23974defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23975compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23976and 73, respectively.
23977
23978
23979.option timeout pipe time 1h
23980If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23981causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23982specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23983command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23984and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23985if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23986
23987.option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23988A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23989runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23990treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
23991is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
23992delivery to be deferred.
23993
23994.option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
23995This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
23996
23997
23998.option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
23999.cindex "envelope sender"
24000If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24001SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24002commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24003you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24004&<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24005
24006.option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24007.cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24008This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24009BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24010resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24011limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24012class database.
24013
24014
24015.option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24016.cindex "carriage return"
24017.cindex "linefeed"
24018This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24019(carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24020of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24021of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24022
24023The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24024written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24025are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24026&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24027values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24028
24029
24030.option use_shell pipe boolean false
24031.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24032If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24033instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24034&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24035where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24036modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24037&`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24038command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24039its &%-c%& option.
24040
24041
24042
24043.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24044.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24045.cindex "&'procmail'&"
24046.cindex "external local delivery"
24047.cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24048.cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24049The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24050delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24051this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24052uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24053by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24054necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24055appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24056configuration for &%procmail%&:
24057.code
24058# transport
24059procmail_pipe:
24060 driver = pipe
24061 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24062 return_path_add
24063 delivery_date_add
24064 envelope_to_add
24065 check_string = "From "
24066 escape_string = ">From "
24067 umask = 077
24068 user = $local_part
24069 group = mail
24070
24071# router
24072procmail:
24073 driver = accept
24074 check_local_user
24075 transport = procmail_pipe
24076.endd
24077In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24078&'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24079or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24080user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24081&%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24082home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24083
24084&*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24085.code
24086IFS=" "
24087.endd
24088as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24089use a shell to run pipe commands.
24090
24091.cindex "Cyrus"
24092The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24093deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24094.code
24095# transport
24096local_delivery_cyrus:
24097 driver = pipe
24098 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24099 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24100 user = cyrus
24101 group = mail
24102 return_output
24103 log_output
24104 message_prefix =
24105 message_suffix =
24106
24107# router
24108local_user_cyrus:
24109 driver = accept
24110 check_local_user
24111 local_part_suffix = .*
24112 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24113.endd
24114Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24115&%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24116sender.
24117.ecindex IIDpiptra1
24118.ecindex IIDpiptra2
24119
24120
24121. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24122. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24123
24124.chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24125.scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24126.scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24127The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24128or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24129that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24130explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24131&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24132
24133
24134.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24135The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24136two ways:
24137
24138.ilist
24139If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24140routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24141that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24142the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24143does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24144value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24145section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24146.next
24147.cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24148When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24149looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24150connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24151for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24152process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24153process.
24154.endlist
24155
24156
24157For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24158incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24159no further messages are sent over that connection.
24160
24161
24162
24163.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24164.vindex "&$host$&"
24165.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24166At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24167&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24168passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24169specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24170&$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24171that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24172&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24173
24174
24175.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24176.vindex &$tls_bits$&
24177.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24178.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24179.vindex &$tls_sni$&
24180At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24181&$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24182are the values that were set when the message was received.
24183These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24184SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24185variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24186appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24187are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24188&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24189
24190These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24191and will be removed in a future release.
24192
24193
24194.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24195.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24196The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24197
24198
24199.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24200.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24201When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24202is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24203runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24204reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24205setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24206problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24207
24208.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24209.cindex "local host" "sending to"
24210.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24211When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24212to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24213deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24214the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24215configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24216configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24217
24218
24219.option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24220.cindex "Cyrus"
24221When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24222is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24223overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24224forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24225to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24226ignored.
24227
24228The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24229started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24230&$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24231particular connection.
24232
24233If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24234&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24235deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24236unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24237
24238This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24239deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24240&"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24241.code
24242authenticated_sender = $local_part
24243.endd
24244This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24245allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24246
24247Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24248domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24249value.
24250
24251
24252.option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24253If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24254is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24255authenticated as a client.
24256
24257
24258.option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24259This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24260sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24261remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24262
24263
24264.option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24265This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24266to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24267several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24268less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24269systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24270option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24271
24272
24273.option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24274.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24275.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24276.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24277This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24278over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24279For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24280option.
24281
24282
24283.option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24284.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24285.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24286.cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24287This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24288where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24289If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24290Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24291configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24292been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24293TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24294counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24295If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24296be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24297
24298
24299.option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24300This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24301the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24302of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24303
24304
24305.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24306.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24307.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24308.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24309.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24310.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24311.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24312.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24313.option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24314DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24315
24316
24317.option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24318.cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24319.cindex retry "final cutoff"
24320This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24321domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24322cutoff times.
24323
24324In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24325them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24326Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24327retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24328a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24329unhappy at this prospect, so...
24330
24331If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24332addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24333IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24334none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24335delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24336addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24337continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24338&%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24339to them.
24340
24341
24342.option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24343If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24344and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24345the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24346in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24347
24348
24349.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24350If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24351&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24352See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24353details.
24354
24355
24356.option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24357.cindex "MX record" "security"
24358.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24359.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24360.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24361DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24362the dnssec request bit set.
24363This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24364
24365
24366
24367.option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24368.cindex "MX record" "security"
24369.cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24370.cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24371.cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24372DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24373the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
24374(AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
24375This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24376
24377
24378
24379.option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24380.cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24381This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24382of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24383The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24384Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24385&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24386
24387The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24388(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24389that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24390equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24391Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24392
24393
24394.option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24395.cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24396String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24397colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24398port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24399&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24400item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24401in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24402
24403Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24404addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24405&%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24406not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24407&%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24408However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24409
24410If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24411the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24412transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24413address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24414list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24415
24416Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24417re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24418addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24419copy of the message is sent.
24420
24421The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24422&%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24423both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24424from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24425fails"& facility.
24426
24427
24428.option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24429This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24430line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24431zero.
24432
24433.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24434If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24435being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24436(or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24437instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24438it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24439
24440.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24441This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24442server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24443implementations of TLS.
24444
24445.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24446.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24447.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24448.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24449The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24450been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24451command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24452option is:
24453.code
24454$primary_hostname
24455.endd
24456During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24457the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24458&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24459used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24460servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24461that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24462interface address, you could use this:
24463.code
24464helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24465 {$primary_hostname}}
24466.endd
24467The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24468callouts.
24469
24470.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24471Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24472finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24473&(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24474email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24475all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24476
24477The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24478processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24479&%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24480&%hosts_override%& is set.
24481
24482The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24483list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24484separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24485&<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24486item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24487in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24488of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24489
24490If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24491the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24492well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24493address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24494&[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24495&%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24496that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24497address are used.
24498
24499During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24500unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24501
24502
24503.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24504.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24505.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24506.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24507.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24508This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24509example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24510matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24511start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24512facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24513
24514
24515.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24516.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24517Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24518that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24519
24520
24521.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24522.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24523Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24524matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24525
24526.option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24527.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24528Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24529or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24530to any host that matches this list.
24531
24532
24533.option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24534.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24535.cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24536.cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24537.cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24538This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24539delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24540&<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24541
24542
24543.option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24544This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24545tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24546why it exists.
24547
24548
24549
24550.option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24551.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24552.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24553.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24554For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24555been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24556message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24557explanation of when this might be needed.
24558
24559.option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24560.cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24561.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24562.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24563For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24564been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24565message on the same session.
24566
24567The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24568process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24569sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24570instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24571the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24572The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24573logging.
24574
24575
24576
24577.option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24578If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24579attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24580&%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24581&%fallback_hosts%&.
24582
24583
24584.option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24585.cindex "randomized host list"
24586.cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24587.cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24588If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24589&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24590were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24591router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24592is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24593list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24594
24595When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24596order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24597behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24598&`+`& in the host list. For example:
24599.code
24600hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24601.endd
24602The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24603randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24604If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24605
24606.option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24607.cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24608This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24609before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24610servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24611authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24612temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24613hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24614&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24615
24616
24617.option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24618.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24619Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24620TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24621&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24622
24623.option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24624.cindex DANE "transport options"
24625.cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24626If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24627TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24628and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
24629There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24630See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24631
24632.option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24633.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24634Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24635TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24636&%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24637
24638.option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24639.cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24640Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24641matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24642&*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24643incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24644
24645.option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24646.cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24647This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24648authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24649connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24650unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24651&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24652
24653.option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24654.cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24655.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24656.cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24657This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24658CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24659BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24660
24661.option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24662.cindex DANE "transport options"
24663.cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24664If built with DANE support, Exim will lookup a
24665TLSA record for any host matching the list.
24666If found and verified by DNSSEC,
24667a DANE-verified TLS connection is made to that host;
24668there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24669See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24670
24671.option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" unset
24672.cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24673.cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24674.cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24675This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24676the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24677perform a TCP Fast Open.
24678No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24679supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24680the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24681
24682The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24683as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24684
24685On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24686in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24687There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24688it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24689such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24690
24691.option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24692.cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24693This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24694PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24695for multi-recipient messages.
24696The option can usually be left as default.
24697
24698.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24699.cindex "bind IP address"
24700.cindex "IP address" "binding"
24701.vindex "&$host$&"
24702.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24703This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24704call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24705&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24706message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24707&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24708outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24709interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24710unknown.
24711
24712During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24713&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24714during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24715string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24716string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24717separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
24718For example:
24719.code
24720interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24721.endd
24722The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24723connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24724&%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24725interface to use if the host has more than one.
24726
24727
24728.option keepalive smtp boolean true
24729.cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24730This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24731connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24732periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24733of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24734or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24735that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24736that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24737TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24738unreachable hosts.
24739
24740
24741.option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24742.cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24743If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24744string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24745has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24746
24747.option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24748.cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24749This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24750SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24751so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24752permits this.
24753
24754
24755.option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24756.vindex "&$domain$&"
24757When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24758addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24759to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24760handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24761&$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24762is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24763
24764It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24765&$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24766&$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24767
24768.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24769.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24770.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24771This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24772&*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24773received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24774The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24775variable that contains an outgoing port.
24776
24777If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24778otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24779normally &"smtp"&,
24780but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
24781and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
24782If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24783is deferred.
24784
24785Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
24786to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
24787
24788
24789
24790.option protocol smtp string smtp
24791.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24792.cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24793.cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24794.vindex "&$port$&"
24795If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24796the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24797protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24798deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24799over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24800
24801If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24802changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24803connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24804The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
24805but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
24806(as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
24807
24808
24809.option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24810Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24811constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24812means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24813tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24814addresses is not affected.
24815
24816However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24817each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24818the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24819Exim to use only the host name.
24820Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24821
24822
24823.option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24824.cindex "serializing connections"
24825.cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24826Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24827host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24828the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24829slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24830Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24831&%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24832
24833.cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24834Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24835written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24836is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24837records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24838guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24839
24840If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24841relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24842start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24843may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24844are used for ETRN serialization.
24845
24846See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24847
24848
24849.option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24850.cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24851.cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24852.cindex "size" "of message"
24853.cindex "transport" "filter"
24854.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24855If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24856MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24857an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24858sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24859configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24860this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24861
24862Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24863the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24864
24865
24866.option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24867.cindex proxy SOCKS
24868This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24869transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24870
24871
24872.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24873.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24874.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24875.vindex "&$host$&"
24876.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24877The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24878client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24879connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24880address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24881details of TLS.
24882
24883&*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24884certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24885name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24886assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24887client.
24888
24889
24890.option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24891.cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24892.cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24893This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24894be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24895
24896
24897.option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24898.cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24899When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24900key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24901for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24902If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24903will fail.
24904
24905Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24906
24907
24908.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24909.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24910.vindex "&$host$&"
24911.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24912The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24913client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24914connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24915&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24916expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24917result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24918the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24919
24920
24921.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24922.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24923.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24924.vindex "&$host$&"
24925.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24926The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24927when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24928the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24929&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24930expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24931is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24932&<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24933ciphers is a preference order.
24934
24935
24936
24937.option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24938.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24939.vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24940If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24941TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24942the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24943certificate and private key for the session.
24944
24945See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24946
24947Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24948TLS extensions.
24949
24950
24951
24952
24953.option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24954.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24955When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24956setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24957to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24958current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24959option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24960response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24961TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24962unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24963in clear.
24964
24965
24966.option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24967.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24968.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24969This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24970certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24971The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24972Note that unless the host is in this list
24973TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24974when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24975The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24976certificate verification succeeds.
24977
24978
24979.option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24980.cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24981.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24982This option give a list of hosts for which,
24983while verifying the server certificate,
24984checks will be included on the host name
24985(note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24986versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24987limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24988
24989There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
24990
24991
24992.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
24993.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24994.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24995.vindex "&$host$&"
24996.vindex "&$host_address$&"
24997The value of this option must be either the
24998word "system"
24999or the absolute path to
25000a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25001for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25002
25003The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25004This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25005is taken as empty and an explicit location
25006must be specified.
25007
25008The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25009preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25010
25011With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25012explicitly
25013either by file or directory
25014are added to those given by the system default location.
25015
25016The values of &$host$& and
25017&$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25018expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25019
25020For back-compatibility,
25021if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25022(a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25023and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25024
25025
25026.option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25027.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25028.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25029This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25030certificate verification must succeed.
25031The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25032If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25033operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25034
25035.option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25036.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25037.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25038If built with internationalization support,
25039this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25040to a-label form.
25041For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25042
25043
25044
25045
25046.section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25047 "SECTvalhosmax"
25048.cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25049.cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25050There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25051tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25052&%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25053
25054
25055The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25056for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25057option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25058multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25059retrying.
25060
25061Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25062multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25063created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25064
25065Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25066several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25067problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25068&%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25069delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25070
25071Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25072arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25073limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25074some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25075&%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25076that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25077see below for an exception).
25078
25079Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25080list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25081If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25082but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25083that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25084
25085Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25086higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25087hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25088which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25089tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25090reached their retry times.
25091
25092However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25093large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25094Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25095of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25096time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25097without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25098all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25099there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25100the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25101every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25102reached.
25103
25104The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25105particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25106out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25107reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25108been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25109take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25110
25111The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25112Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25113and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25114possible IP addresses have been tried.
25115.ecindex IIDsmttra1
25116.ecindex IIDsmttra2
25117
25118
25119
25120
25121
25122. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25123. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25124
25125.chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25126.scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25127There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25128addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25129(referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25130abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25131
25132Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25133messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25134&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25135appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25136locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25137unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25138lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25139
25140One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25141when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25142such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25143do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25144
25145
25146.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25147This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25148main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25149&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25150
25151Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25152Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25153facility; you do not have to use it.
25154
25155The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25156configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25157addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25158address to which it applies.
25159
25160Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25161the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25162rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25163those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25164by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25165are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25166rules.
25167
25168Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25169applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25170well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25171headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25172
25173
25174In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25175legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25176in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25177used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25178Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25179discouraged.
25180
25181There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25182illustrated by these examples:
25183
25184.ilist
25185The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25186exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25187gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25188&'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25189.next
25190A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25191&'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25192.endlist
25193
25194
25195
25196.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25197.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25198.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25199Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25200message's processing.
25201
25202.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25203At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25204by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25205ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25206is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25207rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25208rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25209RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25210rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25211
25212.vindex "&$domain$&"
25213.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25214Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25215may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25216rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25217from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25218for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25219value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25220as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25221SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25222
25223As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25224recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25225the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25226any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25227.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25228before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25229
25230When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25231rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25232redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25233
25234.cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25235.cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25236.cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25237At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25238specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25239This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25240section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25241header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25242applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25243
25244The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25245transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25246transport time.
25247
25248
25249
25250
25251.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25252.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25253.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25254Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25255configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25256&%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
252572822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25258transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25259appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25260envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25261.code
25262exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25263.endd
25264might produce the output
25265.code
25266sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25267from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25268to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25269cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25270bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25271reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25272env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25273env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25274.endd
25275which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25276the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25277present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25278set for a particular transport.
25279
25280
25281.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25282.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25283The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25284rules in the form
25285.display
25286<&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25287.endd
25288Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25289transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25290takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25291any colons must be doubled, of course).
25292
25293The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25294Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25295case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25296characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25297ignored.
25298
25299For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25300order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25301replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25302
25303The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25304releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25305received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25306lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25307address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25308(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25309that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25310
25311.vindex "&$domain$&"
25312.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25313The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25314string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25315rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25316.code
25317*@* ${lookup ...
25318.endd
25319where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25320refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25321
25322
25323.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25324.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25325.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25326The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25327address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25328single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25329against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25330you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25331facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25332
25333Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25334case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25335can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25336
25337.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25338After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25339depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25340replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25341refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25342numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25343of pattern they are set as follows:
25344
25345.ilist
25346If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25347refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25348the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25349pattern
25350.code
25351*queen@*.fict.example
25352.endd
25353is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25354.code
25355$0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25356$1 = hearts-
25357$2 = wonderland
25358.endd
25359Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25360does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25361
25362.next
25363If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25364of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25365for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25366rewriting rule of the form
25367.display
25368&`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25369.endd
25370and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25371.code
25372$1 = foo
25373$2 = bar
25374$3 = baz.example
25375.endd
25376If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25377wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25378&$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25379partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25380whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25381.endlist
25382
25383
25384.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25385.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25386If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25387match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25388rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25389.code
25390hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25391.endd
25392specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25393&'From:'& headers.
25394
25395.vindex "&$domain$&"
25396.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25397If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25398yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25399&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25400Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25401cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25402matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25403the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25404current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25405expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25406entry written to the panic log.
25407
25408
25409
25410.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25411There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25412
25413.ilist
25414Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25415c, f, h, r, s, t.
25416.next
25417A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25418.next
25419Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25420.endlist
25421
25422For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25423E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25424
25425
25426
25427.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25428 "SECID154"
25429.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25430If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25431&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25432and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25433transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25434rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25435.display
25436&`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25437&`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25438&`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25439&`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25440&`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25441&`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25442&`h`& rewrite all headers
25443&`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25444&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25445&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25446.endd
25447"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25448individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25449other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25450
25451You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25452restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25453
25454
25455.section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25456.cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25457.cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25458.cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25459The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25460SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25461before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25462required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25463data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25464
25465.vindex "&$domain$&"
25466.vindex "&$local_part$&"
25467This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25468compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25469input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25470the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25471expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25472original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25473
25474
25475.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25476There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25477take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25478correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25479
25480.ilist
25481If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25482unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25483absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25484.next
25485If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25486even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25487expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25488(does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25489.next
25490The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25491address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25492rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25493.next
25494.cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25495When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25496to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25497left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25498.code
25499From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25500.endd
25501into
25502.code
25503From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25504.endd
25505.cindex "RFC 2047"
25506Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25507done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25508causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25509replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
255102822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25511brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25512(except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25513is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25514
25515When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25516rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25517.endlist
25518
25519
25520.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25521Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25522.code
25523*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25524*@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25525 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25526.endd
25527Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25528the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25529has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25530consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25531present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25532explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25533at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25534error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25535
25536The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25537domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25538.code
25539root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25540.endd
25541were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25542local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25543
25544Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25545&${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25546messages that originate outside the local host:
25547.code
25548*@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25549 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25550.endd
25551The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25552space.
25553
25554.cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25555.cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25556Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25557an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25558the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25559remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25560sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25561components. For example, the rule
25562.code
25563\N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25564.endd
25565rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25566&'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25567a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25568method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25569to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25570use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25571can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25572.ecindex IIDaddrew
25573
25574
25575
25576
25577
25578. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25579. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25580
25581.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25582.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25583.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25584The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25585retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25586be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25587empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25588errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25589general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25590line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25591address, domain and error.
25592
25593The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25594host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25595Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25596address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25597been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25598tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25599log selector is set, the message
25600.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25601&"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25602skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25603the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25604
25605Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25606in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25607actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25608failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25609the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25610added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25611same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25612domain are maintained independently.
25613
25614When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25615receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25616always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25617behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25618quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25619suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25620subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25621the local address is reached.
25622
25623.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25624If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25625whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25626files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25627always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25628
25629The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25630rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25631record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25632timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25633and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25634messages that it should now be retaining.
25635
25636
25637
25638.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25639.cindex "retry" "rules"
25640Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25641separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25642addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25643enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25644in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25645present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25646message's sender, respectively.
25647
25648
25649The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25650&<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25651which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25652has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25653list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25654which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25655example,
25656.code
25657lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25658.endd
25659provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25660whereas
25661.code
25662alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25663.endd
25664applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25665In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25666part.
25667
25668.cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25669&*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25670must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25671expressions work in address lists.
25672.display
25673&`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25674&`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25675.endd
25676
25677
25678.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25679When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25680example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25681against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25682router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25683regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25684A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25685&"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25686&%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25687
25688Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25689failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25690configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25691&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25692local transports).
25693
25694.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25695However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25696suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25697whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25698rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25699failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25700recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25701reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25702&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25703lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25704commands.
25705
25706
25707
25708.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25709 "SECID160"
25710For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25711example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25712twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25713&"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25714the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25715suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25716.code
25717a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25718 MX 6 p.q.r.example
25719 MX 7 m.n.o.example
25720.endd
25721and the retry rules are
25722.code
25723p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25724a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25725.endd
25726and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25727first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25728rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25729to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25730tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25731first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25732
25733In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25734first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25735&'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25736routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25737
25738&*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25739However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25740host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25741.code
25742route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25743.endd
25744then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25745textual form of the IP address.
25746
25747.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25748.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25749The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25750asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25751
25752.vlist
25753.vitem &%auth_failed%&
25754Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25755&%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25756
25757.vitem &%data_4xx%&
25758A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25759after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25760
25761.vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25762A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25763
25764.vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25765A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25766.endlist
25767
25768For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25769as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25770recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25771and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25772retry rule of this form:
25773.code
25774the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25775.endd
25776These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25777LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25778
25779.vlist
25780.vitem &%lost_connection%&
25781A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25782legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25783for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25784
25785.vitem &%lookup%&
25786A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25787Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25788its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25789Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25790its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25791
25792.vitem &%refused_MX%&
25793A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25794
25795.vitem &%refused_A%&
25796A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25797
25798.vitem &%refused%&
25799A connection was refused.
25800
25801.vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25802A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25803
25804.vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25805A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25806
25807.vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25808A connection attempt timed out.
25809
25810.vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25811There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25812obtained from an MX record.
25813
25814.vitem &%timeout_A%&
25815There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25816obtained from an MX record.
25817
25818.vitem &%timeout%&
25819There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25820
25821.vitem &%tls_required%&
25822The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25823&(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25824to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25825
25826.vitem &%quota%&
25827A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25828transport.
25829
25830.vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25831.cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25832.cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25833A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25834transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25835&'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25836for four days.
25837.endlist
25838
25839.cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25840The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25841timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25842it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25843However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25844heuristic rules:
25845
25846.ilist
25847If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25848used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25849quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25850.next
25851.cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25852For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25853subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25854the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25855change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25856MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25857time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25858.next
25859For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25860obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25861.endlist
25862
25863The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25864mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25865when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25866error).
25867
25868
25869
25870.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25871.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25872You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25873specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25874apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25875form:
25876.display
25877&`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25878.endd
25879The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25880.code
25881* rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25882.endd
25883matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25884host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25885For example:
25886.code
25887a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25888.endd
25889&*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25890(which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25891only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25892its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25893all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25894
25895When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25896&%-f%& command line option, like this:
25897.code
25898exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25899.endd
25900If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25901list is never matched.
25902
25903
25904
25905
25906
25907.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25908.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25909The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25910sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25911.display
25912<&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25913.endd
25914The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25915time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25916arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25917time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25918relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25919
25920.cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25921.cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25922.cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25923.cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25924The available algorithms are:
25925
25926.ilist
25927&'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25928the interval.
25929.next
25930&'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25931specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25932is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25933.next
25934&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25935retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25936maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25937the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25938rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25939members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25940queue processing times.
25941.endlist
25942
25943When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25944order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25945used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25946case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25947current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25948computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25949interval is found. The main configuration variable
25950.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25951.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25952.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25953&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25954cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25955
25956A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25957host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25958basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25959for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25960generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25961time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25962time.
25963
25964.cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25965Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25966run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25967starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25968new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25969If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25970occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25971messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25972processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25973your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25974number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25975sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25976
25977The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25978&'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25979&<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25980&'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25981are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25982deliveries that have been deferred.
25983
25984
25985.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25986Here are some example retry rules:
25987.code
25988alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25989wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25990wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
25991lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25992* refused_A F,2h,20m;
25993* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
25994.endd
25995The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
25996&'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
25997mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
25998hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
25999parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26000effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26001fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26002days.
26003
26004The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26005happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26006intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26007first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26008so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26009
26010The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26011They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26012all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26013were not obtained from an MX record.
26014
26015The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26016first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26017not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26018hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
260191.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26020
26021
26022
26023.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26024.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26025.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26026.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26027.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26028Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26029consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26030set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26031been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26032arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26033failing for the first time.
26034
26035This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26036backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26037Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26038down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26039
26040If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26041every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26042message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26043
26044
26045
26046
26047.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26048.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26049.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26050Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26051that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26052default retry rule:
26053.code
26054* * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26055.endd
26056the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26057long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26058failure for the recipient address that counts.
26059
26060When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26061addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26062causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26063In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26064time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26065
26066For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26067messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26068post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26069
26070.cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26071.cindex retry "final cutoff"
26072If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26073.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26074&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26075default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26076as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26077reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26078attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26079those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26080the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26081
26082In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26083for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26084times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26085behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26086to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26087notice.
26088
26089If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26090addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26091addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26092no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26093words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26094addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26095If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26096&%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26097deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26098true.
26099
26100.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26101.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26102Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26103intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26104its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26105because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26106host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26107failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26108reached.
26109
26110Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26111applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26112Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26113examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26114commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26115time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26116is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26117time out the address.
26118
26119The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26120the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26121given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26122time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26123not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26124considered immediately.
26125.ecindex IIDretconf1
26126.ecindex IIDregconf2
26127
26128
26129
26130
26131
26132
26133. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26134. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26135
26136.chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26137.scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26138.scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26139The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26140with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26141described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26142to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26143permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26144transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26145other.
26146
26147.cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26148Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26149
26150.ilist
26151The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26152the client's EHLO command.
26153.next
26154The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26155may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26156.next
26157The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26158appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26159just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26160any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26161with the AUTH command.
26162.next
26163The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26164.next
26165If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26166option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26167mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26168connection.
26169.next
26170If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26171authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26172unauthenticated connection.
26173.endlist
26174
26175If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26176mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26177SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26178includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26179.display
26180&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26181&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26182&`Connected to server.example.`&
26183&`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
26184&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26185&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26186&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26187&`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26188&`250-PIPELINING`&
26189&`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
26190&`250 HELP`&
26191.endd
26192The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26193authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26194mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26195routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26196controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26197included by setting
26198.code
26199AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
26200AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26201AUTH_DOVECOT=yes
26202AUTH_EXTERNAL=yes
26203AUTH_GSASL=yes
26204AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26205AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
26206AUTH_SPA=yes
26207AUTH_TLS=yes
26208.endd
26209in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26210authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26211the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26212The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26213work via a socket interface.
26214.new
26215The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26216as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26217.wen
26218The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26219provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26220The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26221supporting setting a server keytab.
26222The seventh can be configured to support
26223the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26224not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26225The eighth authenticator
26226supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26227The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26228instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26229
26230The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26231section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26232authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26233authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26234is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26235messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26236options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26237
26238To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26239&%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26240either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26241functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26242to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26243both sets of options, is required. For example:
26244.code
26245cram:
26246 driver = cram_md5
26247 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26248 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26249 client_name = ph10
26250 client_secret = secret2
26251.endd
26252The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26253&%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26254
26255Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26256The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26257authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26258in Exim.
26259
26260&*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26261per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26262account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26263authenticating data.
26264
26265Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26266&'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26267and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26268Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26269used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26270second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26271user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26272configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26273&'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26274as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26275choose to honour.
26276
26277A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26278to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26279mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26280typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26281
26282
26283
26284.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26285.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26286.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26287
26288.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26289When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26290&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26291used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26292encrypted by a setting such as:
26293.code
26294client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26295.endd
26296
26297
26298.option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26299When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26300result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26301Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26302
26303
26304.option driver authenticators string unset
26305This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26306authenticators is to be used.
26307
26308
26309.option public_name authenticators string unset
26310This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26311implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26312contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26313but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26314defaults to the driver's instance name.
26315
26316
26317.option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26318When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26319is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26320mechanism is not advertised.
26321If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26322forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26323See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26324
26325
26326.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26327This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26328is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26329for details.
26330
26331For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26332mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26333
26334For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26335authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26336authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26337authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26338to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26339error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26340string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26341expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26342other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26343the error text.
26344
26345
26346.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26347If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26348command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26349output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26350out the values of variables.
26351If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26352output, and Exim carries on processing.
26353
26354
26355.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26356.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26357.vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26358When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26359expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26360messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26361lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26362configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26363refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26364On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26365the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26366If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26367
26368
26369.option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26370This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26371as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26372driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26373as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26374remembered for later use.
26375How it is used is described in the following section.
26376
26377
26378
26379
26380
26381.section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26382.cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26383.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26384When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26385the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26386message:
26387
26388.ilist
26389If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26390than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26391.next
26392If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26393.next
26394.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26395If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26396running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26397from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26398&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26399return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26400given for the MAIL command.
26401.next
26402If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26403is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26404authenticated.
26405.next
26406If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26407the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26408&%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26409valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26410fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26411&$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26412the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26413message.
26414.endlist
26415
26416
26417When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26418hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26419&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26420process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26421
26422.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26423Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26424MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26425therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26426value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26427ACL is run.
26428
26429
26430
26431.section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26432.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26433When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26434authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26435conditions:
26436
26437.ilist
26438The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26439.next
26440It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26441yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26442.endlist
26443
26444The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26445the mechanisms are advertised.
26446
26447Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26448provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26449even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26450set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26451You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26452For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26453that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26454.code
26455auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26456.endd
26457so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26458
26459The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26460authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26461advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26462such as:
26463.code
26464server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26465.endd
26466.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26467If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26468yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26469
26470When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26471immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26472command. This is the case if
26473
26474.ilist
26475The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26476.next
26477No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26478.next
26479Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26480server authenticators.
26481.endlist
26482
26483
26484Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26485to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26486AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26487
26488If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26489server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26490that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26491the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26492fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26493rejected with a 504 error.
26494
26495.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26496.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26497When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26498&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26499or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26500public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26501client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26502no successful authentication.
26503
26504.cindex authentication "expansion item"
26505Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26506&$authresults$& expansion item.
26507
26508
26509
26510
26511.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26512.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26513.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26514.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26515Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26516configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26517encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26518script:
26519.code
26520use MIME::Base64;
26521printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26522.endd
26523.cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26524This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26525interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26526some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26527command line to run this script on such data might be
26528.code
26529encode '\0user\0password'
26530.endd
26531Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26532backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26533whose code value is zero.
26534
26535&*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26536digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26537you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26538interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26539
26540&*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26541specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26542example, a command such as
26543.code
26544encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26545.endd
26546gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26547
26548If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26549base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26550.code
26551echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26552.endd
26553The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26554in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26555output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26556should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26557
26558
26559
26560.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26561.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26562The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26563&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26564announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26565of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26566
26567.ilist
26568For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26569they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26570mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26571of the authenticator.
26572.next
26573.vindex "&$host$&"
26574.vindex "&$host_address$&"
26575When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26576variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26577that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26578any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26579Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26580delivery to be deferred.
26581.next
26582If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26583Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26584try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26585usual way.
26586.next
26587If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26588carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26589possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26590no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26591what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26592&%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26593delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26594turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26595deliver the message unauthenticated.
26596.endlist
26597
26598Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26599confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26600upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26601router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26602the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26603running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26604check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26605No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26606
26607For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26608
26609.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26610When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26611parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26612the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26613is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26614incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26615allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26616to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26617&%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26618&%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26619the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26620.ecindex IIDauthconf1
26621.ecindex IIDauthconf2
26622
26623
26624
26625
26626
26627
26628. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26629. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26630
26631.chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26632.scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26633.scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26634The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26635LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26636plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26637security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26638(see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26639use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26640connections as you do for login accounts.
26641
26642.section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26643.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26644When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26645
26646.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26647This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26648configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26649
26650.option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26651The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26652prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26653given.
26654
26655.section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26656.cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26657.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26658.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26659 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26660.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26661.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26662
26663When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26664expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26665response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26666values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26667a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26668are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26669(neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26670
26671For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26672the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26673variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26674string expansions that also use them for other things.
26675
26676If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26677supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26678data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26679
26680.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26681Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26682&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26683authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26684to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26685&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26686expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26687generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26688For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26689string as the error text.
26690
26691&*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26692password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26693There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26694
26695
26696
26697.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26698.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26699.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26700.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26701The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26702sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26703separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26704subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26705
26706The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26707Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26708configured as follows:
26709.code
26710fixed_plain:
26711 driver = plaintext
26712 public_name = PLAIN
26713 server_prompts = :
26714 server_condition = \
26715 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26716 server_set_id = $auth2
26717.endd
26718Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26719are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26720password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26721or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26722
26723The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26724the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26725AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26726authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26727.code
26728250-AUTH PLAIN
26729.endd
26730and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26731.code
26732AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26733.endd
26734As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26735data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26736.code
26737AUTH PLAIN
26738.endd
26739to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26740prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26741
26742The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26743when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26744represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26745is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26746second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26747
26748Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26749realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26750authenticating clients it could make sense.
26751
26752A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26753&$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26754comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26755this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26756This is an incorrect example:
26757.code
26758server_condition = \
26759 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26760.endd
26761The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26762which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26763incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26764non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26765strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26766the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26767name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26768.code
26769server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26770 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26771.endd
26772In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26773fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26774used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26775always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26776writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26777
26778
26779.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26780.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26781.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26782The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26783in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26784user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26785plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26786.code
26787fixed_login:
26788 driver = plaintext
26789 public_name = LOGIN
26790 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26791 server_condition = \
26792 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26793 server_set_id = $auth1
26794.endd
26795Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26796with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26797if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26798strings are used to obtain two data items.
26799
26800Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26801example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26802&"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26803strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26804name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26805.code
26806login:
26807 driver = plaintext
26808 public_name = LOGIN
26809 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26810 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26811 !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
26812 ldapauth{\
26813 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26814 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26815 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26816 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26817.endd
26818We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26819does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26820operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26821&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26822correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26823the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26824uninterpreted string.
26825
26826
26827.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26828A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26829interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26830traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26831Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26832&<<SECTexpcond>>&.
26833
26834
26835
26836
26837.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26838.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26839The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26840
26841.option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26842If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26843authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26844the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26845usual.
26846
26847.option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26848The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26849string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26850string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26851to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26852most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26853with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26854way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26855(with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26856so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26857&%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26858&$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26859
26860&*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26861splitting takes priority and happens first.
26862
26863Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26864the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26865there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26866NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26867the string.
26868
26869This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26870authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26871.code
26872fixed_plain:
26873 driver = plaintext
26874 public_name = PLAIN
26875 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26876.endd
26877The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26878command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26879that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26880.code
26881fixed_login:
26882 driver = plaintext
26883 public_name = LOGIN
26884 client_send = : username : mysecret
26885.endd
26886The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26887the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26888prompts.
26889.ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26890.ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26891
26892
26893
26894
26895. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26896. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26897
26898.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26899.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26900.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26901.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26902.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26903The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26904sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26905name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26906string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26907is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26908secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26909available in plain text at either end.
26910
26911
26912.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26913.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26914This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26915authenticator as a server:
26916
26917.option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26918.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26919When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26920the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26921obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26922that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26923string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26924fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26925returned to the client.
26926
26927For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26928in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26929deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26930numeric variables for other things.
26931
26932For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26933client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26934user name, authentication fails.
26935.code
26936fixed_cram:
26937 driver = cram_md5
26938 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26939 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26940 server_set_id = $auth1
26941.endd
26942.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26943If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26944name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26945secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26946.code
26947lookup_cram:
26948 driver = cram_md5
26949 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26950 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26951 {$value}fail}
26952 server_set_id = $auth1
26953.endd
26954Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26955because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26956
26957As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26958using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26959lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26960realm, with:
26961.code
26962cyrusless_crammd5:
26963 driver = cram_md5
26964 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26965 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26966 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26967 server_set_id = $auth1
26968.endd
26969
26970.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26971.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26972When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26973
26974
26975
26976.option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26977This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26978computing the response to the server's challenge.
26979
26980
26981.option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26982This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26983expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26984
26985
26986.vindex "&$host$&"
26987.vindex "&$host_address$&"
26988Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26989to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26990expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
26991prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
26992authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
26993send the message to the current server.
26994
26995A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
26996strings, is:
26997.code
26998fixed_cram:
26999 driver = cram_md5
27000 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27001 client_name = ph10
27002 client_secret = secret
27003.endd
27004.ecindex IIDcramauth1
27005.ecindex IIDcramauth2
27006
27007
27008
27009. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27010. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27011
27012.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27013.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27014.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27015.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27016.cindex "Kerberos"
27017The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27018at A L Digital Ltd.
27019
27020The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27021library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27022Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27023including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27024directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27025
27026The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27027the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27028then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27029name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27030
27031Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27032or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27033user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27034by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27035depending on the driver you are using.
27036
27037The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27038be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27039Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27040changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27041layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27042implementation.
27043
27044For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27045may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27046variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27047Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27048With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27049environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27050is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27051the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27052
27053
27054.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27055The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27056(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27057previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27058use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27059confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27060things.
27061
27062
27063.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27064This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27065library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27066SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27067
27068
27069.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27070This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27071default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27072you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27073example:
27074.code
27075sasl:
27076 driver = cyrus_sasl
27077 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27078 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27079 server_set_id = $auth1
27080.endd
27081
27082.option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27083This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27084
27085
27086.option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27087This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27088
27089
27090For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27091private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27092the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27093PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27094.code
27095sasl_cram_md5:
27096 driver = cyrus_sasl
27097 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27098 server_set_id = $auth1
27099
27100sasl_plain:
27101 driver = cyrus_sasl
27102 public_name = PLAIN
27103 server_set_id = $auth2
27104.endd
27105Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27106not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27107but it is present in many binary distributions.
27108.ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27109.ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27110
27111
27112
27113
27114. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27115. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27116.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27117.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27118.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27119This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27120Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27121Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27122If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27123to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27124authenticator only. There is only one option:
27125
27126.option server_socket dovecot string unset
27127
27128This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27129authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27130mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27131authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27132.code
27133dovecot_plain:
27134 driver = dovecot
27135 public_name = PLAIN
27136 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27137 server_set_id = $auth1
27138
27139dovecot_ntlm:
27140 driver = dovecot
27141 public_name = NTLM
27142 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27143 server_set_id = $auth1
27144.endd
27145If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27146&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27147option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27148connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27149option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27150who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27151.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27152.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27153
27154
27155. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27156. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27157.chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27158.scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27159.scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27160.cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27161.cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27162.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27163.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27164.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27165.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27166.cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27167.cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27168.cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
27169The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
27170library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27171and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27172scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27173made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27174without code changes in Exim.
27175
27176Exim's &(gsasl)& authenticator does not have client-side support at this
27177time; only the server-side support is implemented. Patches welcome.
27178
27179
27180.option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27181Do not set this true without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27182
27183Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27184of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27185authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27186ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27187context.
27188
27189This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27190non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27191server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27192
27193This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
27194only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27195writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27196
27197This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27198this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27199of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27200
27201However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be broken in current versions.
27202Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27203with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27204
27205
27206.option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27207This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27208library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27209Some mechanisms will use this data.
27210
27211
27212.option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27213This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27214default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27215you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27216example:
27217.code
27218sasl:
27219 driver = gsasl
27220 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27221 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27222 server_set_id = $auth1
27223.endd
27224
27225
27226.option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27227Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27228that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27229the password itself.
27230
27231The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27232In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27233The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27234if available, else the empty string.
27235The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27236else the empty string.
27237
27238A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27239
27240If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27241option to be simply "true".
27242
27243
27244.option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27245This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27246Some mechanisms will use this data.
27247
27248
27249.option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
27250This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27251&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27252(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27253
27254
27255.option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27256This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27257&$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27258(This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27259
27260
27261.option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27262This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27263Some mechanisms will use this data.
27264
27265
27266.section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27267.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27268These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27269They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27270
27271Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27272meanings for these variables:
27273
27274.ilist
27275.vindex "&$auth1$&"
27276&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27277.next
27278.vindex "&$auth2$&"
27279&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27280.next
27281.vindex "&$auth3$&"
27282&$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27283.endlist
27284
27285On a per-mechanism basis:
27286
27287.ilist
27288.cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27289EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27290the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27291.next
27292.cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27293ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27294the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27295.next
27296.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27297GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27298&$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27299the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27300.endlist
27301
27302An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27303identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27304email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27305
27306
27307An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27308and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27309.code
27310gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27311 driver = gsasl
27312 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27313 server_realm = imap.example.org
27314 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27315 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27316 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27317 server_condition = yes
27318.endd
27319
27320
27321. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27322. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27323
27324.chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27325.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27326.scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27327.cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27328.cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27329The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27330Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27331reliably.
27332
27333.option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27334This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27335for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27336identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27337
27338.option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27339If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27340&_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27341The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27342
27343.option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27344This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27345&%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27346from the keytab.
27347
27348
27349.section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27350Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27351to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27352not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27353
27354The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27355Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27356Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27357role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27358
27359.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27360.ilist
27361.vindex "&$auth1$&"
27362&$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27363.next
27364.vindex "&$auth2$&"
27365&$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27366authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27367GSS Display Name.
27368.endlist
27369
27370
27371. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27372. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27373
27374.chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27375.scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27376.scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27377.cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27378.cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27379.cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27380.cindex "NTLM authentication"
27381The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27382Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27383which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27384this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27385taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27386server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27387follows:
27388
27389.ilist
27390After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27391authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27392.next
27393The server sends back a challenge.
27394.next
27395The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27396and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27397.endlist
27398
27399Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27400
27401
27402
27403.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27404.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27405The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27406
27407.option server_password spa string&!! unset
27408.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27409This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27410authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27411compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27412&$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27413it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27414for other things. For example:
27415.code
27416spa:
27417 driver = spa
27418 public_name = NTLM
27419 server_password = \
27420 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27421.endd
27422If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27423failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27424
27425
27426
27427
27428
27429.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27430.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27431The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27432
27433
27434
27435.option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27436This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27437
27438
27439.option client_password spa string&!! unset
27440This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27441
27442
27443.option client_username spa string&!! unset
27444This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27445configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27446&'msn.com'&:
27447.code
27448msn:
27449 driver = spa
27450 public_name = MSN
27451 client_username = msn/msn_username
27452 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27453 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27454.endd
27455.ecindex IIDspaauth1
27456.ecindex IIDspaauth2
27457
27458
27459
27460
27461
27462. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27463. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27464
27465.chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
27466.scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
27467.scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
27468.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27469.cindex "authentication" "X509"
27470.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27471The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
27472authentication based on non-SMTP information.
27473The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
27474(&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
27475It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
27476the process of authentication is entirely controlled
27477by the server configuration.
27478
27479The client presents an identity in-clear.
27480It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
27481and for clients to only attempt,
27482this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
27483
27484One possible use, compatible with the
27485K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
27486is for using X509 client certificates.
27487
27488It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
27489(see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
27490but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
27491rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
27492client certificates only.
27493
27494The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
27495client-certificate authentication is being done.
27496
27497The client must present a certificate,
27498for which it must have been requested via the
27499&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27500(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27501For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
27502verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
27503
27504.section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
27505.cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
27506The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
27507
27508.option server_param2 external string&!! unset
27509.option server_param3 external string&!! unset
27510.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27511These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
27512and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
27513If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27514failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27515
27516They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
27517
27518.section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
27519.cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27520.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27521 "in &(external)& authenticator"
27522.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27523.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27524
27525When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
27526expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27527response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27528values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
27529an identity for authentication and
27530placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
27531
27532For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
27533the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
27534variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27535string expansions that also use them for other things.
27536
27537.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27538Once an identity has been received,
27539&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27540authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27541to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27542&"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27543expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27544generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27545For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27546string as the error text.
27547
27548Example:
27549.code
27550ext_ccert_san_mail:
27551 driver = external
27552 public_name = EXTERNAL
27553
27554 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
27555 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27556 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27557 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
27558 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
27559 server_set_id = $auth1
27560.endd
27561This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27562of your configured trust-anchors
27563(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27564and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
27565
27566Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27567The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27568TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27569in this way.
27570Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27571
27572
27573.section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
27574.cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
27575The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
27576
27577.option client_send external string&!! unset
27578This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
27579identity being asserted.
27580
27581Example:
27582.code
27583ext_ccert:
27584 driver = external
27585 public_name = EXTERNAL
27586
27587 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27588 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
27589.endd
27590
27591
27592.ecindex IIDexternauth1
27593.ecindex IIDexternauth2
27594
27595
27596
27597
27598
27599. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27600. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27601
27602.chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27603.scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27604.scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27605.cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27606.cindex "authentication" "X509"
27607.cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27608The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27609authentication based on client certificates.
27610
27611It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27612advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27613It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27614the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27615by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27616the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27617
27618The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27619for which it must have been requested via the
27620&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27621(see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27622
27623If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27624run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27625and can authenticate the connection.
27626If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27627
27628A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27629
27630
27631.cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27632The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27633
27634.option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27635.cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27636This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27637the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27638If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27639failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27640
27641.option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27642.option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27643As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27644
27645&%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27646
27647
27648Example:
27649.code
27650tls:
27651 driver = tls
27652 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27653 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27654 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
27655 {forany {$auth1} \
27656 {!= {0} \
27657 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27658 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27659 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27660 } } } }}}
27661 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27662.endd
27663This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27664of your configured trust-anchors
27665(which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27666and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27667
27668Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27669The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27670TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27671in this way.
27672Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27673
27674. An alternative might use
27675. .code
27676. server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27677. .endd
27678. to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27679. (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27680. This would help for per-device use.
27681.
27682. However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27683. user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27684
27685.ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27686.ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27687
27688
27689Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27690the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27691a connect- or helo-ACL.
27692
27693
27694
27695. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27696. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27697
27698.chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27699 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27700.scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27701.scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27702.cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27703.cindex "OpenSSL"
27704.cindex "GnuTLS"
27705Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27706Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27707GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27708cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27709order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27710version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27711You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27712level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27713certificates are used.
27714
27715RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27716connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27717server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27718mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27719between them is encrypted.
27720
27721Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27722and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27723certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27724possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27725encryption state.
27726
27727&*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27728disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27729in order to get TLS to work.
27730
27731
27732
27733.section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27734 "SECID284"
27735.cindex "submissions protocol"
27736.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27737.cindex "smtps protocol"
27738.cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27739.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27740.cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27741The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27742contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27743allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27744instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27745by them in preference to STARTTLS.
27746
27747The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27748clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27749Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27750
27751This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27752standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27753reassigned for other use.
27754Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27755this port.
27756In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
27757not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27758Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27759
27760Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27761global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27762the most common use is expected to be:
27763.code
27764tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27765.endd
27766The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27767via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27768the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27769the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27770an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27771defined elsewhere.
27772
27773There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27774&%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27775
27776
27777
27778
27779
27780
27781.section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27782.cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27783The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27784followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27785to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27786.code
27787USE_GNUTLS=yes
27788.endd
27789in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27790.code
27791SUPPORT_TLS=yes
27792.endd
27793You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27794include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27795
27796There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27797
27798.ilist
27799The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27800cannot be the path of a directory
27801for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27802(for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27803.next
27804The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27805.next
27806.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27807.vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27808Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27809separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27810affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27811.next
27812OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27813DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27814RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27815in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27816for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27817to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27818&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27819option).
27820.next
27821The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27822sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27823.next
27824The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27825When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27826(If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27827let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27828.next
27829With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27830main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27831.next
27832Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27833This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27834explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27835implementation, then patches are welcome.
27836.endlist
27837
27838
27839.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27840This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27841an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27842but not the chosen filename.
27843By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27844See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27845
27846GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27847to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27848Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27849&_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27850of bits requested.
27851The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27852its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27853parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27854that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27855renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27856this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27857place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27858
27859For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27860recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27861If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27862are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27863not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27864
27865Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27866values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27867parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27868If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27869until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27870a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27871
27872The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27873in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27874generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27875
27876To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27877and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27878&(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27879renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27880.code
27881# ls
27882[ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27883# rm -f new-params
27884# touch new-params
27885# chown exim:exim new-params
27886# chmod 0600 new-params
27887# certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27888# openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27889[ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27890 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27891 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27892# chmod 0400 new-params
27893# mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27894.endd
27895If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27896stalling is removed.
27897
27898The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27899Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27900the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27901a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27902and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27903failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27904of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27905which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27906GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27907to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27908limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27909
27910The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27911value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27912&%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
279132432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27914
27915In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27916increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27917bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27918procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27919the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27920
27921
27922.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27923.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27924.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27925There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27926suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27927are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
27928The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27929DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27930directly to this function call.
27931Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27932&'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27933The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27934documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27935
27936.ilist
27937It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27938.next
27939It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27940or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27941ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27942SSL v3 algorithms.
27943.next
27944Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27945the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27946SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27947algorithms.
27948.endlist
27949
27950Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27951&`-`& or &`+`&.
27952.ilist
27953If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27954ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27955stated.
27956.next
27957If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27958of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27959.next
27960If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27961option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27962.endlist
27963
27964If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27965a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27966includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27967not be moved to the end of the list.
27968.endlist
27969
27970The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27971string:
27972.code
27973# note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27974$ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27975.endd
27976
27977This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27978there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27979submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27980choice of clients used:
27981.code
27982# OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27983tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27984 {DEFAULT}\
27985 {HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1}}
27986.endd
27987
27988This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
27989.code
27990tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
27991.endd
27992
27993For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
27994and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
27995The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
27996TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
27997
27998As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
27999.code
28000TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28001.endd
28002
28003
28004.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28005 "SECTreqciphgnu"
28006.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28007.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28008.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28009.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28010.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28011.cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28012.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28013The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28014as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28015ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28016
28017The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28018and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28019
28020The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28021controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28022&(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28023the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28024the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28025aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28026
28027Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28028"Priority strings". This is online as
28029&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28030but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28031installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28032then the example code
28033&url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28034on that site can be used to test a given string.
28035
28036For example:
28037.code
28038# Disable older versions of protocols
28039tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28040.endd
28041
28042Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28043additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28044"&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28045
28046This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28047there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28048by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28049where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28050used:
28051.code
28052# GnuTLS variant
28053tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28054 {NORMAL:%COMPAT}\
28055 {SECURE128}}
28056.endd
28057
28058
28059.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28060.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28061When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28062the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28063but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28064that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28065this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28066
28067If STARTTLS is to be used you
28068need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28069
28070If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28071problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28072persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28073with the error
28074.code
28075554 Security failure
28076.endd
28077If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28078rejected with a 554 error code.
28079
28080To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28081must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28082
28083If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28084meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28085You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28086from someone able to intercept the communication.
28087
28088Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28089
28090To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28091.code
28092tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28093tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28094.endd
28095These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28096the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28097contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28098that goes with it. These files need to be
28099PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28100always be given as full path names.
28101The key must not be password-protected.
28102They can be the same file if both the
28103certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28104set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28105is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28106certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28107the server's certificate.
28108
28109For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28110colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28111algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28112public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28113client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28114ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28115
28116If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28117source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28118few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28119
28120&*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28121they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28122Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28123transport.
28124
28125With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28126require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28127this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28128.code
28129tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28130.endd
28131is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28132with the parameters contained in the file.
28133Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28134available:
28135.code
28136tls_dhparam = none
28137.endd
28138This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28139DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28140used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28141documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28142
28143See the command
28144.code
28145openssl dhparam
28146.endd
28147for a way of generating file data.
28148
28149The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28150host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28151for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28152in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28153forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28154
28155.cindex "cipher" "logging"
28156.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28157.vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28158The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28159an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28160incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28161also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28162&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28163condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28164
28165Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28166can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28167cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28168example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28169contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28170documentation for more details.
28171
28172For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28173(again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28174
28175
28176.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28177.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28178.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28179If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28180session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28181&%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28182apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28183Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28184contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28185expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28186These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28187an explicit file or,
28188depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28189&%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28190
28191A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28192directory is used
28193(OpenSSL only),
28194each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28195of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28196certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28197.code
28198openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28199.endd
28200where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28201
28202There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28203Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28204
28205The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28206what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28207does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28208&%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28209attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28210dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28211session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28212fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28213example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28214relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28215
28216.vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28217When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28218the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28219&$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28220
28221.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28222Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28223&'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28224&"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28225&%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28226certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28227
28228
28229.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28230.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28231.cindex "revocation list"
28232.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28233.cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28234Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28235certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28236server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28237an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28238of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28239CRL in PEM format.
28240The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28241file from every certificate authority they know of.
28242
28243The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28244Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28245against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28246usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28247private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28248is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28249
28250The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28251comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28252connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28253re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28254
28255The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28256issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28257the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28258negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28259CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28260resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28261starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28262proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28263
28264Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28265or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28266support for OCSP stapling is included.
28267
28268There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28269The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28270an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28271option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28272contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28273
28274Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28275proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28276Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28277contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28278on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28279next connection.
28280
28281When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28282in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28283ignored.
28284
28285For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28286also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28287certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28288of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28289intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28290file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28291
28292Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28293not any of the chain from CA to it.
28294
28295There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28296
28297.code
28298 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28299 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28300 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28301
28302 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28303 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28304 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28305.endd
28306
28307
28308
28309
28310.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
28311.cindex "cipher" "logging"
28312.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28313.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28314.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28315The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28316deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28317server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28318within the &(smtp)& transport.
28319
28320It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28321transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28322server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28323this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
28324transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
28325
28326If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
28327to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
28328&%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
28329those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
28330set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28331usual way.
28332
28333When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28334the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28335a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28336session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28337&%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28338delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28339it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28340STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28341negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28342unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28343unencrypted.
28344
28345The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28346transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28347if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28348&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28349
28350If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28351specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28352These may be
28353the system default set (depending on library version),
28354a file,
28355or (depending on library version) a directory.
28356The client verifies the server's certificate
28357against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28358in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28359Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28360&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28361
28362The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28363certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28364or need not succeed respectively.
28365
28366The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28367checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28368is valid for the certificate.
28369The option defaults to always checking.
28370
28371The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28372&%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28373is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28374value is empty.
28375&%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28376a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28377value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28378otherwise.
28379
28380The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28381&%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28382for OCSP to be relevant.
28383
28384If
28385&%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28386list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28387the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28388alternative hosts, if any.
28389
28390 &*Note*&:
28391These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28392is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28393by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28394client.
28395
28396.vindex "&$host$&"
28397.vindex "&$host_address$&"
28398All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28399&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28400which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28401behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28402
28403.vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28404.vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28405.vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28406.vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28407Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28408&$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28409variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28410that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28411successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28412outgoing connection.
28413
28414
28415
28416.section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28417.cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28418.vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28419.oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28420With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28421information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28422extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28423&"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28424client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28425within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28426for this session.
28427
28428This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28429which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28430address.
28431
28432With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28433against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28434provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28435be of limited use in that environment.
28436
28437With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28438connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28439choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28440wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28441different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28442
28443The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28444if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28445nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28446only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28447for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28448
28449Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28450received from a client.
28451It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28452
28453If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28454option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28455during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28456
28457.ilist
28458&%tls_certificate%&
28459.next
28460&%tls_crl%&
28461.next
28462&%tls_privatekey%&
28463.next
28464&%tls_verify_certificates%&
28465.next
28466&%tls_ocsp_file%&
28467.endlist
28468
28469Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
28470attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
28471can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
28472arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
28473Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
28474an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
28475when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
28476
28477The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
28478are re-expanded.
28479
28480When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
28481for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
28482enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
28483see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
28484
28485When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
284860.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
28487built, then you have SNI support).
28488
28489
28490
28491.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
28492 "SECTmulmessam"
28493.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
28494.cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
28495Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
28496an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
28497one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
28498of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
28499connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28500to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28501starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28502unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28503
28504An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28505&%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28506this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28507shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28508before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28509try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28510if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28511
28512The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28513after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28514just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28515reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28516successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28517SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28518should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28519subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28520and delay other deliveries to that host.
28521
28522To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28523closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28524closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28525information is recorded.
28526
28527There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28528&(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28529connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28530
28531
28532
28533
28534.section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28535.cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28536In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28537certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
28538This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
28539reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
28540
28541The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
28542documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
28543document is currently at
28544.display
28545&url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
28546.endd
28547and their FAQ is at
28548.display
28549&url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
28550.endd
28551
28552Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
285530-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
28554descriptions.
28555More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
28556published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
28557Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
28558&url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
28559
28560
28561.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28562The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28563certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28564sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28565not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28566First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28567certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28568intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28569certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28570The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28571validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28572root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28573install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28574
28575Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28576even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28577server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28578diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28579
28580
28581
28582.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28583.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28584You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28585with OpenSSL, like this:
28586. ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28587. ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28588.code
28589openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28590 -days 9999 -nodes
28591.endd
28592&_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28593delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28594specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28595important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28596that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28597prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28598this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28599
28600. ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28601. ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28602. ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28603. ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28604. ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28605. ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28606. ==== -pdp, 2012
28607NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28608epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28609the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28610the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28611of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28612writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28613progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28614be a sensible resolution).
28615
28616A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28617may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28618encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28619
28620However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28621user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28622certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28623must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28624authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28625signed with that self-signed certificate.
28626
28627For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28628user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28629Open-source PKI book, available online at
28630&url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
28631.ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28632.ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28633
28634
28635
28636.section DANE "SECDANE"
28637.cindex DANE
28638DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28639it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28640operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28641you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28642Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28643certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28644
28645What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28646that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28647by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28648
28649It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28650fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28651
28652DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28653for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28654client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28655
28656DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28657that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28658to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28659DNSSEC.
286602) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
286613) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
28662
28663There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28664Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28665in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28666If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28667
28668The TLSA record for the server may have "certificate usage" of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
28669These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
28670The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
28671(and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
28672this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28673DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28674well-known one.
28675A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
28676attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
28677does require careful arrangement.
28678With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
28679the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
28680DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28681all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28682DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
28683
28684Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
28685because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
28686your certificate.
28687You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
28688"MTA-STS", described below.
28689
28690When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
28691outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
28692connections to you.
28693If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
28694technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
28695In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
28696operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
28697Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
28698because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
28699
28700When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
28701and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
28702than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
28703random serial numbers.
28704The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
28705If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
28706requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
28707CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
28708
28709The TLSA record should have a Selector field of SPKI(1) and a Matching Type field of SHA2-512(2).
28710
28711At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28712is useful for quickly generating TLSA records; and commands like
28713
28714.code
28715 openssl x509 -in -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28716 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28717 | openssl sha512 \
28718 | awk '{print $2}'
28719.endd
28720
28721are workable for 4th-field hashes.
28722
28723For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28724
28725The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
28726issued using a strong hash algorithm.
28727Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
28728re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
28729libraries.
28730This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
28731interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
28732
28733The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28734be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28735default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28736
28737.code
28738 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28739 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28740 {*}{}}
28741.endd
28742
28743The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28744The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28745found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28746string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28747control the OCSP request.
28748
28749This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28750those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28751
28752
28753For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
28754and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
28755The require variant will result in failure if the target host is not DNSSEC-secured.
28756
28757DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
28758
28759A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
28760If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
28761will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
28762be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
28763
28764If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
28765prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
28766back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
28767This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
28768crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
28769which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
28770limited to ciphersuite constraints.
28771
28772If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
28773.code
28774 hosts_require_tls
28775 tls_verify_hosts
28776 tls_try_verify_hosts
28777 tls_verify_certificates
28778 tls_crl
28779 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
28780.endd
28781
28782If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
28783verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
28784
28785Currently the &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
28786
28787If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
28788
28789There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
28790verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
28791in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
28792and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
28793
28794.cindex DANE reporting
28795An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
28796to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
28797required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
28798&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
28799The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
28800Section 4.3 of that document.
28801
28802Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
28803
28804DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
28805selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
28806to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
28807instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
28808time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
28809Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
28810can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
28811MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
28812information.
28813
28814The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
28815which is recognized by clients sending to you.
28816That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
28817
28818The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
28819&url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
28820renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
28821records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
28822information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
28823domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
28824incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
28825
28826
28827
28828. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28829. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28830
28831.chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
28832.scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
28833.cindex "control of incoming mail"
28834.cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
28835.cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
28836Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
28837configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
28838name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
28839one very small ACL:
28840.code
28841begin acl
28842small_acl:
28843 accept hosts = one.host.only
28844.endd
28845You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
28846which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
28847
28848The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
28849certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
28850when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
28851option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
28852in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
28853local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
28854a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
28855&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28856
28857
28858.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
28859The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
28860configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28861
28862
28863.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
28864.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
28865In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
28866options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
28867.cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
28868.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28869.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
28870.cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
28871.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28872.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28873.cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
28874.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
28875.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28876.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
28877.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
28878.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
28879.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28880.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28881.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
28882.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28883
28884.table2 140pt
28885.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
28886.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
28887.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
28888.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
28889.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
28890.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
28891.irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
28892.irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
28893.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
28894.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
28895.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
28896.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
28897.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
28898.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
28899.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
28900.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
28901.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
28902.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
28903.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
28904.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
28905.endtable
28906
28907For example, if you set
28908.code
28909acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
28910.endd
28911the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
28912in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
28913done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
28914sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
28915command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
28916trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
28917testing as possible at RCPT time.
28918
28919
28920.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
28921.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28922The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
28923apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
28924really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
28925the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
28926relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
28927are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
28928&$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
28929&$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
28930in any of these ACLs.
28931
28932The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
28933non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
28934analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
28935batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
28936result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
28937really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
28938on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
28939controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
28940.code
28941control = suppress_local_fixups
28942.endd
28943This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
28944run, it is too late.
28945
28946The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28947content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28948
28949The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
28950kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
28951temporary error for these kinds of message.
28952
28953
28954.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
28955.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28956.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
28957The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
28958session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
28959an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
28960accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
28961the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
28962&%smtp_banner%& option.
28963
28964
28965.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
28966.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28967.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28968The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
28969EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
28970&%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
28971Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
28972session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
28973setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
28974
28975Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
28976mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
28977&$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
28978
28979If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
28980modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
28981at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
28982affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
28983an EHLO response.
28984
28985
28986.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
28987.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28988Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
28989command, with two responses being sent to the client.
28990When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
28991is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
28992the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
28993response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
28994added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
28995are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
28996
28997You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
28998in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
28999tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29000received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29001the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29002associated with the DATA command.
29003
29004.cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29005.cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29006.cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29007If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29008the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29009. XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29010The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29011the data specified is received.
29012
29013For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29014error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29015MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29016before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29017and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29018your resources.
29019
29020The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29021the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29022the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29023and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29024
29025.section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29026The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29027enabled (which is the default).
29028
29029The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29030received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29031otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29032
29033This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29034
29035For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29036
29037
29038.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29039The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29040content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29041
29042This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29043
29044
29045.section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29046.cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29047.oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29048The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29049with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29050It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29051client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29052has been accepted.
29053
29054The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29055has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29056with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29057The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29058The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29059can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29060for some or all recipients.
29061
29062PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29063one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29064content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29065.cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29066for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29067is &"yes"&.
29068Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29069ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29070will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29071
29072See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29073and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29074
29075This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29076If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29077the feature was not requested by the client.
29078
29079.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29080.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29081The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29082does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29083does not in fact control any access.
29084For this reason, it may only accept
29085or warn as its final result.
29086
29087This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29088session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29089messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29090more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29091
29092&*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29093the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29094
29095You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29096&%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29097response to QUIT.
29098
29099This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29100failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29101because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29102client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29103connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29104
29105
29106.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29107.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29108The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29109an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29110trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29111because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29112situation even worse.
29113
29114Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29115logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29116modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29117and &%warn%&.
29118
29119.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29120When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29121to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29122connection. The possible values are:
29123.table2
29124.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29125.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29126.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29127.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29128.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29129.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29130.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29131.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29132.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29133.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29134.endtable
29135In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29136Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29137With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29138overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29139&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29140used.
29141
29142
29143.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29144.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29145The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29146you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29147.code
29148acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29149 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29150.endd
29151In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29152providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29153an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29154expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29155more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29156
29157The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29158configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29159string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29160
29161.ilist
29162If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29163contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29164Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29165lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29166If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29167causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29168.code
29169acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29170 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29171 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29172.endd
29173This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29174back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29175file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29176can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29177.next
29178If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29179Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29180matches the string.
29181.next
29182If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29183the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29184want to have something like
29185.code
29186acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29187.endd
29188in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29189newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29190.endlist
29191
29192
29193
29194
29195.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29196.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29197Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29198section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29199&"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29200database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29201return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29202&"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29203This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29204
29205For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29206&"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29207submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29208
29209
29210ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29211has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29212individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29213blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29214
29215If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29216ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29217RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29218recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29219run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29220remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29221&%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29222
29223If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29224is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29225
29226
29227.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29228The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29229recipients; it may create new recipients.
29230
29231
29232
29233.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29234.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29235The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29236all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29237not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29238reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29239
29240For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29241these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29242used to accept or reject anything.
29243
29244For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29245&%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29246&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29247when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29248
29249For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29250&%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29251This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29252messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29253configuration file.
29254
29255
29256
29257
29258.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29259.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29260.vindex &$domain$&
29261.vindex &$local_part$&
29262.vindex &$sender_address$&
29263.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29264.vindex &$smtp_command$&
29265When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29266that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29267&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29268statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29269&$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29270is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29271
29272When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29273contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29274set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29275how it is used.
29276
29277.vindex "&$message_size$&"
29278The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29279the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29280that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29281the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29282received).
29283
29284.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29285.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29286The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29287The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29288accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29289of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29290&$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29291&$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29292
29293
29294
29295
29296
29297.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29298.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29299.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29300.vindex &$smtp_command$&
29301When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
29302the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
29303and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29304These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
29305here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
29306encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
29307does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
29308unencrypted connections.
29309.code
29310acl_check_auth:
29311 accept encrypted = *
29312 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
29313 {CRAM-MD5}}
29314 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
29315.endd
29316(Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
29317that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
29318encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
29319option to do this.)
29320
29321
29322
29323.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
29324.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
29325.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
29326An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
29327with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29328Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29329set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29330
29331If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29332used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29333provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29334example:
29335.code
29336deny dnslists = list1.example
29337 dnslists = list2.example
29338.endd
29339If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29340the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29341happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29342all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29343test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29344
29345
29346.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29347The ACL verbs are as follows:
29348
29349.ilist
29350.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29351&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29352of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29353appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29354is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29355after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29356check a RCPT command:
29357.code
29358accept domains = +local_domains
29359 endpass
29360 verify = recipient
29361.endd
29362If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29363passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29364the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29365fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29366&%endpass%&.
29367
29368The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29369use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29370that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29371configuration.
29372
29373.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29374If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29375depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29376(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29377statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29378SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29379.display
29380&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29381&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29382.endd
29383You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29384response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29385same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29386
29387If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29388an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29389for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29390of &%endpass%&.
29391
29392
29393.next
29394.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29395&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29396an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29397&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29398temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
29399&(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
29400be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
29401
29402
29403.next
29404.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
29405&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
29406the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
29407example,
29408.code
29409deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29410.endd
29411rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
29412
29413
29414.next
29415.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29416&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29417&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29418that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29419the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29420recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29421recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29422message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29423do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29424
29425If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29426its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29427The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29428
29429
29430.next
29431.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29432&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29433forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29434.code
29435drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29436 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29437.endd
29438There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
29439The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
29440
29441.next
29442.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
29443&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
29444statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
29445example, when checking a RCPT command,
29446.code
29447require message = Sender did not verify
29448 verify = sender
29449.endd
29450passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
29451verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
29452&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
29453discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
29454
29455.next
29456.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29457&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
29458&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
29459to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
29460written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
29461message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
29462duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
29463
29464If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
29465and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
29466&%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
29467first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
29468&<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29469
29470If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
29471some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
29472This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
29473is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
29474conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
29475is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
29476onwards.
29477
29478
29479.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29480When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
29481text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
29482want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
29483.code
29484warn !verify = sender
29485 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
29486.endd
29487.endlist
29488
29489At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
29490
29491As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
29492written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
29493subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
29494continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
29495mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
29496
29497
29498
29499.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
29500.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
29501There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
29502can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
29503of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
29504transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
29505variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
29506an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
29507alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
29508the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
29509.ilist
29510The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
29511throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
29512while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
29513on the same SMTP connection.
29514.next
29515The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
29516while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
29517reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
29518.endlist
29519
29520When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
29521preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
29522time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
29523.code
29524accept hosts = whatever
29525 set acl_m4 = some value
29526accept authenticated = *
29527 set acl_c_auth = yes
29528.endd
29529&*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
29530be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
29531&%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
29532
29533.oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
29534What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
29535referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
29536false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
29537error is generated.
29538
29539Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
29540their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
29541
29542
29543.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
29544.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
29545.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
29546An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
29547.code
29548deny domains = *.dom.example
29549 !verify = recipient
29550.endd
29551causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
29552&'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
29553negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
29554two statements are equivalent:
29555.code
29556deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
29557deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
29558.endd
29559However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
29560side negation of the whole condition is possible.
29561
29562The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
29563of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
29564condition is true. Consider these two statements:
29565.code
29566accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29567 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29568accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29569 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29570.endd
29571Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29572the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29573different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29574condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29575therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29576the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29577and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29578
29579ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29580specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29581others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29582warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29583message is handled.
29584
29585The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29586processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29587modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29588consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29589.code
29590require message = Can't verify sender
29591 verify = sender
29592 message = Can't verify recipient
29593 verify = recipient
29594 message = This message cannot be used
29595.endd
29596If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29597&"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29598so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29599recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29600verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29601because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29602
29603For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29604modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29605happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29606the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29607.code
29608deny hosts = ...
29609 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29610 message = Invalid sender from client host
29611.endd
29612The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29613by which time Exim has set up the message.
29614
29615
29616
29617.section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29618.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29619The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29620
29621.vlist
29622.vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29623This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29624incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29625accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29626
29627.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29628.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29629.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29630This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29631continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29632the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29633update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29634write rather ugly lines like this:
29635.display
29636&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29637.endd
29638Instead, all you need is
29639.display
29640&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29641.endd
29642
29643.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29644.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29645This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29646incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29647lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29648lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29649controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29650even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29651
29652As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29653separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29654in several different ways. For example:
29655
29656. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29657. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29658. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29659. ==== way.
29660
29661.ilist
29662It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29663.code
29664 accept ...some conditions
29665 control = queue_only
29666.endd
29667In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29668other words, when the conditions are all true.
29669
29670.next
29671It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29672.code
29673 accept ...some conditions...
29674 control = queue_only
29675 ...some more conditions...
29676.endd
29677If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29678statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29679In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29680to be relevant.
29681
29682.next
29683It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29684decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29685example:
29686.code
29687 warn ...some conditions...
29688 control = freeze
29689 accept ...
29690.endd
29691This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29692&%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29693log entry.
29694
29695.next
29696If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29697&%require%& verb. For example:
29698.code
29699 require control = no_multiline_responses
29700.endd
29701.endlist
29702
29703.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29704.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29705.oindex "&%-bh%&"
29706This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29707the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29708&%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29709output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29710happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29711output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29712
29713Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29714example:
29715.code
29716deny ...some conditions...
29717 delay = 30s
29718.endd
29719The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29720&"deny"&. Compare this with:
29721.code
29722deny delay = 30s
29723 ...some conditions...
29724.endd
29725which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29726can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29727.code
29728warn ...some conditions...
29729 delay = 2m
29730 control = freeze
29731accept ...
29732.endd
29733
29734If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29735responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29736they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29737delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29738appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29739unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29740using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29741
29742
29743.vitem &*endpass*&
29744.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29745This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29746&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29747failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29748failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29749confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29750&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29751
29752
29753.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29754.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29755This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29756ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
29757.code
29758require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
29759 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
29760.endd
29761&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
29762example:
29763.display
29764&`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
29765&` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
29766.endd
29767When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
29768that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
29769recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
29770message.
29771
29772The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
29773the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
29774denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
29775available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
29776variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
29777&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
29778ignored.
29779
29780.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29781If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
29782verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
29783error message.
29784
29785If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
29786the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
29787more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
29788actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
29789of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
29790is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
29791
29792If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
29793example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
29794the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
29795logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
29796both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
29797logging rejections.
29798
29799
29800.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
29801.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
29802.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
29803This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
29804about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
29805be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
29806may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
29807ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
29808.display
29809&`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
29810&` log_reject_target =`&
29811.endd
29812This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
29813permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
29814current ACL.
29815
29816
29817.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29818.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
29819.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
29820This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
29821processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
29822&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
29823access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
29824ACLs. For example:
29825.display
29826&`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
29827&` control = freeze`&
29828&` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
29829.endd
29830By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
29831with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
29832another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
29833example:
29834.code
29835logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
29836logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
29837.endd
29838
29839
29840.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29841.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
29842This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
29843message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
29844or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
29845there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
29846&%accept%& for details.)
29847
29848The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
29849to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
29850generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
29851&%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
29852the &%hosts%& condition fails:
29853.code
29854require message = Host not recognized
29855 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
29856.endd
29857(Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
29858processed.)
29859
29860.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
29861.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
29862For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
29863of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
29864is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
29865is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
29866overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
29867accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
29868truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
29869EHLO options.
29870
29871When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
29872consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
29873of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
29874.code
29875deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
29876 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
29877.endd
29878The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
29879by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
29880access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
298812&'xx'&.
29882
29883Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
29884the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
29885
29886The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
29887literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
29888anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
29889response.
29890
29891.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29892For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
29893stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
29894
29895If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
29896specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
29897However, the original message is available in the variable
29898&$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
29899wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
29900routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
29901use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
29902
29903For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
29904is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
29905modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
29906all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
29907&%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
29908&%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
29909effect.
29910
29911
29912.vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29913.cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
29914.cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
29915This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
29916for the message.
29917It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
29918the DATA ACL).
29919This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
29920of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
29921Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
29922If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
29923
29924
29925.vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29926This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
29927 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
29928the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
29929
29930
29931.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
29932.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
29933This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
29934&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
29935
29936
29937.vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
29938.cindex "UDP communications"
29939This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
29940collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
29941the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
29942of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
29943server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
29944separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
29945example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
29946when:
29947.code
29948udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
29949 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
29950.endd
29951.endlist
29952
29953
29954
29955
29956.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
29957.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29958The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
29959
29960.vlist
29961.vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
29962This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
29963has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
29964apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
29965HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
29966really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
29967not work without it. For example:
29968.code
29969warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
29970 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
29971.endd
29972Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
29973the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
29974matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
29975mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
29976by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
29977
29978
29979.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
29980 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
29981.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
29982.cindex "case of local parts"
29983.vindex "&$local_part$&"
29984These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
29985(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
29986are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
29987any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
29988for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
29989is encountered.
29990
29991These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
29992local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
29993in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
29994handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
29995configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
29996
29997This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
29998containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
29999spam score:
30000.code
30001warn control = caseful_local_part
30002 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30003 $acl_m4 + \
30004 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30005 }
30006 control = caselower_local_part
30007.endd
30008Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30009is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30010
30011
30012.vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30013.cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30014.cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30015This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30016
30017The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30018If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30019and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30020is used for all recipients of the message,
30021then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30022and data is copied from one to the other.
30023
30024An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30025for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30026If a recipient-verify callout
30027(with use_sender)
30028connection is subsequently
30029requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30030any subsequent recipients and the data,
30031otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30032
30033Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30034and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30035Note also that headers cannot be
30036modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30037Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30038The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30039rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30040this will affect the timestamp.
30041
30042All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30043rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30044the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30045Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30046message body.
30047
30048Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30049of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30050before the entire message has been received from the source.
30051It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30052or CHUNKING
30053options in use.
30054
30055Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30056a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30057If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30058the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30059before the acceptance "<=" line.
30060
30061If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30062usual fashion.
30063This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30064to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30065&"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30066and does not queue the message.
30067Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30068
30069Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30070(possibly faked)
30071sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30072
30073
30074.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30075.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30076.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30077This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30078with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30079by default called &'debuglog'&.
30080The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30081may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30082the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30083option.
30084Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30085with the &'kill'& option.
30086Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30087contexts):
30088.code
30089 control = debug
30090 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30091 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30092 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30093 control = debug/kill
30094.endd
30095
30096
30097.vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30098.cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30099.cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30100This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30101the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30102
30103
30104.vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30105.cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30106.cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30107This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30108connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30109strings or to numeric value.
30110The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30111Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30112&`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30113
30114The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30115(for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30116that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30117equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30118Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30119
30120
30121.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30122 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30123.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30124.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30125These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30126is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30127state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30128in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30129
30130The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30131connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30132messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30133&%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30134before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30135synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30136work with.
30137
30138
30139.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30140.cindex "fake defer"
30141.cindex "defer, fake"
30142This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30143except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30144550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30145messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30146use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30147
30148.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30149.cindex "fake rejection"
30150.cindex "rejection, fake"
30151This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30152words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30153message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30154However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30155only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30156the same SMTP connection.
30157
30158The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30159message is supplied, the following is used:
30160.code
30161550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30162550-kept for evaluation.
30163550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30164550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30165.endd
30166This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30167
30168.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30169.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30170This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30171other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30172it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30173current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30174SMTP connection.
30175
30176This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30177&%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30178is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30179are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30180
30181.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30182.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30183Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30184avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30185use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30186disables such output flushing.
30187
30188.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30189.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30190Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30191avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30192use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30193that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30194
30195.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30196This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30197extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30198of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30199or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30200needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30201only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30202the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30203to be useful in production.
30204
30205.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30206.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30207This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30208It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30209SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30210
30211If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30212suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30213one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30214(&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30215responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30216sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30217
30218.ilist
30219Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30220sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30221verification failed"&) is sent.
30222.next
30223If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30224line is output.
30225.endlist
30226
30227The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30228calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30229
30230.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30231.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30232This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30233the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30234response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30235controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30236&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30237
30238.vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30239.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30240.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30241This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30242other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30243it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30244runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30245effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
30246to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
30247same SMTP connection.
30248
30249.vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30250.cindex "message" "submission"
30251.cindex "submission mode"
30252This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30253latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30254the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30255operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30256necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30257This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30258late (the message has already been created).
30259
30260Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30261messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30262submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30263The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30264that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30265
30266.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30267.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30268This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30269complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30270normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30271
30272.ilist
30273Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30274dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30275.next
30276No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30277.next
30278There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
30279.endlist ilist
30280
30281This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
30282passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
30283used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30284and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
30285data is read.
30286
30287&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
30288that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
30289
30290.vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
30291This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
30292to a-label form.
30293For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
30294.endlist vlist
30295
30296
30297.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
30298All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
30299
30300.ilist
30301Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
30302.next
30303Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
30304&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
30305.next
30306Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
30307.next
30308Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
30309.endlist
30310
30311
30312
30313.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
30314.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
30315.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
30316.cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
30317The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
30318to an incoming message, as in this example:
30319.code
30320warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30321 dialup.mail-abuse.org
30322 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
30323.endd
30324The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30325MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30326receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30327&%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30328any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30329RCPT ACL).
30330
30331Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30332DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30333
30334Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30335the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30336contains one or more newlines that
30337are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30338lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30339front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30340
30341Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30342They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30343However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30344is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30345during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30346with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30347lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30348In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30349non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30350message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30351are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30352
30353.cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30354Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30355of message headers
30356until they are added to the
30357message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30358ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30359header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30360ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30361passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30362this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30363&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30364
30365The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30366
30367The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30368processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30369.display
30370&`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30371&` `&<&'some condition'&>
30372
30373&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30374&` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30375.endd
30376In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
30377condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
30378condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
30379ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
30380honoured.
30381
30382.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30383For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
30384&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
30385effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
30386them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
30387usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
30388are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
30389specifications.
30390
30391By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
30392header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
30393be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
30394after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
30395that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
30396
30397This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
30398&":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
30399header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
30400to be a header name first.) For example:
30401.code
30402warn add_header = \
30403 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
30404.endd
30405If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
30406each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
30407you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
30408up in reverse order.
30409
30410&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30411added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
30412system filter or in a router or transport.
30413
30414
30415
30416.section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
30417.cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
30418.cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
30419.cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
30420The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
30421from an incoming message, as in this example:
30422.code
30423warn message = Remove internal headers
30424 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30425.endd
30426The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30427MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30428receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30429&%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
30430with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
30431any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
30432
30433Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
30434DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30435
30436More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
30437list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
30438not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
30439create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
30440are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
30441.code
30442warn hosts = +internal_hosts
30443 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30444warn message = Remove internal headers
30445 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
30446.endd
30447Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30448Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30449If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
30450There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
30451a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
30452during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
30453if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
30454accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
30455all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
30456ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
30457would have been removed.
30458
30459.cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
30460Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
30461is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
30462not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
30463removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
30464this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
30465passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
30466you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
30467&<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30468
30469The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30470processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30471.display
30472&`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
30473&` `&<&'some condition'&>
30474
30475&`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30476&` remove_header = X-Internal`&
30477.endd
30478In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
30479condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
30480condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
30481same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
30482are honoured.
30483
30484&*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30485present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
30486in a system filter or in a router or transport.
30487
30488
30489
30490
30491.section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
30492.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
30493Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
30494compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
30495for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
30496content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30497
30498Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
30499senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
30500result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
30501done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
30502can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
30503same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
30504The conditions are as follows:
30505
30506
30507.vlist
30508.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
30509.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
30510.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
30511.cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
30512.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
30513The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
30514&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
30515&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
30516false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
30517condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
30518condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
30519ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
30520
30521If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
30522can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
30523and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
30524Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
30525The name and values are expanded separately.
30526Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
30527will act as argument separators.
30528
30529If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
30530the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
30531&%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
30532conditions are tested.
30533
30534ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
30535loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
30536circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
30537for different local users or different local domains.
30538
30539.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30540.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
30541.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
30542.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
30543If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
30544the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
30545authentication by any authenticator, you can set
30546.code
30547authenticated = *
30548.endd
30549
30550.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
30551.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
30552.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
30553.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
30554.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
30555This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
30556expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
30557&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
30558number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
30559any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
30560&"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
30561ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
30562negative.
30563
30564.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
30565.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
30566This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30567content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30568&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30569If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30570problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30571chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30572
30573.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30574.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30575.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30576.cindex "black list (DNS)"
30577.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30578This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30579&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30580use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30581different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30582&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30583
30584.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30585.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30586.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30587.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30588.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30589This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30590of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30591enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30592lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30593&%domains%& test.
30594
30595&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30596use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30597
30598
30599.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30600.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30601.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30602.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30603If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30604name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30605encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30606.code
30607encrypted = *
30608.endd
30609
30610
30611.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30612.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30613.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30614.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30615This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30616name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30617you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30618.code
30619accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30620.endd
30621The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30622the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30623and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30624
30625The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30626Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30627but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30628find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30629opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30630found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30631
30632If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30633address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30634.code
30635accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30636accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30637.endd
30638The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30639is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30640statement can then check the IP address.
30641
30642.vindex "&$host_data$&"
30643If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30644of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30645allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30646.code
30647deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30648message = $host_data
30649.endd
30650which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30651
30652.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30653.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30654.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30655.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30656.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30657This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30658part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30659enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30660result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30661the next &%local_parts%& test.
30662
30663.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30664.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30665.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30666.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30667This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30668content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30669viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30670
30671.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30672.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30673.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30674This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30675content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30676&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30677with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30678&<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30679
30680.vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30681.cindex "rate limiting"
30682This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30683messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30684
30685.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30686.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30687.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30688.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30689This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30690recipient address against a list of recipients.
30691
30692.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30693.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30694.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30695This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30696content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30697non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30698any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30699
30700.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30701.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30702.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30703.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30704.vindex "&$domain$&"
30705.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30706This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30707domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30708&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30709of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30710lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30711RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30712influence the sender checking.
30713
30714&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30715relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30716
30717.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30718.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30719.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30720.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30721This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30722for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30723.code
30724senders = :
30725.endd
30726&*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30727relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30728
30729.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30730.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30731.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30732This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30733content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30734SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30735
30736.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30737.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30738.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30739.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30740.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30741.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30742This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30743certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30744server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30745or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30746
30747.vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30748.cindex "CSA verification"
30749This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30750send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30751&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30752
30753.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30754.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30755.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30756.cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30757.cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
30758This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30759received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30760&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
30761there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
30762allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
30763
30764Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
30765problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
30766detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
30767
30768.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
30769.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30770.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
30771.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
30772.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
30773.cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
30774This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30775received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30776&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
30777of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
30778is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
30779However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
30780that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
30781to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
30782might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
30783
30784Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
30785section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
30786&<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
30787condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
30788.code
30789deny senders = :
30790 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
30791 !verify = header_sender
30792.endd
30793
30794.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
30795.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30796.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
30797.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
30798.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
30799This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30800received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30801&%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
30802lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
30803and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
30804Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
30805permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
30806&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
30807appropriate.
30808
30809Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
30810ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
30811.code
30812To: @
30813.endd
30814and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
30815common as they used to be.
30816
30817.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
30818.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30819.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
30820.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
30821.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
30822.cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
30823.cindex "verifying" "HELO"
30824This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
30825client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
30826attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
30827condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
30828&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
30829independently of this condition.
30830
30831For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
30832option), this condition is always true.
30833
30834
30835.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
30836.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
30837.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
30838This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
30839Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
30840&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
30841case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
30842&'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
30843used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
30844
30845There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
30846recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
30847
30848
30849.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
30850.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30851.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
30852.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
30853.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
30854.vindex "&$address_data$&"
30855This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
30856recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
30857&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
30858of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
30859This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
30860verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
30861address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
30862value for the child address.
30863
30864.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
30865.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30866.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
30867.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
30868This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
30869address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
30870was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
30871Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
30872one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
30873original IP address.
30874
30875There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
30876DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
30877
30878If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
30879is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
30880
30881.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
30882.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30883.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
30884.cindex "sender" "verifying"
30885.cindex "verifying" "sender"
30886This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
30887message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
30888the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
30889condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
30890
30891.vindex "&$address_data$&"
30892.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
30893If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
30894value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
30895value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
30896statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
30897want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
30898
30899Details of verification are given later, starting at section
30900&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
30901to avoid doing it more than once per message.
30902
30903.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
30904.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30905This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
30906verified as a sender.
30907
30908Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
30909(eg. is generated from the received message)
30910they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
30911.code
30912verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
30913.endd
30914.endlist
30915
30916
30917
30918.section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
30919.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30920.cindex "black list (DNS)"
30921.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30922In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
30923is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
30924address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
30925domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
30926special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
30927address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
30928.code
30929deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
30930 dialups.mail-abuse.org
30931.endd
30932the following records are looked up:
30933.code
3093443.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
3093543.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
30936.endd
30937As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
30938Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
30939to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
30940use two separate conditions:
30941.code
30942deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30943 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30944.endd
30945If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
30946behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
30947record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
30948processed.
30949
30950This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
30951(which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
30952blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
30953following special items in the list:
30954.display
30955&`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
30956&`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
30957&`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
30958.endd
30959.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
30960.cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
30961.cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
30962Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
30963.code
30964deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
30965.endd
30966Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
30967warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
30968.code
30969deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30970warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
30971 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30972.endd
30973.cindex caching "of dns lookup"
30974.cindex DNS TTL
30975DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
30976(but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
30977so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
30978connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
30979Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
30980connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
30981
30982There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
30983or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
30984&url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
30985
30986
30987
30988.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
30989.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
30990By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
30991of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
30992after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
30993.code
30994deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
30995.endd
30996This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
30997use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
30998MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
30999&<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31000
31001
31002
31003
31004.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31005.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31006There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31007addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31008&url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31009with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31010listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31011.code
31012deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31013 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31014.endd
31015This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31016RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31017example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31018up by this example is
31019.code
31020tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31021.endd
31022A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31023addresses. For example:
31024.code
31025deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31026 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31027.endd
31028The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31029name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31030
31031
31032
31033
31034.section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31035.cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31036The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31037names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31038name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31039As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31040this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31041either to double the separators like this:
31042.code
31043dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31044.endd
31045or to change the separator character, like this:
31046.code
31047dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31048.endd
31049If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31050blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31051occurs. Consider this condition:
31052.code
31053dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31054.endd
31055The DNS lookups that occur are:
31056.code
310572.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31058a.domain.black.list.tld
31059.endd
31060Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31061address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31062are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31063or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31064only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31065successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31066error for a previous item.
31067
31068The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31069syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31070.code
31071dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31072dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31073.endd
31074However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31075is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31076.code
31077deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31078 $sender_address_domain \
31079 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31080 see $dnslist_text.
31081 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31082 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31083 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31084.endd
31085Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31086multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31087and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31088of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31089.code
31090dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31091.endd
31092Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31093domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31094
31095The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31096&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31097
31098
31099
31100
31101.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31102.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31103DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31104just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31105RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31106The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31107.display
31108127.1.0.1 RBL
31109127.1.0.2 DUL
31110127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31111127.1.0.4 RSS
31112127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31113127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31114127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31115.endd
31116Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31117different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31118see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31119
31120
31121.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31122.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31123.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31124.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31125.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31126.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31127.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31128When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31129the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31130&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31131(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31132the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31133&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31134cases, for example:
31135.code
31136deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31137.endd
31138the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31139&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31140For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31141might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31142.code
31143deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31144.endd
31145If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31146&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31147
31148If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31149addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31150The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31151record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31152very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31153information.
31154
31155You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31156&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31157expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31158.code
31159deny hosts = !+local_networks
31160 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31161 at $dnslist_domain
31162 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31163.endd
31164
31165
31166
31167.section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31168.cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31169You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31170in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31171For example,
31172.code
31173deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31174.endd
31175rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31176any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31177that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31178describes how multiple records are handled.
31179
31180More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31181separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31182&%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31183.code
31184deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31185.endd
31186If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31187addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31188first. For example:
31189.code
31190deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31191 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31192.endd
31193
31194If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31195listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31196In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31197true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31198tested. For example:
31199.code
31200dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31201.endd
31202matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31203want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31204being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31205.code
31206dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31207.endd
31208matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31209an odd number.
31210
31211
31212
31213.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31214You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31215condition. Whereas
31216.code
31217deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31218.endd
31219means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31220IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31221.code
31222deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31223.endd
31224means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31225IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31226words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31227the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31228
31229&*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31230host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31231
31232If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31233previous example is precisely equivalent to
31234.code
31235deny dnslists = a.b.c
31236 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31237.endd
31238However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31239Consider this example:
31240.code
31241deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31242 list.dsbl.org : \
31243 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31244 relays.ordb.org
31245.endd
31246Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31247.code
31248deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31249 list.dsbl.org
31250deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31251 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31252deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31253.endd
31254which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31255
31256
31257
31258
31259.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31260A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31261thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31262is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31263the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31264the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31265.code
31266dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31267.endd
31268What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31269127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31270condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31271because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31272affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
31273additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
31274
31275.ilist
31276If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
31277IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
31278condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31279.next
31280If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
31281looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
31282changed to:
31283.code
31284dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
31285.endd
31286and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31287false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
31288.code
31289dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
31290.endd
31291for the condition to be true.
31292.endlist
31293
31294When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
31295the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
31296.ilist
31297If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
31298addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
31299.code
31300dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
31301.endd
31302If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31303false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31304.next
31305If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
31306looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
31307.code
31308dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
31309.endd
31310If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31311true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
31312.code
31313dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31314.endd
31315for the condition to be false.
31316.endlist
31317When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
31318between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
31319
31320
31321
31322
31323.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
31324.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
31325When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
31326the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
31327the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
31328address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31329only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31330can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31331in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31332lists.
31333
31334A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31335two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31336do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31337If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31338restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31339a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31340domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31341.code
31342deny message = \
31343 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31344 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31345 dnslists = \
31346 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31347 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31348.endd
31349For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31350&'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31351match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31352value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31353record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31354The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31355
31356If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31357given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31358the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31359.code
31360deny dnslists = \
31361 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31362 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31363 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31364 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31365.endd
31366In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31367values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31368done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31369
31370
31371
31372.section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
31373.cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
31374.cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
31375If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
31376nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
313773ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
31378.code
313791.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
31380 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31381.endd
31382(split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
31383lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
31384IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
31385.code
31386*.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
31387.endd
31388is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
31389Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
31390
31391You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
31392&%condition%& condition, as in this example:
31393.code
31394deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
31395 dnslists = some.list.example
31396.endd
31397
31398If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
31399address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
31400(DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
31401.code
31402 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
31403.endd
31404
31405.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
31406.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
31407.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
31408.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
31409The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
31410which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
31411&%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
31412commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
31413works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
31414host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
31415.display
31416&`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
31417.endd
31418If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
31419period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
31420
31421As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
31422&$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
31423configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
31424of &'p'&.
31425
31426The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
31427time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
31428means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
31429parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
31430send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
31431in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
31432constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
31433changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
31434both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
31435
31436There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
31437log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
31438when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
31439instructions when it is run with no arguments.
31440
31441The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
31442sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
31443retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
31444which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
31445By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
31446of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
31447user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
31448&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
31449example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
31450authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
31451
31452The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
31453rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
31454&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
31455ACL.
31456
31457Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
31458specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
31459or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
31460&%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
31461using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
31462separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
31463
31464Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
31465any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
31466stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
31467remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
31468remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
31469behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
31470the &%count=%& option.
31471
31472
31473.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
31474.cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
31475The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
31476normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
31477&%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
31478
31479The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
31480the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
31481&%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
31482&%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
31483
31484The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
31485the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
31486in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
31487used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
31488in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
31489follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
31490in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
31491
31492The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
31493accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31494&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
31495&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
31496ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
31497in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
31498recipients as a large high-speed burst.
31499
31500The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
31501number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
31502last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
31503recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
31504&%acl_smtp_rcpt%&.
31505
31506The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
31507condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
31508command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
31509multiple different commands.
31510
31511The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
31512measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
31513&`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
31514increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
31515other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
31516
31517The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
31518
31519
31520.section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
31521.cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
31522You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
31523control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
31524mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
31525
31526If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
31527previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
31528
31529For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
31530it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
31531can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
31532in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
31533new rate.
31534.code
31535acl_check_connect:
31536 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
31537 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31538 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31539# ...
31540acl_check_mail:
31541 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
31542 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31543 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31544.endd
31545
31546If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
31547processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
31548it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
31549in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
31550same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
31551multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
31552checks.
31553
31554The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
31555use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
31556update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
31557&%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
31558next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
31559
31560
31561.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
31562.cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
31563If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
31564engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
31565&%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
31566counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
31567rest of the ACL.
31568
31569The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
31570updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
31571client's average rate of successfully sent email,
31572up to the given limit.
31573This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31574consists of refusing the message, and
31575is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31576If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31577likely not what is wanted.
31578
31579The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31580updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31581of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31582actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31583counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31584pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31585again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31586attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31587.code
31588 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31589.endd
31590
31591
31592.section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31593.cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31594The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31595rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31596mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31597sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31598&`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31599measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31600options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31601
31602For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31603has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31604rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31605per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31606go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31607recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31608
31609When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31610&%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31611rate.
31612
31613The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31614other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31615unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31616required increases with larger limits.
31617
31618The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31619will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31620the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31621the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31622events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31623times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31624throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31625limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31626are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31627as intended.
31628
31629
31630.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31631Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31632when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31633(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31634policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31635message. For example:
31636.code
31637# Log all senders' rates
31638warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31639 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31640
31641# Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31642# at the decimal point.
31643warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31644 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31645 $sender_rate_limit }s
31646
31647# Keep authenticated users under control
31648deny authenticated = *
31649 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31650
31651# System-wide rate limit
31652defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31653 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31654
31655# Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31656# set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31657defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31658 messages per $sender_rate_period
31659 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31660 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31661 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31662.endd
31663&*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31664especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31665bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31666making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31667RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31668this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31669hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31670
31671
31672
31673.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31674.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31675.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31676Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31677&<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31678&<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31679The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31680verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31681other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31682.code
31683verify = sender/callout
31684verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31685.endd
31686The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31687address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31688difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31689be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31690(see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31691The available options are as follows:
31692
31693.ilist
31694If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31695remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31696check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31697.next
31698If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31699normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31700options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31701verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31702.next
31703The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31704discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31705.next
31706The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31707immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31708generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31709discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31710.endlist
31711
31712.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31713.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31714.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31715.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31716After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31717error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31718coding like this:
31719.code
31720warn !verify = sender
31721 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31722.endd
31723If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31724denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31725verification failure.
31726
31727In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31728appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31729
31730.ilist
31731&%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31732was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31733.next
31734&%route%&: Routing failed.
31735.next
31736&%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31737occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31738connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31739.next
31740&%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31741.next
31742&%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31743.endlist
31744
31745The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31746rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31747
31748The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
31749address verification to:
31750
31751.ilist
31752&%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
31753.endlist
31754
31755
31756
31757
31758.section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
31759.cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
31760.cindex "callout" "verification"
31761.cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
31762For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
31763checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
31764the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
31765&'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
31766a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
31767address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
31768sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
31769deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
31770sender's domain.
31771
31772Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
31773request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
31774described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
31775lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
31776cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
31777caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
31778
31779Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
31780the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
31781callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
31782callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
31783on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
31784
31785If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
31786second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
31787one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
31788&(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
31789router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
31790&%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
31791&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
31792supplies a host list.
31793Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
31794
31795The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
31796remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
31797specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
31798specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
31799specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
31800the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
31801&$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
31802
31803For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
31804test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
31805following SMTP commands are sent:
31806.display
31807&`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
31808&`MAIL FROM:<>`&
31809&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
31810&`QUIT`&
31811.endd
31812LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
31813set to &"lmtp"&.
31814
31815The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
31816settings.
31817
31818A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
31819for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
31820the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
31821that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
31822do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
31823&%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
31824
31825If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
31826succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
31827Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
31828hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
31829&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
31830
31831.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31832A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
31833output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
31834clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
31835disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
31836
31837
31838
31839
31840.section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
31841.cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
31842The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
31843optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
31844.code
31845verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
31846.endd
31847The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
31848separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
31849deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
31850
31851
31852.vlist
31853.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
31854.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
31855This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
31856For example:
31857.code
31858verify = sender/callout=5s
31859.endd
31860The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
31861remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
31862the &%connect%& parameter.
31863
31864
31865.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31866.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
31867This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
31868for making the SMTP connection. For example:
31869.code
31870verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
31871.endd
31872If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
31873
31874.vitem &*defer_ok*&
31875.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
31876When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
31877of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
31878updated in this circumstance.
31879
31880.vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
31881.cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
31882This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
31883&'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
31884accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
31885unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
31886
31887
31888.vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31889.cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
31890When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
31891verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
31892sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
31893whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
31894MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
31895as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
31896(empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
31897address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
31898.code
31899require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
31900.endd
31901This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
31902
31903
31904.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31905.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
31906This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
31907For example:
31908.code
31909verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
31910.endd
31911This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
31912commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
31913be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
31914very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
31915(for example, when network connections are timing out).
31916
31917
31918.vitem &*no_cache*&
31919.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
31920.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
31921When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
31922
31923.vitem &*postmaster*&
31924.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
31925When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
31926check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
31927rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
31928the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
31929used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
31930made, until the cache record expires.
31931
31932.vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31933The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
31934You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
31935For example:
31936.code
31937require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
31938.endd
31939If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
31940one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
31941.code
31942require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
31943.endd
31944&*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
31945account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
31946a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
31947postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
31948
31949
31950.vitem &*random*&
31951.cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
31952When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
31953check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
31954really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
31955&%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
31956.code
31957$primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
31958.endd
31959The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
31960parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
31961specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
31962a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
31963succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
31964
31965.vitem &*use_postmaster*&
31966.cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
31967This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31968.code
31969deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
31970.endd
31971.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31972It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
31973performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
31974that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
31975domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
31976
31977.vitem &*use_sender*&
31978This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31979.code
31980require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
31981.endd
31982It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
31983command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
31984need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
31985sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
31986usefulness of callout caching.
31987
31988.vitem &*hold*&
31989This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31990.code
31991require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
31992.endd
31993It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
31994and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
31995Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
31996when that is used for the connections.
31997The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
31998(which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
31999if the use_sender option is used,
32000if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32001and if no other callouts intervene.
32002.endlist
32003
32004If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32005command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32006&%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32007usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32008that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32009Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32010these circumstances.
32011
32012However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32013host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32014callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32015sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32016callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32017own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32018is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32019
32020Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32021caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32022by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32023actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32024
32025
32026
32027
32028.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32029.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32030.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32031.cindex "caching" "callout"
32032Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32033used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32034option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32035different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32036a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32037entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32038
32039When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32040the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32041is not available.
32042
32043The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32044independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32045(default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32046
32047If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32048commands up to and including
32049.code
32050MAIL FROM:<>
32051.endd
32052(but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32053any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32054domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32055making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32056separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32057&%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32058&%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32059
32060Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32061cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32062Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32063ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32064will eventually be noticed.
32065
32066The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32067being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32068behaviour will be the same.
32069
32070
32071
32072.section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32073.cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32074See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32075verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32076failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32077relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32078you might see:
32079.code
32080MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32081250 OK
32082RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32083550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32084550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32085550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32086550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32087550 Sender verification failed
32088.endd
32089If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32090only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32091out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32092&`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32093example:
32094.code
32095verify = sender/no_details
32096.endd
32097
32098.section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32099.cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32100.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32101A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32102during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32103or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32104it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32105
32106.ilist
32107When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32108continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32109verification also fails.
32110.next
32111When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32112verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32113.endlist
32114
32115This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32116way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32117example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32118.code
32119A.Wol: aw123
32120aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32121.endd
32122work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32123redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32124mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32125verification to succeed.
32126
32127It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32128redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32129generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32130option. For example:
32131.code
32132require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32133.endd
32134In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32135the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32136
32137When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32138redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32139also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32140address and a report is output for each of them.
32141
32142
32143
32144.section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32145.cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32146Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32147which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32148special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32149domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32150Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32151.code
32152verify = csa
32153.endd
32154This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32155valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32156succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32157&$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32158&"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32159be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32160
32161The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32162detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32163looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32164address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32165
32166.ilist
32167The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32168.next
32169The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32170.next
32171The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32172(for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32173.next
32174The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32175that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32176.endlist
32177
32178The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32179use for the DNS query. The default is:
32180.code
32181verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32182.endd
32183This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32184is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32185address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32186the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32187meaningful to say:
32188.code
32189verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32190.endd
32191In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32192This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32193&%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32194
32195If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32196is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32197making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32198using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32199default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32200default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32201(&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32202of legitimate HELO domains.
32203
32204The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32205direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32206search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32207addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32208lookup such as:
32209.code
32210${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32211.endd
32212has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32213The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32214authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32215
32216
32217
32218
32219.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32220.cindex "BATV, verifying"
32221Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32222of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32223Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32224recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32225bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32226spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32227
32228There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32229&"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32230the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32231address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32232item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32233The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32234&<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32235The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32236
32237As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32238database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32239like this:
32240.code
32241PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32242 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32243 }{$value}}
32244.endd
32245Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32246list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32247use this:
32248.code
32249# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32250deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32251 senders = :
32252 recipients = +batv_senders
32253
32254# Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32255deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32256 senders = :
32257 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32258 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32259 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32260.endd
32261The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32262to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32263send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32264recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32265the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32266
32267A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32268&%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32269prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32270the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32271the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32272timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
32273of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
32274
32275There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
32276you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
32277deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
32278router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
32279.code
32280batv_redirect:
32281 driver = redirect
32282 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
32283.endd
32284This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
32285of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
32286address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
32287local addresses.
32288
32289To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
32290can be used:
32291.code
32292external_smtp_batv:
32293 driver = smtp
32294 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
32295 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
32296 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
32297 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
32298 {$value}fail}}}
32299.endd
32300If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
32301
32302
32303
32304.section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
32305.cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
32306.cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
32307.cindex "policy control" "relay control"
32308An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
32309delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
32310within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
32311passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
32312.cindex "&""percent hack""&"
32313but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
32314
32315Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
32316A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
32317relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
32318a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
32319with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
32320same host is fulfilling both functions,
32321. ///
32322. as illustrated in the diagram below,
32323. ///
32324but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32325not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32326system to arbitrary domains.
32327
32328
32329You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32330runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32331Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32332example, suppose you want to do the following:
32333
32334.ilist
32335Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32336locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32337&'my.dom2.example'&.
32338.next
32339Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32340These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32341.next
32342Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32343Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32344.endlist
32345
32346
32347In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32348.code
32349domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32350domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32351hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32352.endd
32353Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32354command:
32355.code
32356acl_check_rcpt:
32357 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32358 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32359.endd
32360The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32361the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32362statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32363hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32364than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32365default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32366in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32367
32368
32369
32370.section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
32371.cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
32372You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
32373that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
32374the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
32375.ecindex IIDacl
32376
32377
32378
32379. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32380. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32381
32382.chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
32383.scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
32384The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
32385as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
32386was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
32387maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
32388specification.
32389
32390It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
32391&[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
32392scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
32393messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
32394chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
32395
32396If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
32397Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
32398&_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
32399
32400.ilist
32401Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
32402for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
32403.next
32404Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
32405&%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
32406run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
32407.next
32408An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
32409of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32410.next
32411Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
32412conditions.
32413.next
32414Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
32415.endlist
32416
32417Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
32418added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
32419changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
32420EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
32421this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
32422&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
32423
32424All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
32425temporarily created in a file called:
32426.display
32427<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
32428.endd
32429The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
32430expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
32431first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
32432scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
32433removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
32434.code
32435control = no_mbox_unspool
32436.endd
32437has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
32438same directory by default.
32439
32440
32441
32442.section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
32443.cindex "virus scanning"
32444.cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
32445.cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
32446The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
32447It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
32448specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
32449in memory and thus are much faster.
32450
32451A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
32452if it expires then a defer action is taken.
32453
32454.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
32455You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
32456to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
32457are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
32458.display
32459&`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
32460.endd
32461If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
32462.code
32463av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
32464.endd
32465If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
32466before use.
32467The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
32468The following scanner types are supported in this release,
32469though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
32470
32471.vlist
32472.vitem &%avast%&
32473.cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
32474This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
32475Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
32476You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
32477at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
32478This scanner type takes one option,
32479which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32480or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32481The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32482single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32483A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
32484Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
32485the daemon as options before the main scan command.
32486
32487.cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
32488If &`pass_unscanned`&
32489is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
32490decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
32491care.
32492
32493For example:
32494.code
32495av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32496av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32497av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
32498.endd
32499If you omit the argument, the default path
32500&_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
32501is used.
32502If you use a remote host,
32503you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
32504as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
32505For information about available commands and their options you may use
32506.code
32507$ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
32508 FLAGS
32509 SENSITIVITY
32510 PACK
32511.endd
32512
32513If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
32514permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
32515written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
32516
32517.vitem &%aveserver%&
32518.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32519This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
32520at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
32521which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
32522example:
32523.code
32524av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
32525.endd
32526
32527
32528.vitem &%clamd%&
32529.cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
32530This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
32531&url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
32532unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
32533in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
32534
32535The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
32536a UNIX socket specification,
32537a TCP socket specification,
32538or a (global) option.
32539
32540A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
32541For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
32542for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
32543and the second a port number,
32544Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
32545These per-server options are supported:
32546.code
32547retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32548.endd
32549
32550The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32551a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
32552
32553If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
32554
32555Examples:
32556.code
32557av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
32558av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
32559av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
32560av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
32561av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
32562.endd
32563If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
32564&`local`&
32565option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
32566to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
32567more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
32568Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32569
32570The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32571randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32572that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32573socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32574unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32575When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32576not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32577selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32578email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32579.code
325802013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32581 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32582 (Connection refused)
32583.endd
32584
32585If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32586contributing the code for this scanner.
32587
32588.vitem &%cmdline%&
32589.cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32590This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32591used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32592type takes 3 mandatory options:
32593
32594.olist
32595The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32596and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32597
32598.next
32599A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32600virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32601absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32602the &"trigger"& expression.
32603
32604.next
32605Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32606match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32607&"name"& expression.
32608.endlist olist
32609
32610For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32611.code
32612Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32613.endd
32614For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32615name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32616for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32617configuration setting:
32618.code
32619av_scanner = cmdline:\
32620 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32621 found in file:'(.+)'
32622.endd
32623.vitem &%drweb%&
32624.cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
32625The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
32626takes one option,
32627either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32628or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32629The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32630single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32631For example:
32632.code
32633av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
32634av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
32635.endd
32636If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
32637is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
32638
32639.vitem &%f-protd%&
32640.cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
32641The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32642One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32643(or port-range).
32644For example:
32645.code
32646av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32647.endd
32648If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
32649
32650.vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32651.cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32652The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32653One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32654For example:
32655.code
32656av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32657.endd
32658If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32659
32660.vitem &%fsecure%&
32661.cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32662The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
32663argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32664.code
32665av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32666.endd
32667If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32668Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32669
32670.vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32671.cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32672This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32673Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32674scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32675For example:
32676.code
32677av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32678.endd
32679The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32680
32681.vitem &%mksd%&
32682.cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32683This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
32684though some documentation was available in English.
32685The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
32686and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
32687we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
32688to integrate.
32689The only option for this scanner type is
32690the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32691provided that mksd has
32692been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32693.code
32694av_scanner = mksd:2
32695.endd
32696You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32697
32698.vitem &%sock%&
32699.cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32700This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32701running on the local machine.
32702There are four options:
32703an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32704a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32705the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32706an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32707and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32708For example:
32709.code
32710av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32711.endd
32712Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32713there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32714The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32715Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32716specify an empty element to get this.
32717
32718.vitem &%sophie%&
32719.cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32720Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32721You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
32722for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32723client communication. For example:
32724.code
32725av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32726.endd
32727The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32728the option.
32729.endlist
32730
32731When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32732the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32733ACL.
32734
32735The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32736makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32737The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32738for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32739However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32740which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
32741message.
32742
32743The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
32744use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
32745The first element can then be one of
32746
32747.ilist
32748&"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
32749The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
32750recommended usage.
32751.next
32752&"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
32753the condition fails immediately.
32754.next
32755A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
32756condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
32757expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
32758Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
32759unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
32760.endlist
32761
32762You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
32763messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
32764Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
32765
32766You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
32767specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
32768For example:
32769.code
32770malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
32771.endd
32772A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
32773
32774.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32775When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32776is set to record the actual address used.
32777
32778.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
32779When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
32780&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
32781&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
32782logging data.
32783
32784Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
32785imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
32786
32787Here is a very simple scanning example:
32788.code
32789deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32790 malware = *
32791.endd
32792The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
32793.code
32794deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32795 malware = */defer_ok
32796.endd
32797The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
32798aveserver. It assumes you have set:
32799.code
32800av_scanner = $acl_m0
32801.endd
32802in the main Exim configuration.
32803.code
32804deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32805 set acl_m0 = sophie
32806 malware = *
32807
32808deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32809 set acl_m0 = aveserver
32810 malware = *
32811.endd
32812
32813
32814.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
32815.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
32816.cindex "spam scanning"
32817.cindex "SpamAssassin"
32818.cindex "Rspamd"
32819The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
32820score and a report for the message.
32821Support is also provided for Rspamd.
32822
32823For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
32824Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
32825&url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
32826
32827SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
32828.code
32829perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
32830.endd
32831SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
32832documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
32833nicely, however.
32834
32835.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
32836By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
32837intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
32838&%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
32839you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
32840configuration as follows (example):
32841.code
32842spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
32843.endd
32844The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
32845If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
32846iptables firewall, consider setting
32847&%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
32848timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
32849server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
32850connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
32851soon.
32852
32853
32854To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
32855on TCP port 11333)
32856you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
32857.code
32858spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
32859.endd
32860
32861As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
32862sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
32863filename instead of an address/port pair:
32864.code
32865spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
32866.endd
32867You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
32868reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
32869&%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
32870option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
32871.code
32872spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
32873 192.168.2.11 783 : \
32874 192.168.2.12 783
32875.endd
32876Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
32877When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
32878servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
32879condition defers.
32880
32881Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
32882Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
32883and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
32884take care to not double the separator.
32885
32886For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
32887subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
32888and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
32889In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
32890
32891Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
32892are options.
32893The supported options are:
32894.code
32895pri=<priority> Selection priority
32896weight=<value> Selection bias
32897time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
32898retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32899tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
32900variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
32901.endd
32902
32903The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
32904higher values being tried first.
32905The default priority is 1.
32906
32907The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
32908Within a priority set
32909servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
32910The default value for selection bias is 1.
32911
32912Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
32913in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
32914Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
32915characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
32916
32917Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
32918are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
32919
32920The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
32921The default value is two minutes.
32922
32923The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32924a failed connect is made.
32925The default is to not retry.
32926
32927The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
32928a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
32929used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
32930expansion.
32931
32932.vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32933When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32934is set to record the actual address used.
32935
32936.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
32937Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
32938.code
32939deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32940 spam = joe
32941.endd
32942The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
32943relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
32944to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
32945default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
32946Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
32947right-hand side.
32948
32949The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
32950principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
32951have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
32952&%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
32953read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
32954are not set.
32955Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
32956(e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
32957after the first),
32958or the use of PRDR,
32959.cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
32960are needed to use this feature.
32961
32962The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
32963you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
32964&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
32965
32966
32967Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
32968large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
32969are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
32970example:
32971.code
32972deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32973 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
32974 spam = nobody
32975.endd
32976
32977The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
32978SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
32979&%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
32980it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
32981
32982.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
32983When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
32984variables.
32985Except for &$spam_report$&,
32986these variables are saved with the received message so are
32987available for use at delivery time.
32988
32989.vlist
32990.vitem &$spam_score$&
32991The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
32992for inclusion in log or reject messages.
32993
32994.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
32995The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
32996example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
32997because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
32998The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
32999
33000.vitem &$spam_bar$&
33001A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33002integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33003&$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33004headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33005spam bar is 50 characters.
33006
33007.vitem &$spam_report$&
33008A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33009message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33010This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33011Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33012when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33013unencoded in headers.
33014
33015.vitem &$spam_action$&
33016For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33017spam score versus threshold.
33018For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33019
33020.endlist
33021
33022The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33023spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33024does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33025
33026The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33027the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33028failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33029statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33030spam condition, like this:
33031.code
33032deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33033 spam = joe/defer_ok
33034.endd
33035This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33036
33037Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33038condition:
33039.code
33040# put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33041warn spam = nobody:true
33042 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33043 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33044
33045# add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33046# is over threshold
33047warn spam = nobody
33048 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33049
33050# reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33051deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33052 spam = nobody:true
33053 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33054.endd
33055
33056
33057
33058.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33059.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33060.cindex "MIME content scanning"
33061.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33062.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33063The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33064each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33065of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33066specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33067options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33068cases.
33069
33070These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33071ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33072the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33073message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33074ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33075result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33076&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33077
33078You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33079only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33080condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33081&%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33082&<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33083
33084At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33085information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33086of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33087parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33088part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33089syntax is:
33090.display
33091&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33092.endd
33093The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33094the value can be:
33095
33096.olist
33097&"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33098.next
33099The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33100&"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33101a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33102full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33103.next
33104A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33105directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33106is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33107the full path and filename.
33108.next
33109If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33110filename, and the default path is then used.
33111.endlist
33112The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33113errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33114a file with its original, proposed filename using
33115.code
33116decode = $mime_filename
33117.endd
33118However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33119anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33120automatically unlinked.
33121
33122For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33123content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33124as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33125variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33126before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33127
33128The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33129used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33130respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33131
33132.cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33133The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33134available in the MIME ACL:
33135
33136.vlist
33137.vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33138If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
33139have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33140has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33141contains the empty string.
33142
33143.vitem &$mime_charset$&
33144This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33145&'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33146.code
33147us-ascii
33148gb2312 (Chinese)
33149iso-8859-1
33150.endd
33151Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33152case-insensitively.
33153
33154.vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33155This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33156header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33157implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33158only used for display purposes.
33159
33160.vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33161This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33162header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33163
33164.vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33165This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33166This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33167
33168.vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33169This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33170successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33171size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33172has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33173
33174.vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33175This variable contains the normalized content of the
33176&'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33177type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33178
33179.vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33180If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33181value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33182are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33183.code
33184text/plain
33185text/html
33186application/octet-stream
33187image/jpeg
33188audio/midi
33189.endd
33190If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33191empty string.
33192
33193.vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33194This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33195successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33196containing the decoded data.
33197.endlist
33198
33199.cindex "RFC 2047"
33200.vlist
33201.vitem &$mime_filename$&
33202This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33203proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33204&'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33205RFC2047
33206or RFC2231
33207decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33208 If no filename was
33209found, this variable contains the empty string.
33210
33211.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33212This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33213attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33214content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33215
33216The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33217cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33218follows:
33219
33220.olist
33221The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33222
33223.next
33224If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33225so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33226
33227.next
33228If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33229and the rest are attachments.
33230
33231.next
33232All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33233.endlist olist
33234
33235As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33236alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33237coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33238.code
33239deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33240!condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33241condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33242condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33243.endd
33244.vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33245This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
33246&"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
33247Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
33248want to carry out specific actions on them.
33249
33250.vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33251This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
33252checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
33253decoding is fully recursive.
33254
33255.vitem &$mime_part_count$&
33256This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
33257starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
33258counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
33259&$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
33260complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
33261parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
33262.endlist
33263
33264
33265
33266.section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
33267.cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
33268.cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
33269You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
33270the message, or on individual MIME parts.
33271
33272The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
33273matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
33274MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
33275linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
33276have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
33277
33278The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
33279to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
33280part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
33281is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
33282and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
3328332K characters are checked.
33284
33285The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
33286literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
33287expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
33288with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
33289Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
33290.code
33291deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
33292 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
33293.endd
33294The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
33295&$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
33296matching regular expression.
33297The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
33298are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
33299
33300&*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
33301CPU-intensive.
33302
33303.ecindex IIDcosca
33304
33305
33306
33307
33308. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33309. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33310
33311.chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
33312 "Local scan function"
33313.scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
33314.cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
33315.cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
33316In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
33317want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
33318
33319The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
33320passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
33321a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
33322condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
33323non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
33324
33325To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33326possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33327in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33328can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33329
33330The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33331when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33332It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33333well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33334
33335Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33336option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33337Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33338Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33339before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33340are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33341incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
33342For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
33343code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
33344
33345
33346
33347.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
33348.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
33349To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
33350function is before building Exim, by setting
33351both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
33352LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
33353&_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
33354directory, so you might set
33355.code
33356HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
33357LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
33358.endd
33359for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
33360Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
33361be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
33362function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
33363commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
33364_src/local_scan.c_.
33365
33366If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
33367for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
33368.code
33369LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33370.endd
33371in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
33372
33373
33374
33375
33376.section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
33377.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
33378.cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
33379You must include this line near the start of your code:
33380.code
33381#include "local_scan.h"
33382.endd
33383This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
33384prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
33385almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
33386for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
33387It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
33388strings and pointers to character strings:
33389.code
33390#define CS (char *)
33391#define CCS (const char *)
33392#define CSS (char **)
33393#define US (unsigned char *)
33394#define CUS (const unsigned char *)
33395#define USS (unsigned char **)
33396.endd
33397The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
33398.code
33399extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
33400.endd
33401The arguments are as follows:
33402
33403.ilist
33404&%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
33405(the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
33406recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
33407
33408The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
33409character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
33410id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
33411macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
33412case this changes in some future version.
33413.next
33414&%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
33415string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
33416.endlist
33417
33418The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
33419
33420.vlist
33421.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
33422.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
33423The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
33424the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
33425newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
33426maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
33427
33428.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
33429This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33430queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
33431
33432.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
33433This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33434queued without immediate delivery.
33435
33436.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
33437The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
33438passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
33439they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
33440&`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
33441used.
33442
33443.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
33444The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
33445message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
33446problem"& is used.
33447
33448.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33449This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
33450message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
33451&%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
33452&%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
33453&%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
33454same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33455
33456.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33457This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
33458LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33459.endlist
33460
33461If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
33462reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
33463&%-oe%& command line options.
33464
33465
33466
33467.section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
33468.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
33469It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
33470that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
33471want to do this, you must have the line
33472.code
33473LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33474.endd
33475in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
33476&_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
33477file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
33478to define them.
33479
33480The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
33481&`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
33482and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
33483alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
33484variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
33485entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
33486.code
33487static int my_integer_option = 42;
33488static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
33489
33490optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
33491 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
33492 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
33493};
33494
33495int local_scan_options_count =
33496 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
33497.endd
33498The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
33499configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
33500.code
33501begin local_scan
33502my_integer = 99
33503my_string = some string of text...
33504.endd
33505The available types of option data are as follows:
33506
33507.vlist
33508.vitem &*opt_bool*&
33509This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
33510variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
33511that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
33512whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
33513TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
33514values.)
33515
33516.vitem &*opt_fixed*&
33517This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
33518The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
33519multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
33520
33521.vitem &*opt_int*&
33522This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
33523&`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
33524Exim.
33525
33526.vitem &*opt_mkint*&
33527This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
33528&%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
33529printed with the suffix K or M.
33530
33531.vitem &*opt_octint*&
33532This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
33533octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
33534always output in octal.
33535
33536.vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
33537This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
33538variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
33539
33540.vitem &*opt_time*&
33541This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
33542type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
33543.endlist
33544
33545If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
33546out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
33547
33548
33549
33550.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
33551.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
33552The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
33553are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
33554Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
33555including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
33556C variables are as follows:
33557
33558.vlist
33559.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
33560This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
33561It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33562
33563.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
33564This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
33565It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33566
33567.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
33568This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
33569is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
33570&[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
33571
33572.ilist
33573The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33574testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33575other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33576
33577.next
33578The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33579by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33580of debugging bits.
33581.endlist ilist
33582
33583Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33584selected, you should use code like this:
33585.code
33586if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33587 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33588.endd
33589.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33590After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33591variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33592
33593.vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33594A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33595discussed below.
33596
33597.vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33598A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33599
33600.vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33601The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33602
33603.vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
33604This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
33605&%-bh%& command line option.
33606
33607.vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
33608The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
33609is NULL for locally submitted messages.
33610
33611.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
33612The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
33613command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
33614specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33615
33616.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33617This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33618&$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33619
33620.vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
33621The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
33622
33623.vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
33624The number of accepted recipients.
33625
33626.vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
33627.cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
33628.cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
33629The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
33630&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
33631can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
33632below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
33633adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
33634&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
33635value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
33636blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
33637and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
33638
33639.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
33640The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
33641
33642.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
33643The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
33644locally-submitted messages.
33645
33646.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
33647The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
33648was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
33649
33650.vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33651The name of the sending host, if known.
33652
33653.vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33654The port on the sending host.
33655
33656.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33657This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33658
33659.vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33660This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33661
33662.vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33663The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33664requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33665.endlist
33666
33667
33668.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33669The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33670You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33671(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33672their type to *.
33673
33674
33675.vlist
33676.vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33677A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33678
33679.vitem &*int&~type*&
33680A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33681characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33682Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33683with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33684rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33685lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33686
33687.vitem &*int&~slen*&
33688The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33689internal newlines.
33690
33691.vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33692A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33693a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33694.endlist
33695
33696
33697
33698.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33699The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33700
33701.vlist
33702.vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33703This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33704
33705.vitem &*int&~pno*&
33706This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33707the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33708and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33709
33710.vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33711If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33712recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33713envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33714router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33715an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33716&%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33717is NULL for all recipients.
33718.endlist
33719
33720
33721
33722.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33723.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33724The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33725These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33726release:
33727
33728.vlist
33729.vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33730 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33731
33732This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33733&%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33734be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33735for the process in &%newumask%&.
33736
33737Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33738and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33739standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33740descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
33741argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
33742
33743The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
33744
33745.vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
33746This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
33747seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
33748return value is as follows:
33749
33750.ilist
33751>= 0
33752
33753The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
33754ending status.
33755
33756.next
33757< 0 and > &--256
33758
33759The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
33760signal number.
33761
33762.next
33763&--256
33764
33765The process timed out.
33766.next
33767&--257
33768
33769The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
33770.endlist
33771
33772.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
33773This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
33774Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
33775want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
33776forks a subprocess that is running
33777.code
33778exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
33779.endd
33780and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
33781that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
33782of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
33783recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
33784
33785When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
33786finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
33787fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
33788addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
33789
33790
33791.vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
33792 *sender_authentication)*&
33793This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
33794that it runs is:
33795.display
33796&`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
33797.endd
33798The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
33799
33800
33801.vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33802This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
33803output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
33804calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
33805conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
33806.code
33807if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33808 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33809.endd
33810
33811.vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
33812This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
33813expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
33814The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
33815expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
33816the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
33817block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
33818&<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
33819
33820.vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
33821This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
33822existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
33823character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
33824substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
33825if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
33826
33827.vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33828 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
33829This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
33830chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
33831
33832If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
33833&%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
33834NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
33835matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
33836&%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
33837found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
33838marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
33839option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
33840top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
33841headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
33842.code
33843header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
33844 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
33845.endd
33846Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
33847there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
33848
33849
33850.vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
33851This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
33852occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
33853particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
33854match the specification, the function does nothing.
33855
33856
33857.vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33858 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
33859This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
33860a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
33861colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
33862&"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
33863.code
33864if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
33865.endd
33866.vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
33867.cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
33868This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
33869The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
33870back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
33871zero-terminated.
33872
33873.vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
33874This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
33875zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
33876to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
33877string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
33878yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
33879easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
33880added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
33881
33882.vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
33883This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
33884matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
33885.display
33886&`OK `& match succeeded
33887&`FAIL `& match failed
33888&`DEFER `& match deferred
33889.endd
33890DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
33891inability to contact a database.
33892
33893.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33894 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
33895This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
33896controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
33897&'lss_match_domain()'&.
33898
33899.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33900 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
33901This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
33902controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
33903matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33904
33905.vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
33906 uschar&~*list)*&"
33907This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
33908expected to be
33909.code
33910lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
33911.endd
33912.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
33913An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
33914is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
33915looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
33916values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
33917returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
33918failed.
33919
33920.vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
33921 *format,&~...)*&"
33922This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
33923is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
33924&`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
33925them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
33926arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
33927contain any newlines, not even at the end.
33928
33929
33930.vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
33931This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
33932is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
33933with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
33934
33935This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
33936described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
33937the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
33938value afterwards. For example:
33939.code
33940 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
33941 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
33942 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
33943.endd
33944
33945.vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
33946This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
33947recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
33948matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
33949address.
33950.endlist
33951
33952
33953.cindex "RFC 2047"
33954.vlist
33955.vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
33956 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
33957This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
33958these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
33959from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
33960a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
33961made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
33962binary string is returned with an error message.
33963
33964The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
33965maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
33966encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
33967
33968.cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
33969.cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
33970If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
33971contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
33972not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
33973
33974The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
33975&%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
33976which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
33977
33978If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
33979argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
33980set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
33981returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
33982with translation.
33983
33984
33985.vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
33986This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
33987below.
33988
33989.vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33990The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
33991output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
33992stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
33993SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
33994is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
33995opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
33996test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
33997is involved.
33998
33999If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34000output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34001
34002Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34003must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34004LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34005LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34006initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34007to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34008that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34009.code
34010smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34011return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34012.endd
34013Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34014the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34015&'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34016multiple output lines.
34017
34018The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34019does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
34020the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34021detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34022you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34023dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34024arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34025is an error.
34026
34027.vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
34028This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34029chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
34030runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34031
34032.vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
34033This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34034permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34035
34036.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34037See below.
34038
34039.vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34040See below.
34041
34042.vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34043These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34044The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34045number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34046and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34047pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34048more discussion.
34049.endlist
34050
34051
34052
34053.section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34054.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34055No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34056The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34057recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34058to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34059message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34060terminates.
34061
34062Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34063data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34064connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34065one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34066
34067If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34068in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34069.code
34070store_pool = POOL_PERM
34071.endd
34072before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34073restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34074the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34075set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34076
34077The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34078&'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34079There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34080block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34081&%store_pool%&.
34082.ecindex IIDlosca
34083
34084
34085
34086
34087. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34088. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34089
34090.chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34091.scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34092.scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34093.scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34094The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34095that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34096also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34097they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34098
34099The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34100is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34101It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34102commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34103The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34104
34105The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34106is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34107the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34108If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34109of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34110prevent it happening on retries.
34111
34112.vindex "&$domain$&"
34113.vindex "&$local_part$&"
34114&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34115specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34116&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34117you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34118independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34119described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34120
34121
34122.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34123.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34124.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34125The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34126setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34127other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34128&%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34129.code
34130system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34131system_filter_user = exim
34132.endd
34133If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34134&%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34135specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34136&%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34137&%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34138by the &%reply%& command.
34139
34140
34141.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34142You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34143filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34144are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34145
34146If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34147you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34148
34149
34150
34151.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34152The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34153files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34154mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34155available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34156If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34157they cause errors.
34158
34159.cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34160There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34161files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34162is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34163&%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34164subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34165manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34166
34167&*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34168specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34169succeed, it will not be tried again.
34170If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34171arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34172
34173When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34174&$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34175users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34176to which users' filter files can refer.
34177
34178
34179
34180.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34181.vindex "&$recipients$&"
34182The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34183of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34184filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34185
34186
34187
34188.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34189.cindex "freezing messages"
34190.cindex "message" "freezing"
34191.cindex "message" "forced failure"
34192.cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34193.cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34194.cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34195There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34196always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34197filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34198for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34199word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34200.code
34201fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34202.endd
34203The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34204
34205The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34206message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34207and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34208delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34209that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34210run.
34211
34212The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34213not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34214filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34215is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34216
34217.cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34218.cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34219The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34220well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
34221up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
34222log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
34223two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
34224strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
34225message. For example:
34226.code
34227fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
34228 because it contains attachments that we are \
34229 not prepared to receive."
34230.endd
34231
34232.cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
34233Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
34234the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
34235the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
34236command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
34237Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
34238use, for example
34239.code
34240if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
34241then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
34242.endd
34243though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
34244alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
34245generated by the filter.
34246
34247The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
34248&%defer%&,
34249&%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
34250set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
34251as
34252.code
34253mail ...
34254freeze
34255.endd
34256to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
34257failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
34258take place.
34259
34260
34261
34262.section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
34263.cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
34264.cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
34265.cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
34266Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
34267.code
34268headers add <string>
34269headers remove <string>
34270.endd
34271The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
34272added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
34273filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
34274space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
34275forced to fail, the command has no effect.
34276
34277You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
34278continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
34279including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
34280example:
34281.code
34282headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
34283 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
34284 X-header-2: ...."
34285.endd
34286Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
34287be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
34288space after input continuations is ignored.
34289
34290The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
34291This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
34292those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
34293&'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
34294header with the same name, they are all removed.
34295
34296The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
34297of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
34298from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
34299modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
34300Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
34301used for all recipients of the message.
34302
34303During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
34304header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
34305that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
34306routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
34307routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
34308until the message is actually being written (see section
34309&<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
34310
34311If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
34312added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
34313present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
34314present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
34315message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
34316conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
34317modified more than once.
34318
34319Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
34320use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
34321For example:
34322.code
34323headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
34324headers remove "Subject"
34325headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
34326headers remove "Old-Subject"
34327.endd
34328
34329
34330
34331.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
34332.cindex "envelope sender"
34333In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
34334.code
34335errors_to <some address>
34336.endd
34337in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
34338delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
34339user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
34340might use
34341.code
34342unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
34343.endd
34344to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
34345address if its delivery failed.
34346
34347
34348
34349.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
34350.vindex "&$domain$&"
34351.vindex "&$local_part$&"
34352In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
34353delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
34354operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
34355such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
34356filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
34357which implements such a filter:
34358.code
34359central_filter:
34360 check_local_user
34361 driver = redirect
34362 domains = +local_domains
34363 file = /central/filters/$local_part
34364 no_verify
34365 allow_filter
34366 allow_freeze
34367.endd
34368The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
34369&%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
34370the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
34371use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
34372
34373Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
34374specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
34375its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
34376address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
34377normal way.
34378.ecindex IIDsysfil1
34379.ecindex IIDsysfil2
34380.ecindex IIDsysfil3
34381
34382
34383
34384
34385
34386
34387. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34388. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34389
34390.chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
34391.scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
34392Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
34393all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
34394these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
34395this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
34396removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
34397before it is placed on Exim's queue.
34398
34399Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
34400&"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
34401that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
34402its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
34403set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
34404
34405&*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
34406or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
34407loopback interface specially in any way.
34408
34409If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
34410that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
34411
34412
34413
34414
34415.section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
34416.cindex "message" "submission"
34417.cindex "submission mode"
34418Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
34419&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
34420received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
34421state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
34422.code
34423control = submission
34424.endd
34425in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
34426&<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
34427a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
34428known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
34429example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
34430interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
34431.code
34432warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
34433 control = submission
34434.endd
34435.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
34436There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
34437is used to separate options. For example:
34438.code
34439control = submission/sender_retain
34440.endd
34441Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
34442true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
34443of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
34444the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
34445authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
34446&'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
34447attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
34448
34449When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
34450domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
34451example:
34452.code
34453control = submission/domain=some.domain
34454.endd
34455The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
34456&<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
34457that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
34458&'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
34459.code
34460accept authenticated = *
34461 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
34462 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
34463 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
34464.endd
34465Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
34466option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
34467the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
34468.code
34469bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
34470.endd
34471then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
34472line would be:
34473.code
34474Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
34475.endd
34476.cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
34477By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
34478used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
34479specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
34480
34481&*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
34482ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
34483untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
34484specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
34485does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
34486spoof another's address.
34487
34488.section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
34489.cindex "line endings"
34490.cindex "carriage return"
34491.cindex "linefeed"
34492RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
34493linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
34494SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
34495conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
34496use CRLF or just CR.
34497
34498Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
34499using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
34500receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
34501Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
34502MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
34503has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
34504that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
34505other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
34506follows:
34507
34508.ilist
34509LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
34510.next
34511CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
34512is ignored.
34513.next
34514The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
34515nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
34516terminator.
34517.next
34518If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
34519the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
34520is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
34521people trying to play silly games.
34522.next
34523If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
34524bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
34525line.
34526.endlist
34527
34528
34529
34530
34531
34532.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
34533.cindex "unqualified addresses"
34534.cindex "address" "qualification"
34535By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
34536host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
34537SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
34538messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
34539requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
34540
34541Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
34542sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
34543&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
34544cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
34545value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
34546
34547.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
34548.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
34549Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
34550that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
34551line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
34552are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
34553other words, such qualification is also controlled by
34554&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
34555
34556
34557
34558
34559.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
34560.cindex "&""From""& line"
34561.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
34562.cindex "sender" "address"
34563.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
34564.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
34565.cindex "envelope sender"
34566.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34567Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
34568with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
34569&"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
34570.code
34571From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
34572From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34573.endd
34574This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34575Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34576via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34577such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34578&%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34579and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34580regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34581default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34582that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34583
34584.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
34585When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
34586a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
34587contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
34588then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
34589qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
34590the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
34591
34592If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
34593sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
34594that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
34595
34596Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
34597treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
34598as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
34599incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
34600
34601
34602
34603.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
34604.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
34605.cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
34606RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
34607&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
34608recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
34609&'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
34610&'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
34611
34612.blockquote
34613&'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
34614processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
34615.endblockquote
34616
34617This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
34618address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
34619follows:
34620
34621.ilist
34622A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
34623is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
34624.next
34625If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
34626&%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
34627&'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
34628.next
34629For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
34630also removed.
34631.next
34632For a locally-submitted message,
34633if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
34634&'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
34635the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
34636included in log lines in this case.
34637.next
34638The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
34639&%Resent-%& header lines are present.
34640.endlist
34641
34642
34643
34644
34645.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
34646Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
34647includes the header line:
34648.code
34649Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
34650.endd
34651
34652.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34653.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
34654If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
34655message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34656extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34657existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34658
34659
34660.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34661.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34662.cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34663If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34664Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34665&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34666
34667.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34668.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34669.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34670&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34671set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34672the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34673in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34674set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34675messages.
34676
34677
34678.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34679.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34680.cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34681.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34682&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34683Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34684generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34685messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34686(the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34687messages.
34688
34689
34690.section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34691.cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34692.cindex "header lines" "From:"
34693.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34694.cindex "message" "submission"
34695.cindex "submission mode"
34696If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34697adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34698
34699.ilist
34700The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34701message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34702.next
34703.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34704The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34705.olist
34706.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34707If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34708&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34709.next
34710If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34711part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34712.next
34713If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34714&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34715.endlist
34716.endlist
34717
34718A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34719
34720If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34721line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34722containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34723are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34724They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34725&%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34726&%qualify_domain%&.
34727
34728For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34729&'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34730user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34731name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34732
34733
34734.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34735.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34736.cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34737.cindex "message" "submission"
34738.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
34739If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
34740&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
34741&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
34742to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
34743creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
34744message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
34745followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
34746in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
34747&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
34748
34749
34750.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
34751.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
34752.cindex "header lines" "Received:"
34753A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
34754contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
34755Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
34756
34757The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
34758have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
34759line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
34760that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
34761
34762Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
34763changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
34764-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
34765
34766
34767.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
34768.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
34769.cindex "header lines" "References:"
34770Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
34771header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
34772section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
34773header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
34774responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
34775processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
34776than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
34777incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
3477811 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
34779
34780
34781
34782.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
34783.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
34784.cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
34785.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
34786&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
34787it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
34788transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
34789transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
34790default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
34791
34792
34793
34794.section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
34795.cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
34796.cindex "message" "submission"
34797.cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
34798For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
34799existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
34800these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
34801&%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34802control setting.
34803
34804When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
34805&%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34806control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
34807&'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
34808that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
34809&%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
34810be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
34811appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
34812line is added to the message.
34813
34814If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
34815the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
34816&%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
34817options true at the same time.
34818
34819.cindex "submission mode"
34820By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
34821received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
34822a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
34823not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
34824
34825.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34826First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
34827authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
34828created as follows:
34829
34830.ilist
34831.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34832If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34833&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34834.next
34835If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
34836is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34837.next
34838If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34839&$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34840.endlist
34841
34842This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
34843are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
34844added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
34845by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
34846
34847.cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
34848&*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
34849the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
34850except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
34851
34852
34853
34854.section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
34855 "SECTheadersaddrem"
34856.cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
34857.cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
34858When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
34859specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
34860process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
34861modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
34862as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
34863
34864In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
34865specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
34866addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
34867changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
34868transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
34869they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
34870
34871&*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
34872the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
34873expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
34874
34875For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
34876option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
34877newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
34878.code
34879headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
34880 X-added-second: another added header line
34881.endd
34882Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
34883
34884Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
34885specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
34886Each header-line is separately expanded.
34887
34888The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
34889list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
34890often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
34891not part of the names. For example:
34892.code
34893headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
34894.endd
34895
34896Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
34897specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
34898Each item is separately expanded.
34899Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
34900form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
34901will act as list separators.
34902
34903When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
34904items are expanded at routing time,
34905and then associated with all addresses that are
34906accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
34907an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
34908forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
34909
34910.oindex "&%unseen%&"
34911However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
34912the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
34913&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
34914
34915Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
34916settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
34917dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
34918requirements.
34919
34920The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
34921with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
34922these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
34923recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
34924consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
34925names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
34926instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
34927
34928After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
34929lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
34930the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
34931header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
34932
34933This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
34934the following consequences:
34935
34936.ilist
34937The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
34938remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
34939to it, at all times.
34940.next
34941Header lines that are added by a router's
34942&%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
34943expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
34944.next
34945Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
34946in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
34947.next
34948Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
34949a later router or by a transport.
34950.next
34951An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
34952removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
34953.code
34954headers_remove = subject
34955headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
34956.endd
34957.endlist
34958
34959&*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
34960for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
34961
34962
34963
34964
34965
34966.section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
34967.cindex "address" "constructed"
34968.cindex "constructed address"
34969When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
34970the form
34971.display
34972<&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
34973.endd
34974For example:
34975.code
34976Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
34977.endd
34978The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
34979otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
34980&"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
34981ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
34982upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
34983&%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
34984The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
34985there is no password file entry.
34986
34987.cindex "RFC 2047"
34988In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
34989parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
34990characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
34991including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
34992&%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
34993characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
34994&%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
34995is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
34996
34997
34998
34999.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35000.cindex "case of local parts"
35001.cindex "local part" "case of"
35002RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35003be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35004addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35005because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35006routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35007original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35008router option.
35009
35010.cindex "mixed-case login names"
35011If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35012assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35013your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35014correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35015.code
35016correct_case:
35017 driver = redirect
35018 domains = +local_domains
35019 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35020 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35021 @$domain
35022.endd
35023For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35024(&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35025up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35026on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35027local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35028
35029
35030
35031.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35032.cindex "dot" "in local part"
35033.cindex "local part" "dots in"
35034RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35035part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35036middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35037empty components for compatibility.
35038
35039
35040
35041.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35042.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35043Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35044happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35045in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35046&'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35047
35048Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35049in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35050routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35051example, a header such as
35052.code
35053To: hare@teaparty
35054.endd
35055might get rewritten as
35056.code
35057To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35058.endd
35059Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35060does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35061been routed.
35062
35063Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35064addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35065result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35066deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35067immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35068routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35069.ecindex IIDmesproc
35070
35071
35072
35073. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35074. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35075
35076.chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35077.scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35078.scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35079Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35080LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35081closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35082processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35083
35084.ilist
35085SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35086.next
35087SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35088.next
35089Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35090.endlist
35091
35092For mail delivery, the following are available:
35093
35094.ilist
35095SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35096.next
35097LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35098&"lmtp"&);
35099.next
35100LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35101transport);
35102.next
35103Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35104the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35105.endlist
35106
35107&'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35108stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35109used to contain the envelope information.
35110
35111
35112
35113.section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35114.cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35115.cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35116.cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35117.cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35118.cindex "EHLO"
35119.cindex "HELO"
35120.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35121Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35122The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35123processing is the same in both cases.
35124
35125If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35126parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35127command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35128&%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35129such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35130.cindex "transport" "filter"
35131.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35132transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35133suppressed.
35134
35135If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35136pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35137required for the transaction.
35138
35139If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35140was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35141server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35142Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35143is called for verification.
35144
35145If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35146the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35147in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35148
35149.cindex "carriage return"
35150.cindex "linefeed"
35151Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35152LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35153order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35154line terminator.
35155
35156If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35157characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35158same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35159even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35160of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35161they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35162each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35163in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35164significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35165
35166When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35167message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35168records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35169particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35170
35171.cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35172Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35173a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35174See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35175
35176.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35177.cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35178When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35179looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35180messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35181creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35182a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35183so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35184does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35185turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35186
35187The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35188limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35189
35190.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35191The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35192identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35193square bracket of the IP address.
35194
35195
35196
35197
35198.section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35199.cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35200.cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35201.cindex "host" "error"
35202Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35203message errors, and recipient errors.
35204
35205.vlist
35206.vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35207A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35208particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35209
35210.ilist
35211Connection refused or timed out,
35212.next
35213Any error response code on connection,
35214.next
35215Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35216.next
35217Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35218.next
35219I/O errors at any time,
35220.next
35221Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
35222the &"."& at the end of the data.
35223.endlist ilist
35224
35225For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
35226EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
35227error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
35228host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
35229the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
35230alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
35231host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
35232made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
35233
35234.vitem "&*Message errors*&"
35235.cindex "message" "error"
35236A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
35237particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
35238message errors are:
35239
35240.ilist
35241Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
35242the data,
35243.next
35244Timeout after MAIL,
35245.next
35246Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
35247timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
35248connection at any other time.
35249.endlist ilist
35250
35251For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
35252to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
35253temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
35254addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
35255a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
35256message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
35257that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
35258time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
35259affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
35260it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
35261
35262If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
35263to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
35264over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
35265response to MAIL.
35266
35267.vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
35268.cindex "recipient" "error"
35269A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
35270recipient errors are:
35271
35272.ilist
35273Any error response to RCPT,
35274.next
35275Timeout after RCPT.
35276.endlist
35277
35278For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
35279recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
35280sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
35281address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
35282used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
35283routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
35284operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
35285to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
35286if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
35287(&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
35288have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
35289the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
35290the retry clock is reset.
35291
35292The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
35293host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
35294other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
35295in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
35296proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
35297than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
35298if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
35299through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
35300recipient's retry time.
35301.endlist
35302
35303In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
35304current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
35305tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
35306own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
35307until the next delivery attempt.
35308
35309Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
35310MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
35311would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
35312host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
35313What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
35314is created.
35315
35316The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
35317these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
35318procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
35319response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
35320it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
35321message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
35322helpful to treat this case as a message error.
35323
35324Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
35325host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
35326or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
35327the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
35328then to be treated as a host error.
35329
35330There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
35331terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
35332reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
35333should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
35334host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
35335
35336
35337
35338
35339.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
35340.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
35341.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
35342.cindex "inetd"
35343.cindex "daemon"
35344Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
35345listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
35346&_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
35347.code
35348smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
35349.endd
35350Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
35351agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
35352a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
35353the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
35354with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
35355stream and exits with an error code.
35356
35357By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
35358disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
35359unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
35360&%smtp_connection%& log selector.
35361
35362.cindex "carriage return"
35363.cindex "linefeed"
35364Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35365LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
35366order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35367line terminator.
35368Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
35369sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
35370sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
35371
35372.cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
35373.cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
35374One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
35375HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
35376commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
35377the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
35378Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
35379match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
35380
35381.cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35382.cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
35383The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
35384a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
35385&%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
35386false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
35387&%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
35388value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
35389message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
35390
35391When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
35392its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
35393logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
35394
35395The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
35396prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
35397number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
35398&%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
35399rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
35400
35401The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
35402subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
35403for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
35404things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
35405processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
35406sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
35407it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
35408
35409When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
35410and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
35411high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
35412&%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
35413applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
35414
35415Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
35416can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
35417&%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
35418number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
35419SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
35420&%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
35421subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
35422a delivery process.
35423
35424The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
35425&%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
35426started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
35427handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
35428however, available with &'inetd'&.
35429
35430Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
35431are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
35432to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
35433section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
35434
35435Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
35436MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
35437&%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
35438
35439
35440
35441.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
35442.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
35443If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
35444commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
35445the error response to the last command. The default value for
35446&%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
35447abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
35448circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
35449
35450
35451.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
35452.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
35453.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
35454A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
35455something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
35456address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
35457sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
35458&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
35459drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
35460default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
35461broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
35462
35463
35464
35465.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
35466.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
35467The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
35468DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
35469many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
35470denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
35471client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
35472defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
35473
35474When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
35475allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
35476but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
35477or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
35478starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
35479counted.
35480
35481The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
35482STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
35483RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
35484
35485You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
35486&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
35487&%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
35488the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
35489specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
35490
35491
35492
35493
35494.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
35495When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
35496runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
35497appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
35498
35499.cindex "VRFY" "processing"
35500When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
35501setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
35502(with a 252 SMTP response code)
35503in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
35504When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
35505called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
35506SMTP response codes.
35507
35508.cindex "EXPN" "processing"
35509If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
35510When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
35511EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
35512than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
35513as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
35514of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
35515VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
35516RCPT failures.
35517
35518
35519
35520.section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
35521.cindex "ETRN" "processing"
35522RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
35523overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
35524disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
35525the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
35526should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
35527
35528The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
35529delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
35530the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
35531text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
35532specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
35533the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
35534argument. For example,
35535.code
35536ETRN #brigadoon
35537.endd
35538runs the command
35539.code
35540exim -R brigadoon
35541.endd
35542which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
35543containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
35544default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
35545for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
35546a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
35547
35548.cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
35549Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
35550record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
35551the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
35552the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
35553a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
35554left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
35555Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
35556
35557.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
35558For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
35559used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
35560whatever the form of its argument. For
35561example:
35562.code
35563smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
35564 $sender_host_address
35565.endd
35566.vindex "&$domain$&"
35567The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
35568expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
35569and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
35570wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
35571under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
35572for it to change them before running the command.
35573
35574
35575
35576.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35577.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35578Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35579standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35580line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35581&%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35582messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35583sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35584an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
35585identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
35586runs for RCPT commands:
35587.code
35588accept hosts = :
35589.endd
35590This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
35591
35592
35593
35594.section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
35595.cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
35596.cindex "batched SMTP output"
35597Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
35598batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
35599be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
35600delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
35601envelope along with the message.
35602
35603The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
35604MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
35605the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
35606HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
35607can be used to specify it.
35608
35609Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
35610one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
35611to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
35612this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
35613chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
35614
35615.vindex "&$host$&"
35616When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
35617sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
35618transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
35619router:
35620.code
35621begin routers
35622route_append:
35623 driver = manualroute
35624 transport = smtp_appendfile
35625 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
35626
35627begin transports
35628smtp_appendfile:
35629 driver = appendfile
35630 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
35631 batch_max = 1000
35632 use_bsmtp
35633 user = exim
35634.endd
35635This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
35636format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
35637message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
35638
35639
35640
35641.section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
35642.cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
35643.cindex "batched SMTP input"
35644The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
35645reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
35646is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
35647sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
35648rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
35649and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
35650as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35651
35652Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35653ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
35654
35655If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35656the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35657standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35658make some use of automatically, for example:
35659.code
35660554 Unexpected end of file
35661Transaction started in line 10
35662Error detected in line 14
35663.endd
35664It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35665file, for example:
35666.code
35667An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35668The error message was:
35669
35670501 '>' missing at end of address
35671
35672The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35673The error was detected in line 12.
35674The SMTP command at fault was:
35675
35676rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35677
356781 previous message was successfully processed.
35679The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35680.endd
35681The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35682messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35683accepted.
35684.ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35685.ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35686
35687
35688
35689. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35690. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35691
35692.chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35693 "Customizing messages"
35694When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
35695configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35696to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35697the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35698string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35699
35700The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35701cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35702option. Exim also adds the line
35703.code
35704Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35705.endd
35706to all warning and bounce messages,
35707
35708
35709.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35710.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35711.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35712If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35713message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35714delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35715&%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35716
35717When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35718constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35719separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35720opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35721logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35722item.
35723
35724.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35725.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35726Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35727expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35728the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35729&$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35730option, rounded to a whole number.
35731
35732The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35733
35734.ilist
35735The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35736&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35737.next
35738The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
35739failing addresses with their error messages.
35740.next
35741The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
35742returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
35743.next
35744The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
35745The fields exist for back-compatibility
35746.endlist
35747
35748The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
35749following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
35750other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
35751.code
35752Subject: Mail delivery failed
35753 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35754 {: returning message to sender}}
35755****
35756This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35757
35758A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35759 {that you sent }{sent by
35760
35761<$sender_address>
35762
35763}}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
35764This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
35765****
35766The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
35767****
35768------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
35769 ------
35770****
35771------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
35772 only the first
35773------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
35774****
35775.endd
35776.section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
35777.cindex "customizing" "warning message"
35778.cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
35779The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
35780warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
35781text sections:
35782
35783.ilist
35784The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35785&'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35786.next
35787The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
35788the delayed addresses.
35789.next
35790The third item then ends the message.
35791.endlist
35792
35793The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
35794have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
35795.code
35796Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
35797 $warn_message_delay
35798****
35799This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35800
35801A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
35802{that you sent }{sent by
35803
35804<$sender_address>
35805
35806}}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
35807more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
35808
35809The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
35810The subject of the message is: $h_subject
35811The date of the message is: $h_date
35812
35813The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
35814****
35815No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
35816continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
35817intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
35818mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
35819the message will be returned to you.
35820.endd
35821.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
35822.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
35823However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
35824appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
35825&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
35826minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
35827of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
35828multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
35829handled them.
35830
35831
35832
35833
35834. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35835. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35836
35837.chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
35838This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
35839common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
35840
35841
35842
35843.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
35844.cindex "smart host" "example router"
35845If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
35846should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
35847routing explicitly:
35848.code
35849send_to_smart_host:
35850 driver = manualroute
35851 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
35852 transport = remote_smtp
35853.endd
35854You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
35855If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
35856receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
35857synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
35858&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
35859
35860
35861
35862
35863.section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
35864.cindex "mailing lists"
35865Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
35866requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
35867Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
35868
35869The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
35870is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
35871independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
35872lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
35873.code
35874lists:
35875 driver = redirect
35876 domains = lists.example
35877 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35878 forbid_pipe
35879 forbid_file
35880 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35881 no_more
35882.endd
35883This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
35884in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
35885such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
35886routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
35887
35888The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
35889expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
35890a mailing list.
35891
35892.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
35893The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
35894taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
35895original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
35896the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
35897
35898For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
35899&'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
35900&_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
35901&'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
35902There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
35903the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
35904such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
35905or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
35906&%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
35907
35908
35909
35910.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
35911.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
35912If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
35913delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
35914list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
35915list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
35916addresses are not rigorously checked.
35917
35918If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
35919entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
35920&%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
35921whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
35922&%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
35923
35924
35925
35926.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
35927.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
35928Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
35929in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
35930recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
35931cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
35932delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
35933account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
35934the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
35935message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
35936
35937If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
35938on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
35939router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
35940&"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
35941&"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
35942subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
35943failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
35944pre-existing messages.
35945
35946The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
35947addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
35948addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
35949&%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
35950one level of expansion anyway.
35951
35952
35953
35954.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
35955.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
35956The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
35957send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
35958from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
35959&%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
35960
35961The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
35962of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
35963.code
35964lists_request:
35965 driver = redirect
35966 domains = lists.example
35967 local_part_suffix = -request
35968 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
35969 no_more
35970
35971lists_post:
35972 driver = redirect
35973 domains = lists.example
35974 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
35975 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
35976 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35977 forbid_pipe
35978 forbid_file
35979 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35980 no_more
35981
35982lists_closed:
35983 driver = redirect
35984 domains = lists.example
35985 allow_fail
35986 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
35987.endd
35988All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
35989they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
35990&%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
35991mailing list.
35992
35993The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
35994checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
35995checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
35996necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
35997because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
35998not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
35999means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36000&%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36001&"unrouteable address"& error.
36002
36003The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36004a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36005the address, giving a suitable error message.
36006
36007
36008
36009
36010.section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36011.cindex "VERP"
36012.cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36013.cindex "envelope sender"
36014Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36015are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36016address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36017the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36018if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36019original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36020
36021.oindex &%errors_to%&
36022.oindex &%return_path%&
36023Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36024facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36025list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36026these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36027host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36028of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36029of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36030.code
36031verp_smtp:
36032 driver = smtp
36033 max_rcpt = 1
36034 return_path = \
36035 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36036 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36037.endd
36038This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36039SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36040&"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36041local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36042example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36043&'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36044&'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36045rewritten as
36046.code
36047somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36048.endd
36049.vindex "&$local_part$&"
36050For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36051have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36052achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36053might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36054&$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36055
36056Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36057probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36058extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36059can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36060.code
36061dnslookup:
36062 driver = dnslookup
36063 domains = ! +local_domains
36064 transport = \
36065 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36066 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36067 no_more
36068.endd
36069If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36070of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36071routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36072errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36073address.
36074
36075On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36076&(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36077SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36078and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36079of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36080.code
36081verp_dnslookup:
36082 driver = dnslookup
36083 domains = ! +local_domains
36084 transport = remote_smtp
36085 errors_to = \
36086 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36087 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36088 no_more
36089.endd
36090Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36091configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36092Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36093router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36094them.
36095
36096The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36097message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36098host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36099a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36100a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36101than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36102used).
36103
36104
36105
36106
36107
36108
36109.section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36110.cindex "virtual domains"
36111.cindex "domain" "virtual"
36112The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36113meanings:
36114
36115.ilist
36116A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36117aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36118top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36119.next
36120One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36121with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36122have login accounts on that host.
36123.endlist
36124
36125The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36126the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36127aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36128virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36129whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36130to a router of this form:
36131.code
36132virtual:
36133 driver = redirect
36134 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36135 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
36136 no_more
36137.endd
36138The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36139is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36140domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
36141part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36142setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36143string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36144
36145This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36146follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36147can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36148a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36149
36150The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36151way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36152valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36153.code
36154my_domains:
36155 driver = accept
36156 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36157 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36158 transport = my_mailboxes
36159.endd
36160The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36161can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36162file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36163option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36164because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36165follows:
36166.code
36167my_mailboxes:
36168 driver = appendfile
36169 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
36170 user = mail
36171.endd
36172This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36173required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36174
36175The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36176requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36177up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36178information about the domains.
36179
36180
36181
36182.section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36183.cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36184.cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36185.cindex "local part" "prefix"
36186.cindex "local part" "suffix"
36187Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36188incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36189allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36190identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36191parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36192&%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36193example, consider this router:
36194.code
36195userforward:
36196 driver = redirect
36197 check_local_user
36198 file = $home/.forward
36199 local_part_suffix = -*
36200 local_part_suffix_optional
36201 allow_filter
36202.endd
36203.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36204It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36205&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36206cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36207.code
36208if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36209save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36210endif
36211.endd
36212If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
36213fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
36214&%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
36215control over which suffixes are valid.
36216
36217Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
36218&_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
36219another MTA:
36220.code
36221userforward:
36222 driver = redirect
36223 check_local_user
36224 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
36225 local_part_suffix = -*
36226 local_part_suffix_optional
36227 allow_filter
36228.endd
36229If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
36230example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
36231does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
36232subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
36233&_.forward_& file to use as a default.
36234
36235
36236
36237.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
36238.cindex "vacation processing"
36239The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
36240a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
36241(see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
36242This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
36243that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
36244
36245.ilist
36246A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
36247can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
36248alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
36249&_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
36250.code
36251spqr, vacation-spqr
36252.endd
36253.next
36254The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
36255vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
36256user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
36257ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
36258to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
36259message.
36260.endlist
36261
36262Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
36263use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
36264
36265
36266
36267.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
36268.cindex "message" "copying every"
36269Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
36270be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
36271command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
36272each day's messages.
36273
36274There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
36275messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
36276delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
36277notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
36278
36279
36280
36281.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
36282.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
36283It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
36284Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
36285arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
36286permanently connected.
36287
36288Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
36289particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
36290Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
36291
36292
36293.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
36294It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
36295host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
36296approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
36297being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
36298some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
36299to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
36300resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
36301
36302A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
36303intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
36304into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
36305format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
36306destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
36307in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
36308if required.
36309
36310On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
36311you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
36312intermittent host. For example:
36313.code
36314cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
36315.endd
36316This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
36317which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
36318online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
36319options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
36320causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
36321connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
36322immediately.
36323
36324If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
36325issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
36326mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
36327used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
36328avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
36329Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
36330arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
36331
36332
36333
36334.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
36335The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
36336increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
36337connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
36338delivered immediately.
36339
36340.cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36341.cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
36342.cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
36343Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
36344not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
36345possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
36346each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
36347avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
36348&%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
36349first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
36350normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
36351destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
36352single SMTP connection.
36353
36354
36355
36356. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36357. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36358
36359.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
36360 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
36361.cindex "client, non-queueing"
36362.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
36363On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
36364email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
36365configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
36366However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
36367configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
36368&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
36369messages this way.
36370
36371If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
36372run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
36373any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
36374continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
36375email is not desirable.
36376
36377There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
36378&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
36379any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
36380host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
36381informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
36382to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
36383to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
36384
36385There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
36386that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
36387ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
36388before sending a message to the smart host.
36389
36390Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
36391tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
36392overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
36393
36394.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
36395There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
36396Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
36397assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
36398just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
36399compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
36400router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
36401
36402When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
36403following ways:
36404
36405.ilist
36406A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
36407In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
36408.next
36409Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
36410assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
36411&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
36412does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
36413successful, a zero return code is given.
36414.next
36415Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
36416be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
36417the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
36418must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
36419deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
36420are.
36421.next
36422If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
36423failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
36424successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
36425.next
36426Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
36427is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
36428smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
36429the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
36430there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
36431.next
36432If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
36433connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
36434failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
36435.next
36436When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
36437(as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
36438value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
36439are ever generated.
36440.next
36441No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
36442.next
36443A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
36444true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
36445&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
36446.endlist
36447
36448The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
36449the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
36450deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
36451privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
36452to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
36453the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
36454
36455
36456
36457
36458. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36459. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36460
36461.chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
36462.scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
36463.cindex "log" "types of"
36464Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
36465and the panic log:
36466
36467.ilist
36468.cindex "main log"
36469The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
36470line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
36471down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
36472out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
36473them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
36474they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
36475analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
36476&<<SECTmailstat>>&).
36477.next
36478.cindex "reject log"
36479The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
36480of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
36481The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
36482the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
36483is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
36484lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
36485reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
36486host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
36487can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
36488false.
36489.next
36490.cindex "panic log"
36491.cindex "system log"
36492When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
36493error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
36494are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
36495other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
36496therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
36497regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
36498panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
36499is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
36500message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
36501.endlist
36502
36503Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
36504example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
36505In the log file, this would be all on one line:
36506.code
365072001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
36508 by QUIT
36509.endd
36510By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
36511ways of changing this:
36512
36513.ilist
36514You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
36515you set
36516.code
36517timezone = UTC
36518.endd
36519the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
36520.next
36521If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
36522example:
36523.code
365242003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
36525.endd
36526.endlist
36527
36528.cindex "log" "process ids in"
36529.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36530Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
36531request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
36532&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
36533brackets, immediately after the time and date.
36534
36535
36536
36537
36538.section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
36539.cindex "log" "destination"
36540.cindex "log" "to file"
36541.cindex "log" "to syslog"
36542.cindex "syslog"
36543The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
36544should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
36545are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
36546arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
36547It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
36548need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
36549Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
36550
36551The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
36552&_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
36553configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
36554references to the host name:
36555.code
36556log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
36557.endd
36558It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
36559rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
36560start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
36561before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
36562configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
36563log at all.
36564
36565The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
36566list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
36567facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
36568colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
36569otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
36570point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
36571implying the use of a default path.
36572
36573When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36574LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36575&"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36576mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36577files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36578equivalent to the setting:
36579.code
36580log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36581.endd
36582If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
36583or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
36584that is where the logs are written.
36585
36586A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
36587are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
36588
36589Here are some examples of possible settings:
36590.display
36591&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
36592&`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
36593&`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
36594&`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
36595.endd
36596If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
36597error is logged.
36598
36599
36600
36601.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
36602.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36603.cindex "cycling logs"
36604.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36605.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
36606Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
36607log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
36608provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
36609main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
36610keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
36611
36612An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
36613and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
36614example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
36615message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
36616that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
36617something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
36618ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
36619&[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
36620does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
36621tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
36622for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
36623renamed.
36624
36625
36626
36627.section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
36628.cindex "log" "datestamped files"
36629Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
36630periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
36631for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
36632&_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
36633the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
36634point where the datestamp is required. For example:
36635.code
36636log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
36637log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
36638log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
36639log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
36640.endd
36641As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
36642examples of names generated by the above examples:
36643.code
36644/var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
36645/var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
36646/var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
36647/var/log/exim/main.200212
36648.endd
36649When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
36650files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36651will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36652run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
36653
36654The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
36655is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36656When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36657the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36658non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36659character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36660log names:
36661.code
36662/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36663/var/log/exim-panic.log
36664/var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36665/var/log/exim/panic
36666.endd
36667
36668
36669.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36670.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36671The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36672except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36673Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36674that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36675&"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36676by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36677&%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36678SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36679&_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36680LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36681the time and host name to each line.
36682The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36683
36684.ilist
36685&'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36686.next
36687&'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36688.next
36689&'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36690.endlist
36691
36692Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36693written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36694these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36695by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36696
36697Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36698entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36699these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36700calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36701870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36702additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36703replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36704RFC 3164, you should set
36705.code
36706SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36707.endd
36708in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36709lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36710
36711To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36712entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36713where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36714components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36715because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36716delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36717870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36718&'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36719name, and pid as added by syslog:
36720.code
36721[1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36722[2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36723[3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36724[4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36725[5/5] mple>)
36726.endd
36727The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36728(LOG_NOTICE):
36729.code
36730[1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36731[2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36732[3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36733[4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36734[5\18] .example>)
36735[6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36736[7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36737[8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
36738[9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
36739[10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
36740[11\18] 09:43 +0100
36741[12\18] F From: <>
36742[13\18] Subject: this is a test header
36743[18\18] X-something: this is another header
36744[15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
36745[16\18] le>
36746[17\18] B Bcc:
36747[18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
36748.endd
36749Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
36750without modification.
36751
36752If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
36753display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
36754the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
36755where it is.
36756
36757
36758
36759.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
36760One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
36761successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
36762picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
36763timestamp. The flags are:
36764.display
36765&`<=`& message arrival
36766&`(=`& message fakereject
36767&`=>`& normal message delivery
36768&`->`& additional address in same delivery
36769&`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
36770&`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
36771&`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
36772&`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
36773.endd
36774
36775
36776.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
36777.cindex "log" "reception line"
36778The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36779message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
36780several lines in order to fit it on the page:
36781.code
367822002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
36783 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
36784 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
36785.endd
36786The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
36787bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
36788generated, this is followed by an item of the form
36789.code
36790R=<message id>
36791.endd
36792which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
36793
36794.cindex "HELO"
36795.cindex "EHLO"
36796For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
36797record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
36798received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
36799host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
36800above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
36801&%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
36802by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
36803verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
36804EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
36805name in parentheses.
36806
36807Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
36808without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
36809the log containing text like these examples:
36810.code
36811H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
36812H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
36813.endd
36814This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
36815on.
36816
36817For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
36818the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
36819of Exim.
36820
36821.cindex "authentication" "logging"
36822.cindex "AUTH" "logging"
36823For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
36824message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
36825of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
36826extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
36827session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
36828suite that was used.
36829
36830.cindex log protocol
36831The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
36832hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
36833value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
36834there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
36835was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
36836&%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
36837authenticator name.
36838
36839.cindex "size" "of message"
36840The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
36841received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
36842headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
36843message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
36844other).
36845
36846The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36847data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36848
36849
36850
36851.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
36852.cindex "log" "delivery line"
36853The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36854delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
36855deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
36856to fit it on the page:
36857.code
368582002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
36859 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
368602002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
36861 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
36862 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
36863.endd
36864For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
36865after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
36866intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
36867last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
36868fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
36869
36870If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
36871followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
36872If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
36873option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
36874
36875If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
36876for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
36877.display
36878&`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
36879.endd
36880If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
36881parentheses afterwards.
36882
36883.cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36884When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
36885SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
36886flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
36887down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
36888lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36889When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
36890DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
36891will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36892TLS cipher information is still available.
36893
36894.cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
36895.cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
36896When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
36897line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
36898rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
36899
36900The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
36901&"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
36902
36903The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36904data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36905
36906
36907.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
36908.cindex "discarded messages"
36909.cindex "message" "discarded"
36910.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
36911When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
36912obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
36913.code
369142002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
36915 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
36916.endd
36917is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
36918because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
36919.code
369201999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
36921 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
36922.endd
36923
36924
36925.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
36926When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
36927.code
369282002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
36929 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
36930.endd
36931In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
36932last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
36933written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
36934.code
369352002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
36936 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
36937.endd
36938When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
36939a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
36940appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
36941
36942
36943
36944.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
36945.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
36946If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
36947following form is logged:
36948.code
369491995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
36950 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
36951.endd
36952If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
36953the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
36954.code
369552002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
36956 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
36957 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
36958 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
36959 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
36960.endd
36961The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
36962used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
36963disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
36964flagged with &`**`&.
36965
36966
36967
36968.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
36969.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
36970If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
36971used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
36972&"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
36973
36974
36975
36976.section "Completion" "SECID257"
36977A line of the form
36978.code
369792002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
36980.endd
36981is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
36982at the end of its processing.
36983
36984
36985
36986
36987.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
36988.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
36989A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
36990the following table:
36991.display
36992&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
36993&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
36994&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36995&`CV `& certificate verification status
36996&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
36997&`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
36998&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
36999&`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37000&`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
37001&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37002&`H `& host name and IP address
37003&`I `& local interface used
37004&`id `& message id for incoming message
37005&`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37006&`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37007&`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37008&`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37009&` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37010&`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37011&`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37012&`Q `& alternate queue name
37013&`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37014&` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37015&`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37016&` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37017&`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37018&`S `& size of message in bytes
37019&`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37020&`ST `& shadow transport name
37021&`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37022&`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37023&` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37024&`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37025&`X `& TLS cipher suite
37026.endd
37027
37028
37029.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37030Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37031self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37032
37033.ilist
37034.cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37035&'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37036during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37037This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37038during the first delivery attempt.
37039.next
37040&'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37041temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37042for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37043.next
37044.cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37045&'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37046some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37047common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37048&'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37049doing.
37050.next
37051.cindex "error" "ignored"
37052&'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37053message:
37054.olist
37055Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37056&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37057.next
37058A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37059failed. The delivery was discarded.
37060.next
37061A delivery set up by a router configured with
37062. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37063. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37064.code
37065 errors_to = <>
37066.endd
37067failed. The delivery was discarded.
37068.endlist olist
37069.next
37070.cindex DKIM "log line"
37071&'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37072logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37073.endlist ilist
37074
37075
37076
37077
37078
37079.section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37080.cindex "log" "selectors"
37081By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37082default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37083&%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37084example:
37085.code
37086log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37087.endd
37088The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37089selection marked by asterisks:
37090.display
37091&` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37092&`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37093&` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37094&` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37095&` arguments `& command line arguments
37096&`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37097&`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37098&` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
37099&` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37100&`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37101&` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37102&`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37103&` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37104&`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37105&`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37106&` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37107&` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37108&` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37109&`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37110&` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37111&` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37112&` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37113&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37114&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37115&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37116&` pid `& Exim process id
37117&` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37118&` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37119&` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37120&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37121&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37122&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37123&`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37124&` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37125&` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37126&`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37127&`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37128&`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37129&`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37130&` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37131&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37132&` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37133&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37134&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37135&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37136&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37137&`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37138&`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37139&` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37140&` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37141&` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37142
37143&` all `& all of the above
37144.endd
37145See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37146section &<<SECID99>>&
37147
37148More details on each of these items follows:
37149
37150.ilist
37151.cindex "8BITMIME"
37152.cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37153&%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37154which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37155that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37156&`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37157&`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37158.next
37159.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37160&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37161its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37162this log selector is set.
37163.next
37164.cindex "log" "rewriting"
37165.cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37166&%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37167rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37168such users cannot access the log).
37169.next
37170.cindex "log" "full parentage"
37171&%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37172delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37173parentheses between them.
37174.next
37175.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37176.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37177&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37178to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37179feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37180&_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37181privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37182that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37183are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37184because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37185only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37186between the caller and Exim.
37187.next
37188.cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37189&%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37190connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37191.next
37192.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37193.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37194&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37195started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37196messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37197process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37198.next
37199.cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37200&%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37201perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37202If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37203precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37204.next
37205.cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37206.cindex "size" "of message"
37207&%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
37208the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
37209.next
37210.cindex log "DKIM verification"
37211.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37212&%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
37213verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
37214.next
37215.cindex log "DKIM verification"
37216.cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37217&%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
37218.next
37219.cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
37220.cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
37221.cindex "black list (DNS)"
37222&%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
37223DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
37224.next
37225.cindex log dnssec
37226.cindex dnssec logging
37227&%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
37228dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
37229For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
37230It does not cover helo-name verification.
37231For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
37232.next
37233.cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
37234.cindex "ETRN" "logging"
37235&%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
37236is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
37237command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
37238selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
37239.next
37240.cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
37241&%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
37242any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
37243log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
37244routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
37245.next
37246.cindex "log" "ident timeout"
37247.cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
37248&%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
37249client's ident port times out.
37250.next
37251.cindex "log" "incoming interface"
37252.cindex "log" "local interface"
37253.cindex "log" "local address and port"
37254.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37255.cindex "interface" "logging"
37256&%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
37257to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
37258followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
37259added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
37260rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
37261The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37262.next
37263.cindex log "incoming proxy address"
37264.cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
37265.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
37266&%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
37267of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
37268on a proxied connection
37269or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
37270See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
37271.next
37272.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
37273.cindex "port" "logging remote"
37274.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
37275.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
37276.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
37277&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
37278added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
37279in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
37280changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
37281&$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
37282important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
37283.next
37284.cindex "log" "dropped connection"
37285&%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
37286connection is unexpectedly dropped.
37287.next
37288.cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
37289.cindex millisecond logging
37290.cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
37291&%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
37292appended to the seconds value.
37293.next
37294.cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
37295.cindex "log" "local interface"
37296.cindex "log" "local address and port"
37297.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37298.cindex "interface" "logging"
37299&%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
37300interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
37301followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
37302off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37303.next
37304.cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
37305.cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
37306.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
37307&%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
37308containing => tags) following the IP address.
37309The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
37310&%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
37311This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
37312configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
37313local port is a random ephemeral port.
37314.next
37315.cindex "log" "process ids in"
37316.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37317&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
37318immediately after the time and date.
37319.next
37320.cindex log pipelining
37321.cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
37322&%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
37323log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
37324The field is a single "L".
37325
37326On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
37327the field has a minus appended.
37328.next
37329.cindex "log" "queue run"
37330.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
37331&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
37332.next
37333.cindex "log" "queue time"
37334&%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
37335local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
37336&`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
37337includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
37338This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
37339delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
37340message has been successfully received.
37341If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37342precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
37343.next
37344&%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
37345the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
37346example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
37347message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
37348.next
37349.cindex "log" "receive duration"
37350&%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
37351perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
37352If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37353precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
37354.next
37355.cindex "log" "recipients"
37356&%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
37357as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
37358that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
37359addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
37360has taken place.
37361Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
37362in the list.
37363.next
37364.cindex "log" "sender reception"
37365&%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
37366the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
37367&"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
37368.next
37369.cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
37370&%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
37371rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
37372log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
37373rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
37374.next
37375.cindex "log" "retry defer"
37376&%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
37377retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
37378message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
37379attempt.
37380.next
37381.cindex "log" "return path"
37382&%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
37383the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
37384This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
37385or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
37386.next
37387.cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
37388&%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
37389and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
37390This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
37391necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
37392.next
37393.cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
37394&%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
37395gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
37396the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
37397detail is lost.
37398.next
37399.cindex "log" "size rejection"
37400&%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
37401it is too big.
37402.next
37403.cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
37404.cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
37405&%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
37406queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
37407it.
37408.cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
37409The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
37410.next
37411.cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
37412.cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
37413.cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
37414&%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
37415outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
37416A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
37417response.
37418.next
37419.cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
37420.cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
37421&%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
37422established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
37423&%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
37424only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
37425processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
37426dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
37427not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
37428of connections unless this selector is enabled.
37429
37430For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
37431included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
37432reset if the daemon is restarted.
37433Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
37434subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
37435whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
37436match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
37437logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
37438.next
37439.cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
37440.cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
37441&%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
37442RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
37443and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
37444line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
37445.next
37446.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
37447.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
37448&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
37449connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
37450the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
37451does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
37452an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
37453already have their own log lines.
37454
37455The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
37456way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
37457If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
37458an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
37459DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
37460the same logging options.
37461
37462Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
37463is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
37464.code
37465C=EHLO,QUIT
37466.endd
37467shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
37468than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
37469the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
37470setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
37471have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
37472.next
37473&%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
37474colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
37475log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
37476was accepted or used.
37477.next
37478.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
37479.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
37480&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
37481encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
37482because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
37483been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
37484it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
37485received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
37486.next
37487.cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
37488.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
37489.cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
37490.cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
37491.cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
37492&%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
37493encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
37494external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
37495using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
37496.next
37497.cindex "log" "subject"
37498.cindex "subject, logging"
37499&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
37500preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
37501Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
37502specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
37503unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
37504.next
37505.cindex "log" "certificate verification"
37506.cindex log DANE
37507.cindex DANE logging
37508&%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
37509when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
37510verified
37511using a CA trust anchor,
37512&`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
37513and &`CV=no`& if not.
37514.next
37515.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
37516.cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
37517&%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37518connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
37519.next
37520.cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
37521.cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
37522&%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37523connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
37524added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
37525.next
37526.cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
37527.cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
37528&%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
37529the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
37530added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
37531.next
37532.cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
37533&%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
37534result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
37535.endlist
37536
37537
37538.section "Message log" "SECID260"
37539.cindex "message" "log file for"
37540.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
37541.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
37542.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
37543In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
37544that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
37545they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
37546message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
37547makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
37548to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
37549is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
37550only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
37551
37552On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
37553per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
37554&%message_logs%& option false.
37555.ecindex IIDloggen
37556
37557
37558
37559
37560. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37561. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37562
37563.chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
37564.scindex IIDutils "utilities"
37565A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
37566described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
37567the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
37568
37569.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
37570.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
37571 "list what Exim processes are doing"
37572.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
37573.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
37574.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
37575.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
37576 various criteria"
37577.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
37578.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
37579 "extract statistics from the log"
37580.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
37581 "check address acceptance from given IP"
37582.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
37583.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
37584.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
37585.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
37586.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
37587.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
37588.endtable
37589
37590Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
37591&'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
37592&url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
37593
37594
37595
37596
37597.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
37598.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
37599.cindex "process, querying"
37600.cindex "SIGUSR1"
37601On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
37602(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
37603a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
37604Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
37605processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
37606second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
37607order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
37608send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
37609
37610&*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
37611use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
37612script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
37613
37614
37615Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
37616varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
37617but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
37618system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
37619it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
37620options:
37621.display
37622&`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
37623&`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
37624&`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
37625&`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
37626.endd
37627An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
37628.code
37629164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
3763010483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
3763110492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
37632 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
3763310592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
3763410628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
37635.endd
37636The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
37637been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
37638
37639
37640
37641.section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
37642.cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
37643.cindex "queue" "grepping"
37644This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
37645.code
37646exim -bpu
37647.endd
37648or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
37649.code
37650exim -bp
37651.endd
37652The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
37653contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
37654
37655to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
37656that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
37657
37658.vlist
37659.vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37660Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37661tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37662.code
37663exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
37664.endd
37665.vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37666Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37667tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37668
37669.vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
37670Match against the size field.
37671
37672.vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37673Match messages that are younger than the given time.
37674
37675.vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37676Match messages that are older than the given time.
37677
37678.vitem &*-z*&
37679Match only frozen messages.
37680
37681.vitem &*-x*&
37682Match only non-frozen messages.
37683.endlist
37684
37685The following options control the format of the output:
37686
37687.vlist
37688.vitem &*-c*&
37689Display only the count of matching messages.
37690
37691.vitem &*-l*&
37692Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37693the default.
37694
37695.vitem &*-i*&
37696Display message ids only.
37697
37698.vitem &*-b*&
37699Brief format &-- one line per message.
37700
37701.vitem &*-R*&
37702Display messages in reverse order.
37703
37704.vitem &*-a*&
37705Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37706.endlist
37707
37708There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37709
37710
37711
37712.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
37713.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
37714.cindex "queue" "summary"
37715The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
37716-bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
37717running a command such as
37718.code
37719exim -bp | exiqsumm
37720.endd
37721The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
37722it, as in the following example:
37723.code
377243 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
37725.endd
37726Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
37727volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
37728been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
37729number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
37730
37731A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
37732domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
37733the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
37734respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
37735domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
37736separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
37737sender.
37738
37739The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
37740this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
37741generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
37742option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
37743level"& addresses).
37744
37745
37746
37747
37748.section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
37749 "SECTextspeinf"
37750.cindex "&'exigrep'&"
37751.cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
37752The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
37753files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
37754extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
37755match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
37756given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
37757The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
37758If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
37759included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
37760.display
37761&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
37762.endd
37763If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
37764
37765The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
37766condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
37767they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
37768
37769By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
37770makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
37771large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
37772option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
37773case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
37774
37775The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
37776pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
37777regular expression.
37778
37779The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
37780if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
37781
37782The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
37783that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
37784normally.
37785
37786Example of &%-M%&:
37787user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
37788&'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
37789displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
37790the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
37791when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
37792&"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
37793search term.
37794
37795If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
37796ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
37797whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
37798If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
37799autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
37800
37801
37802.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
37803.cindex "&'exipick'&"
37804John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
37805lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
37806of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
37807the &%--help%& option.
37808
37809
37810.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
37811.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37812.cindex "cycling logs"
37813.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37814The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
37815&'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
37816you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
37817&<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
37818for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
37819There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
37820.ilist
37821&%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
37822default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
37823.next
37824&%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
37825&%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
37826overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
37827configuration.
37828.endlist
37829
37830Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
37831the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
37832run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
37833&_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
37834&%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
37835logs are handled similarly.
37836
37837If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
37838&_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
37839to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
37840any existing log files.
37841
37842If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
37843the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
37844using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
37845setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
37846root &%crontab%& entry of the form
37847.code
378481 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
37849.endd
37850assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
37851&'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
37852
37853
37854
37855.section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
37856.cindex "statistics"
37857.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
37858A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
37859information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
37860. --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
37861. --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
37862
37863The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
37864latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
37865lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
37866various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
37867list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
37868.code
37869eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
37870.endd
37871By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
37872messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
37873both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
37874are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
37875addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
37876options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
37877also produced per user.
37878
37879The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
37880histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
37881hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
37882example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
37883as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
37884
37885Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
37886have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
37887messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
37888and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
37889recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
37890an entirely separate message.
37891
37892&'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
37893of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
37894each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
37895not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
37896least one address that failed.
37897
37898The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
37899or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
37900transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
37901(default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
37902a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
37903senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
37904and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
37905
37906The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
37907came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
37908without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
37909
37910There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
37911outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
37912by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
37913.code
37914perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
37915.endd
37916
37917.section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
37918.cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
37919.cindex "policy control" "checking access"
37920.cindex "checking access"
37921The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
37922debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
37923policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
37924familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
37925sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
37926access?"& without bothering with any further details.
37927
37928The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
37929two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
37930.code
37931exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
37932.endd
37933The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
37934given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
37935connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
37936is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
37937.code
37938Rejected:
37939550 Relay not permitted
37940.endd
37941When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
37942for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
37943options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
37944that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
37945you can use:
37946.code
37947exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
37948 -f himself@there.example
37949.endd
37950Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
37951mandatory arguments.
37952
37953Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
37954while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
37955&%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
37956
37957
37958
37959.section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
37960.cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
37961.cindex "building DBM files"
37962.cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
37963.cindex "lower casing"
37964.cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
37965The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
37966the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
37967&<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
37968names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
37969can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
37970
37971A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
37972the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
37973&'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
37974strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
37975files.
37976
37977The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
37978single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
37979It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
37980well.
37981
37982.cindex "USE_DB"
37983If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
37984configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
37985filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
37986create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
37987.code
37988exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
37989.endd
37990reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
37991&_/etc/aliases.db_&.
37992
37993In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
37994Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
37995environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
37996&'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
37997when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
37998recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
37999
38000If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38001finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38002option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38003this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38004&%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38005There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38006&%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38007return code is 2.
38008
38009
38010
38011
38012.section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38013.cindex "retry" "times"
38014.cindex "&'exinext'&"
38015A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38016fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38017complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38018information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38019is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38020output. For example:
38021.code
38022$ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38023kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38024 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38025 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38026 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38027roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38028 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38029 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38030 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38031 past final cutoff time
38032.endd
38033You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38034will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38035A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38036message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38037suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38038&'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38039run very often.
38040
38041The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38042of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38043passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38044configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38045file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38046environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38047
38048
38049
38050.section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38051.cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38052.cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38053Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38054uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38055arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38056second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38057
38058.ilist
38059&'retry'&: the database of retry information
38060.next
38061&'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38062for remote hosts
38063.next
38064&'callout'&: the callout cache
38065.next
38066&'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38067.next
38068&'misc'&: other hints data
38069.endlist
38070
38071The &'misc'& database is used for
38072
38073.ilist
38074Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38075.next
38076Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38077&(smtp)& transport)
38078.next
38079Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38080in a transport)
38081.endlist
38082
38083
38084
38085.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38086.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38087The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38088&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38089spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38090.code
38091exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38092.endd
38093Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38094.code
38095T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
3809631-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38097.endd
38098The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38099of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38100transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38101a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38102address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38103transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38104to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38105and a textual description of the error.
38106
38107The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38108the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38109ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38110exceeded.
38111
38112Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38113consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38114waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38115one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38116may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38117may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38118cross-references.
38119
38120
38121
38122.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38123.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38124The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38125database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38126days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38127updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38128since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38129for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38130updated sufficiently often.
38131
38132The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38133followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38134the retry database:
38135.code
38136exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38137.endd
38138Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38139message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38140they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38141are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38142types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38143message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38144queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38145&'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38146For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38147removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38148whenever it removes information from the database.
38149
38150Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38151needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38152down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38153first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38154records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38155
38156It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38157hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38158a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38159work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38160but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38161After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38162point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38163tidied.
38164
38165&*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38166databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38167
38168
38169
38170
38171.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38172.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38173The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38174Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38175getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38176is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38177key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38178displayed.
38179
38180If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38181except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38182out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38183data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38184by new data, for example:
38185.code
38186> 4 951102:1000
38187.endd
38188resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38189sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
38190used as optional separators.
38191
38192
38193
38194
38195.section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
38196.cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
38197.cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
38198.cindex "locking mailboxes"
38199The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
38200Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
38201&'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
38202a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
38203the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
38204argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
38205second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
38206is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
38207is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
38208
38209.vlist
38210.vitem &%-fcntl%&
38211Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
38212
38213.vitem &%-flock%&
38214Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
38215supports it.
38216
38217.vitem &%-interval%&
38218This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
38219interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
38220
38221.vitem &%-lockfile%&
38222Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
38223
38224.vitem &%-mbx%&
38225Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
38226
38227.vitem &%-q%&
38228Suppress verification output.
38229
38230.vitem &%-retries%&
38231This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
38232the lock (default 10).
38233
38234.vitem &%-restore_time%&
38235This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
38236locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
38237example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
38238subsequently sees.
38239
38240.vitem &%-timeout%&
38241This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
38242timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
38243default), a non-blocking call is used.
38244
38245.vitem &%-v%&
38246Generate verbose output.
38247.endlist
38248
38249If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
38250default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
38251mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
38252&%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
38253requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
38254file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
38255more than 30 minutes old.
38256
38257The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
38258&%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
38259to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
38260&_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
38261number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
38262can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
38263
38264The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
38265&%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
38266suppresses all output except error messages.
38267
38268A command such as
38269.code
38270exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
38271.endd
38272runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
38273.display
38274&`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
38275<&'some commands'&>
38276&`End`&
38277.endd
38278runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
38279suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
38280such as
38281.code
38282exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
38283 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
38284.endd
38285Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
38286second argument &-- hence the quotes.
38287.ecindex IIDutils
38288
38289
38290. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38291. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38292
38293.chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
38294.scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
38295.cindex "X-windows"
38296.cindex "&'eximon'&"
38297.cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
38298.cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
38299The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
38300about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
38301perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
38302such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
38303monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
38304
38305
38306
38307.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
38308The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
38309script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
38310binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
38311be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
38312&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
38313parameters are for.
38314
38315The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
38316a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
38317preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
38318.code
38319EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
38320.endd
38321(in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
38322the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
38323overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
38324&'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
38325syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
38326
38327X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
38328way. For example, a resource setting of the form
38329.code
38330Eximon*background: gray94
38331.endd
38332changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
38333stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
38334black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
38335data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
38336&"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
38337For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
38338reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
38339.code
38340xrdb -merge <<End
38341Eximon*highlight: gray
38342End
38343.endd
38344.cindex "admin user"
38345In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
38346&'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
38347
38348The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
38349contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
38350if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
38351binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
38352versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
38353
38354The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
38355more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
38356main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
38357delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
38358different parts of the display.
38359
38360
38361
38362
38363.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
38364.cindex "stripchart"
38365The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
38366be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38367&_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
38368configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
38369it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
38370hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
38371received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
38372period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
38373parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38374
38375The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
38376displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
38377title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
38378For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
38379
38380It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
38381a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
38382to a single partition.
38383
38384.cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
38385This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
38386the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
38387this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
38388100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
38389SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38390&_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38391
38392
38393
38394
38395.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
38396.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
38397.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
38398.cindex "window size"
38399Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
38400to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
38401shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
38402stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
38403the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
38404in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
38405
38406When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
38407currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
38408size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
38409remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
38410
38411The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
38412stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
38413the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
38414The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
38415&'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
38416the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38417
38418Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
38419built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
38420START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38421
38422
38423
38424.section "The log display" "SECID267"
38425.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
38426The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
38427the main log is maintained.
38428To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
38429removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
38430The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
38431syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
38432to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
38433
38434The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
38435move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
38436scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
38437LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
38438to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
38439much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
38440a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
38441only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
38442available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
38443normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
38444configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38445
38446Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
38447and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
38448respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
38449It cannot go further back up the log.
38450
38451The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
38452normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
38453by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
38454by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
38455back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
38456the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
38457
38458Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
38459There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
38460the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
38461happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
38462&"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
38463^C is typed the search is cancelled.
38464
38465The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
38466widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
38467&"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
38468eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
38469However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
38470provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
38471come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
38472unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
38473on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
38474window.
38475
38476
38477
38478.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
38479.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
38480The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
38481are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
38482as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
38483parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
38484at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
38485the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
38486there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
38487to force an update of the queue display at any time.
38488
38489When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
38490and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
38491with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
38492pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
38493type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
38494such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
38495of the texts, the message is not displayed.
38496
38497If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
38498are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
38499example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
38500&'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
38501has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
38502cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
38503a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
38504
38505While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
38506else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
38507queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
38508pressing the &"Hide"& button.
38509
38510The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
38511time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
38512message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
38513a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
38514recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
38515listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
38516an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
38517not shown.
38518
38519.cindex "frozen messages" "display"
38520If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
38521
38522The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
38523of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
38524The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
38525available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
38526display is updated.
38527
38528
38529
38530.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
38531.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
38532If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
38533pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
38534line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
38535any selected text.
38536
38537If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
38538MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
38539set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
38540value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
38541run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
38542.code
38543EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
38544.endd
38545The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
38546follows:
38547
38548.ilist
38549&'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
38550in a new text window.
38551.next
38552&'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
38553information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
38554&<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
38555.next
38556&'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
38557displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
38558amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
38559option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
38560.next
38561&'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
38562delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
38563frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
38564a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
38565up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
38566.next
38567&'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
38568that the message be frozen.
38569.next
38570.cindex "thawing messages"
38571.cindex "unfreezing messages"
38572.cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
38573&'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
38574that the message be thawed.
38575.next
38576.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
38577&'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
38578that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
38579for any remaining undelivered addresses.
38580.next
38581&'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
38582that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
38583message.
38584.next
38585&'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
38586be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38587is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38588Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38589causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
38590additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
38591which case no action is taken.
38592.next
38593&'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
38594can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38595is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38596Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38597causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
38598recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
38599case no action is taken.
38600.next
38601&'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
38602mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
38603.next
38604&'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
38605sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
38606&%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
38607in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
38608bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
38609not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
38610the address is qualified with that domain.
38611.endlist
38612
38613When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
38614other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
38615particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
38616output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
38617from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
38618&_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
38619if no output is generated.
38620
38621The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
38622thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
38623&_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
38624force an update of the display after one of these actions.
38625
38626In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
38627cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
38628and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
38629.ecindex IIDeximon
38630
38631
38632
38633
38634
38635. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38636. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38637
38638.chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
38639.scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
38640This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
38641which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
38642
38643For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
38644Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
38645existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
38646chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
38647security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
38648its security as compared with other MTAs.
38649
38650What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
38651have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
38652absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
38653as soon as possible.
38654
38655
38656.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
38657.cindex "security" "build-time features"
38658There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
38659to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38660Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38661penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38662
38663.ilist
38664ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
38665start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
38666filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
38667the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
38668&_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
38669default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
38670
38671If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
38672which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
38673into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
38674configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38675.next
38676
38677If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38678or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38679file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38680the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38681root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38682right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38683reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38684it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38685privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38686separate commands.
38687
38688.next
38689The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38690with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38691CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38692requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38693the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38694but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38695previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38696.next
38697If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38698is disabled.
38699.next
38700FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38701never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38702option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38703to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38704is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38705.endlist
38706
38707
38708
38709.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38710.cindex "setuid"
38711.cindex "root privilege"
38712The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
38713privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
38714example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
38715may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
38716discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
38717is required for two things:
38718
38719.ilist
38720To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
38721the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
38722not required.
38723.next
38724To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
38725perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
38726configuration.
38727.endlist
38728
38729It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
38730receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
38731obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
38732For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
38733&_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
38734group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
38735is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
38736&'mail'& or another user name altogether.
38737
38738Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
38739abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
38740&[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
38741
38742After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
38743uid and gid in the following cases:
38744
38745.ilist
38746.oindex "&%-C%&"
38747.oindex "&%-D%&"
38748If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
38749the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
38750calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
38751the calling process.
38752However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
38753option may not be used at all.
38754If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
38755can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
38756user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
38757.next
38758.oindex "&%-be%&"
38759.oindex "&%-bf%&"
38760.oindex "&%-bF%&"
38761If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
38762(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
38763calling process.
38764.next
38765If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
38766process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
38767uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
38768runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
38769testing address verification
38770.oindex "&%-bv%&"
38771.oindex "&%-bh%&"
38772(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
38773option).
38774.next
38775For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
38776remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
38777.endlist
38778
38779The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
38780
38781.ilist
38782A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
38783user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
38784function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
38785will be used during message reception.
38786.next
38787A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
38788job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
38789.next
38790A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
38791but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
38792subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
38793deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
38794remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
38795subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
38796while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
38797generating bounce and warning messages.
38798
38799While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
38800process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
38801this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
38802gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
38803.next
38804A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
38805the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
38806.endlist
38807
38808
38809
38810
38811.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
38812.cindex "privilege, running without"
38813.cindex "unprivileged running"
38814.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
38815Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
38816operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
38817by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
38818gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
38819(and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
38820routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
38821to any other uid.
38822
38823.cindex SIGHUP
38824.cindex "daemon" "restarting"
38825Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
38826that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
38827correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
38828
38829An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
38830to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
38831process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
38832when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
38833SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
38834
38835It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
38836stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
38837been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
38838effect.
38839
38840If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
38841set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
38842to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
38843
38844In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
38845those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
38846Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
38847that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
38848discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
38849have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
38850number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
38851address this problem at this time.
38852
38853For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
38854is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
38855&%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
38856be used in the most straightforward way.
38857
38858If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
38859number of restrictions on what you can do:
38860
38861.ilist
38862You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
38863&%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
38864normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
38865work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
38866explicit specification of another user causes an error.
38867.next
38868Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
38869not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
38870.next
38871Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
38872the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
38873and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
38874enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
38875.next
38876Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
38877some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
38878
38879.olist
38880They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
38881implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
38882mode of the mailbox files themselves.
38883.next
38884You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
38885owned by the Exim user.
38886.next
38887You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
38888on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
38889mailboxes need to be created manually.
38890.endlist olist
38891.endlist ilist
38892
38893
38894These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
38895However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
38896gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
38897gives more security at essentially no cost.
38898
38899If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
38900&<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
38901
38902
38903
38904
38905.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
38906Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
38907are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
38908
38909
38910
38911.section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
38912.cindex "security" "local commands"
38913.cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
38914There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
38915commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
38916configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
38917run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
38918
38919.ilist
38920Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
38921injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
38922be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
38923allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
38924has &%use_shell%& enabled.
38925.next
38926A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
38927&%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
38928&_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
38929hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
38930NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
38931forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
38932need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
38933.next
38934The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
38935administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
38936Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
38937.next
38938Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
38939taint checking might apply to their usage.
38940.next
38941Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
38942administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
38943instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
38944.next
38945Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
38946Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
38947each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
38948of opaque strings.
38949The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
38950real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
38951injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
38952Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
38953.endlist
38954
38955
38956
38957
38958.section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
38959.cindex "security" "data sources"
38960.cindex "security" "regular expressions"
38961.cindex "regular expressions" "security"
38962.cindex "PCRE" "security"
38963If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
38964are some issues to be aware of:
38965
38966.ilist
38967Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
38968.next
38969Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
38970.next
38971Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
38972data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
38973"backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
38974expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
38975when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
38976possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
38977data.
38978.next
38979It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
38980&%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
38981items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
38982.next
38983Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
38984expected to yield one result.
38985.endlist
38986
38987
38988
38989
38990.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
38991.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
38992.cindex "IP source routing"
38993Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
38994some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
38995IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
38996IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
38997
38998
38999
39000.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39001Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39002be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39003
39004
39005
39006
39007.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39008.cindex "trusted users"
39009.cindex "admin user"
39010.cindex "privileged user"
39011.cindex "user" "trusted"
39012.cindex "user" "admin"
39013Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39014able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39015addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39016local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39017permit a remote host to be specified.
39018
39019.oindex "&%-f%&"
39020However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39021in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39022message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39023but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39024permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39025the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39026
39027Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39028other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39029the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39030as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39031group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39032
39033Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39034can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39035them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39036the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39037includes the contents of files on the spool.
39038
39039.oindex "&%-M%&"
39040.oindex "&%-q%&"
39041By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39042delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39043restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39044Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39045queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39046setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39047
39048Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39049the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39050the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39051group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39052the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39053unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39054files.
39055
39056By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39057introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39058setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39059This affects most of the checking options,
39060such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39061
39062
39063.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39064.cindex "spool directory" "files"
39065Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39066set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39067&_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39068any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39069
39070
39071
39072.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39073Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39074of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39075with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39076to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39077this.
39078
39079
39080
39081.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39082The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39083are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39084Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39085converted output.
39086
39087
39088
39089.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39090Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39091to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39092does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39093arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39094
39095
39096
39097.section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39098Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39099defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39100loading it.
39101
39102
39103.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39104.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39105A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39106&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39107The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39108that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39109conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39110
39111The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39112the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39113string.
39114
39115
39116
39117.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39118Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39119formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39120the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39121
39122
39123
39124.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39125These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39126enough to hold the result.
39127.ecindex IIDsecurcon
39128
39129
39130
39131
39132. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39133. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39134
39135.chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39136.scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39137.scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39138.scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39139.cindex "spool files" "editing"
39140A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39141followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39142the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39143kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39144two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39145is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39146themselves are recoverable.
39147
39148The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39149Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39150and should not be used as such.
39151
39152Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39153need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39154on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39155
39156.ilist
39157You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39158fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39159which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39160place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39161lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39162.next
39163.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39164If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39165&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39166cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39167.next
39168If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39169.next
39170If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39171signature.
39172.endlist
39173All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39174
39175Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39176its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39177files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39178the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39179the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39180is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39181file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39182-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39183attempt.
39184
39185Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39186These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39187They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39188relics of crashes and can be removed.
39189
39190.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
39191.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
39192.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
39193The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
39194process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
39195gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
39196message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
39197normally the Exim user.
39198
39199The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
39200transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
39201empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
39202in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
39203created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
39204&%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
39205leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
39206&"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
39207
39208The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
39209was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
39210start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
39211warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
39212
39213There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
39214order, and are omitted when not relevant:
39215
39216.vlist
39217.vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39218This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
39219&%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
39220recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
39221this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
39222identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
39223the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
39224the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
39225the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
39226newlines.
39227
39228.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39229A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
39230defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
39231The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39232starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39233character. It may contain internal newlines.
39234
39235.vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39236A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
39237Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
39238length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39239starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39240character. It may contain internal newlines.
39241
39242.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
39243This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
39244&$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
39245
39246.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
39247This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
39248lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
39249transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
39250messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39251
39252.vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
39253This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
39254(to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
39255time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
39256hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39257
39258.vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
39259The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
39260&-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
39261
39262.vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
39263The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
39264&$authenticated_sender$& variable.
39265
39266.vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39267This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
39268present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
39269
39270.vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39271This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
39272present if the number is greater than zero.
39273
39274.vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
39275This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
39276file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
39277
39278.vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
39279.cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
39280The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
39281
39282.vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39283This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
39284command.
39285
39286.vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39287This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
39288the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
39289messages.
39290
39291.vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
39292If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
39293the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
39294&$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
39295
39296.vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
39297This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
39298address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
39299
39300.vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39301.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
39302.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
39303This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
39304if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
39305received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
39306
39307.vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
39308For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
39309unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
39310ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
39311supplied by the remote host, if any.
39312
39313.vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39314This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
39315which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
39316generated messages.
39317
39318.vitem &%-local%&
39319The message is from a local sender.
39320
39321.vitem &%-localerror%&
39322The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
39323
39324.vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
39325This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
39326when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
39327variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
39328
39329.vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
39330The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
39331Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
39332
39333.vitem &%-N%&
39334A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
39335actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
39336&%-N%& is assumed.
39337
39338.vitem &%-received_protocol%&
39339This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
39340the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
39341
39342.vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
39343The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
39344to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
39345
39346.vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
39347If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
39348of &$spam_score_int$&.
39349
39350.vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
39351The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
39352rather than Unix-format.
39353The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
39354There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
39355
39356.vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
39357A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
39358certificate was verified by the server.
39359
39360.vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
39361When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
39362name of the cipher suite that was used.
39363
39364.vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
39365When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
39366was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
39367certificate.
39368.endlist
39369
39370Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
39371is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
39372line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
39373is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
39374the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
39375balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
39376to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
39377original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
39378addresses are complete.
39379
39380If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
39381the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
39382Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
39383tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
39384right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
39385follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
39386.code
39387YY darcy@austen.fict.example
39388NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
39389NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39390.endd
39391After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
39392This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
39393recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
39394delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
39395example:
39396.code
393974
39398editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39399darcy@austen.fict.example
39400rdo@foundation
39401alice@wonderland.fict.example
39402.endd
39403However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
39404result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
39405line is of the following form:
39406.display
39407<&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
39408 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
39409.endd
39410The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
39411the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
39412fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
39413original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
39414envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
39415length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
39416characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
39417that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
39418
39419
39420A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
39421which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
39422when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
39423character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
39424embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
39425following:
39426
39427.table2 50pt
39428.row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
39429.row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
39430.row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
39431.row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
39432.row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
39433.row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
39434.row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
39435.row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
39436.row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
39437.row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
39438.endtable
39439
39440Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
39441purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
39442typical set of headers:
39443.code
39444111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
39445id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39446049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
39447038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
39448042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
39449049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
39450099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
39451darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39452104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
39453darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39454038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39455.endd
39456The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
39457&'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
39458unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
39459.ecindex IIDforspo1
39460.ecindex IIDforspo2
39461.ecindex IIDforspo3
39462
39463.section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
39464The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
39465an ASCII newline character.
39466However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
39467can have an alternate format.
39468This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
39469The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
39470suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
39471ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
39472Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
39473There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
39474
39475. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39476. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39477
39478.chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
39479 "DKIM and SPF Support"
39480.cindex "DKIM"
39481
39482.section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
39483
39484DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
39485linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
39486be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
39487DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
39488
39489As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
39490by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
39491any original DKIM signature.
39492
39493DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
39494It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39495
39496Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
39497.olist
39498Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
39499It can co-exist with all other Exim features
39500(including transport filters)
39501except cutthrough delivery.
39502.next
39503Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
39504ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
39505different signature contexts.
39506.endlist
39507
39508In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
39509default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
39510Exim's standard controls.
39511
39512Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
39513on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
39514
39515Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
39516When set, for each signature in incoming email,
39517exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
39518signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
39519.code
395202009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
39521 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
39522 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
39523 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
39524.endd
39525
39526You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
39527or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
39528control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
39529where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
39530senders).
39531
39532
39533.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
39534.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
39535
39536For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
39537Note that RFC 8301 says:
39538.code
39539rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39540
39541Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39542Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39543.endd
39544
39545Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
39546in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
39547for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
39548(equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
39549but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
39550
39551Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
39552These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
39553
39554.option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
39555The domain(s) you want to sign with.
39556After expansion, this can be a list.
39557Each element in turn is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
39558while expanding the remaining signing options.
39559If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
39560and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39561
39562.option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
39563This sets the key selector string.
39564After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
39565Each element in turn is put in the expansion
39566variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
39567option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
39568If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
39569and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39570
39571.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
39572This sets the private key to use.
39573You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
39574&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
39575The result can either
39576.ilist
39577be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
39578.next
39579with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39580be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
39581.next
39582start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
39583the private key
39584.next
39585be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
39586be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
39587is set.
39588.endlist
39589
39590To generate keys under OpenSSL:
39591.code
39592openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
39593openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
39594.endd
39595Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
39596for the DNS TXT record.
39597See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
39598
39599Under GnuTLS:
39600.code
39601certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
39602certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
39603.endd
39604
39605Note that RFC 8301 says:
39606.code
39607Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39608Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39609.endd
39610
39611Support for EC keys is being developed under
39612&url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-dcrup-dkim-crypto/).
39613They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
39614As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
39615(by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
39616for some transition period.
39617The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39618for EC keys.
39619
39620OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
39621.code
39622openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
39623certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
39624.endd
39625
39626To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
39627.code
39628openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
39629certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
39630.endd
39631
39632Note that the format
39633of Ed25519 keys in DNS has not yet been decided; this release supports
39634both of the leading candidates at this time, a future release will
39635probably drop support for whichever proposal loses.
39636
39637.option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
39638Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
39639.ilist
39640&`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
39641.next
39642&`sha256`& &-- the default
39643.next
39644&`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
39645.endlist
39646
39647Note that RFC 8301 says:
39648.code
39649rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39650.endd
39651
39652.option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
39653If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
39654the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
39655syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
39656local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
39657tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
39658
39659.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
39660This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
39661The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
39662The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
39663only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
39664
39665.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
39666This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
39667should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
39668either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
39669unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
39670variables here.
39671
39672.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
39673If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
39674list of header names.
39675Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
39676in the message signature.
39677When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
39678whether or not each header is present in the message.
39679The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
39680"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
39681
39682If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
39683will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
39684message are signed first, if there are multiples.
39685
39686A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
39687If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
39688will be signed.
39689If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
39690will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
39691name will be appended.
39692
39693.option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
39694This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
39695If not set, no such information will be included.
39696Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
39697for the expiry tag
39698(eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
39699both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
39700
39701RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
39702
39703
39704.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
39705.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
39706
39707Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
39708messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
39709.cindex authentication "expansion item"
39710Performing verification sets up information used by the
39711&$authresults$& expansion item.
39712
39713The results of that verification are then made available to the
39714&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
39715By default, this ACL is called once for each
39716syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
39717A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
39718If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
39719If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
39720summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
39721
39722To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
39723a large number of expansion variables
39724containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
39725runtime of the ACL.
39726
39727Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
39728more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
39729&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
39730&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
39731
39732The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
39733list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
39734called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
39735the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
39736list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
39737&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
39738it defaults as:
39739.code
39740dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
39741.endd
39742This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
39743DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
39744call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
39745.code
39746dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
39747.endd
39748This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
39749and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
39750You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
39751.code
39752dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
39753.endd
39754
39755If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
39756&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
39757
39758If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
39759for each matching signature.
39760
39761
39762Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
39763available (from most to least important):
39764
39765
39766.vlist
39767.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
39768The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
39769an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
39770&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
39771
39772.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
39773Within the DKIM ACL,
39774a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
39775.ilist
39776&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
39777identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39778.next
39779&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
39780More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39781.next
39782&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
39783available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39784.next
39785&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
39786.endlist
39787
39788This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39789This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
39790hash-method or key-size:
39791.code
39792 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
39793 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
39794 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
39795 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
39796 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
39797 set dkim_verify_status = fail
39798 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
39799.endd
39800
39801So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
39802after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
39803colon-separated list of the values after each run.
39804This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
39805
39806.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
39807A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
39808"fail" or "invalid". One of
39809.ilist
39810&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
39811key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
39812.next
39813&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
39814record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
39815.next
39816&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
39817body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
39818means that the message body was modified in transit.
39819.next
39820&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
39821could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
39822re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
39823DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
39824.endlist
39825
39826This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39827
39828.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
39829The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
39830an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
39831reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39832
39833.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
39834The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
39835if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
39836identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39837
39838.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
39839The key record selector string.
39840
39841.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
39842The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
39843If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39844may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
39845The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39846for EC keys.
39847
39848Note that RFC 8301 says:
39849.code
39850rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39851
39852DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
39853algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
39854.endd
39855
39856To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39857and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39858
39859.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
39860The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39861
39862.vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
39863The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39864
39865.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
39866A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
39867(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
39868Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
39869not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
39870strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
39871
39872.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
39873The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
39874limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
39875that this variable always expands to an integer value.
39876&*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
39877is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
39878A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
39879shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
39880
39881.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
39882UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
39883When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
39884
39885.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
39886UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
39887signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
39888signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
39889integer size comparisons against this value.
39890Note that Exim does not check this value.
39891
39892.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
39893A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
39894
39895.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
39896"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
39897
39898.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
39899"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
39900
39901.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
39902Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39903in the key record.
39904
39905.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
39906Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39907in the key record.
39908
39909.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
39910Notes from the key record (tag n=).
39911
39912.vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
39913Number of bits in the key.
39914
39915Note that RFC 8301 says:
39916.code
39917Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
39918less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
39919.endd
39920
39921To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39922and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39923As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
39924
39925.endlist
39926
39927In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
39928
39929.vlist
39930.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
39931ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
39932for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
39933(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
39934verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
39935
39936.code
39937# Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
39938warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
39939 sender_domains = gmail.com
39940 dkim_signers = gmail.com
39941 dkim_status = none
39942.endd
39943
39944Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
39945for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
39946
39947.vitem &%dkim_status%&
39948ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
39949results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
39950to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
39951
39952.code
39953deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
39954 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
39955 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
39956 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
39957.endd
39958
39959The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
39960see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
39961for more information of what they mean.
39962.endlist
39963
39964
39965
39966
39967.section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
39968.cindex SPF verification
39969
39970SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
39971messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
39972For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
39973. --- 2018-09-07: still not https
39974
39975Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
39976This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
39977
39978SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
39979&_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
39980&url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
39981There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
39982publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
39983
39984For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
39985.cindex authentication "expansion item"
39986Performing verification sets up information used by the
39987&$authresults$& expansion item.
39988
39989
39990.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
39991.cindex ACL "spf condition"
39992The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
39993It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
39994and will succeed for any matching outcome.
39995Valid strings are:
39996.vlist
39997.vitem &%pass%&
39998The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
39999
40000.vitem &%fail%&
40001The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40002domain in the envelope-from address.
40003
40004.vitem &%softfail%&
40005The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40006is a forgery.
40007
40008.vitem &%none%&
40009The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40010
40011.vitem &%neutral%&
40012The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40013published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40014its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40015
40016.vitem &%permerror%&
40017This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40018You may deny messages when this occurs.
40019
40020.vitem &%temperror%&
40021This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40022SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40023.endlist
40024
40025You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40026its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40027"fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40028short-circuit fashion.
40029
40030Example:
40031.code
40032deny spf = fail
40033 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40034 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40035 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40036 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
40037 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40038 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40039 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40040 ip=$sender_host_address
40041.endd
40042
40043When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40044variables:
40045
40046.cindex SPF "verification variables"
40047.vlist
40048.vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40049.vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40050 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40051 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40052 it for logging purposes.
40053
40054.vitem &$spf_received$&
40055.vindex &$spf_received$&
40056 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40057 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40058 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40059 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40060
40061 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40062 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40063
40064.vitem &$spf_result$&
40065.vindex &$spf_result$&
40066 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40067 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40068 temperror.
40069
40070.vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40071.vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40072 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40073 and required in order to obtain a result.
40074
40075.vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40076.vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40077 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40078 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40079.endlist
40080
40081
40082.cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40083.cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40084.cindex SPF "best guess"
40085In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40086"Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40087SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40088capability.
40089Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40090for a description of what it means.
40091. --- 2018-09-07: still not https:
40092
40093To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40094of the spf one. For example:
40095
40096.code
40097deny spf_guess = fail
40098 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40099.endd
40100
40101In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40102should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40103is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40104reject message.
40105
40106When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40107variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40108
40109Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40110what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40111&%spf_guess%& option.
40112For example, the following:
40113
40114.code
40115spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40116.endd
40117
40118would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40119
40120
40121.cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40122.cindex lookup spf
40123A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40124address as the key and an IP address as the database:
40125
40126.code
40127 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40128.endd
40129
40130The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40131&$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40132Currently, only IPv4 addresses are supported.
40133
40134
40135
40136
40137. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40138. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40139
40140.chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
40141 "Proxy support"
40142.cindex "proxy support"
40143.cindex "proxy" "access via"
40144
40145A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
40146Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
40147
40148
40149.section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
40150.cindex proxy inbound
40151.cindex proxy "server side"
40152.cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
40153.cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
40154
40155Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
40156that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
40157To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
40158in Local/Makefile.
40159
40160It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
40161&url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
40162
40163The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
40164such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
40165to distribute load.
40166Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
40167the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
40168There is no logging if a host passes or
40169fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
40170recorded in an ACL (example is below).
40171
40172Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
40173main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
40174hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
40175Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
40176automatically determines which version is in use.
40177
40178The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
40179and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
40180negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
40181Exim and the proxy server.
40182
40183The following expansion variables are usable
40184(&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
40185of the proxy):
40186.display
40187&'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
40188&'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
40189&'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
40190&'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
40191&'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
40192.endd
40193If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
40194there was a protocol error.
40195
40196Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
40197per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
40198evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
40199handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
40200With the option set so high, you lose the ability
40201to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
40202In order to prevent your server from overload, you
40203need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
40204A possible solution is:
40205.display
40206 # Set max number of connections per host
40207 LIMIT = 5
40208 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
40209 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
40210
40211 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
40212 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
40213.endd
40214
40215
40216
40217.section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
40218.cindex proxy outbound
40219.cindex proxy "client side"
40220.cindex proxy SOCKS
40221.cindex SOCKS proxy
40222Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
40223using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
40224The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
40225Local/Makefile.
40226
40227Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
40228on an smtp transport.
40229The option value is expanded and should then be a list
40230(colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
40231Each proxy specifier is a list
40232(space-separated by default) where the initial element
40233is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
40234
40235Options are a string <name>=<value>.
40236The list of options is in the following table:
40237.display
40238&'auth '& authentication method
40239&'name '& authentication username
40240&'pass '& authentication password
40241&'port '& tcp port
40242&'tmo '& connection timeout
40243&'pri '& priority
40244&'weight '& selection bias
40245.endd
40246
40247More details on each of these options follows:
40248
40249.ilist
40250.cindex authentication "to proxy"
40251.cindex proxy authentication
40252&%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
40253Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
40254for access to the proxy.
40255Default is &"none"&.
40256.next
40257&%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
40258Default is empty.
40259.next
40260&%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
40261Default is empty.
40262.next
40263&%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
40264Default is 1080.
40265.next
40266&%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
40267Default is 5.
40268.next
40269&%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
40270higher values being tried first.
40271The default priority is 1.
40272.next
40273&%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
40274Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
40275weighted by this value.
40276The default value for selection bias is 1.
40277.endlist
40278
40279Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
40280and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
40281overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
40282
40283.section Logging SECTproxyLog
40284To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
40285add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
40286This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
40287
40288. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40289. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40290
40291.chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
40292 "Internationalisation""
40293.cindex internationalisation "email address"
40294.cindex EAI
40295.cindex i18n
40296.cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
40297
40298Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
40299To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
40300Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
40301
40302If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
40303instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
40304requirement, upon libidn2.
40305
40306.section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
40307.cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
40308The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
40309a host list. If this matches the sending host and
40310accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
40311SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
40312
40313If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
40314international handling for the message is enabled and
40315the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
40316
40317The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
40318message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
40319whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
40320when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
40321
40322Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
40323UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
40324require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
40325the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
40326
40327HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
40328components expanded to a-label form,
40329and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
40330form of the name.
40331
40332.cindex log protocol
40333.cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
40334.cindex i18n logging
40335Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
40336prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
40337
40338The following expansion operators can be used:
40339.code
40340${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
40341${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
40342${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
40343${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
40344.endd
40345
40346.cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
40347.cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
40348The RCPT ACL
40349may use the following modifier:
40350.display
40351control = utf8_downconvert
40352control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
40353.endd
40354This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
40355a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
40356Message Submission Agent context.
40357If a value is appended it may be:
40358.display
40359&`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
40360&`0 `& no downconversion
40361&`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
40362.endd
40363
40364If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
40365is initially set to -1.
40366
40367The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
40368If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
40369and it overrides any previously set value.
40370
40371
40372There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
40373Configurations supporting these should inspect
40374&$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
40375
40376There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
40377Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
40378for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
40379
40380There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
40381and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
40382
40383
40384
40385.section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
40386To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
40387the following expansion operator can be used:
40388.code
40389${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
40390.endd
40391
40392The string is converted from the charset specified by
40393the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
40394or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
40395to the
40396modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
40397with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
40398(which has to be a single character)
40399are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
40400<sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
40401
40402The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
40403The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
40404
40405This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
40406by many other IMAP servers.
40407
40408Examples:
40409.display
40410&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
40411&`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
40412&`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
40413.endd
40414
40415Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
40416must be representable in UTF-16.
40417
40418
40419. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40420. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40421
40422.chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
40423 "Events"
40424.cindex events
40425
40426The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
40427of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
40428actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
40429processing actions.
40430
40431Most installations will never need to use Events.
40432The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
40433in &_Local/Makefile_&.
40434
40435There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
40436The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
40437a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
40438
40439Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
40440An example might look like:
40441.cindex logging custom
40442.code
40443event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
40444{${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
40445 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
40446 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
40447 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
40448 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
40449 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
40450 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
40451 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
40452} {}}
40453.endd
40454
40455Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
40456The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
40457expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
40458
40459The current list of events is:
40460.display
40461&`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
40462&`msg:complete after main `& per message
40463&`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40464&`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
40465&`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
40466&`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
40467&`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40468&`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
40469&`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
40470&`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
40471&`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
40472&`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
40473.endd
40474New event types may be added in future.
40475
40476The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
40477event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
40478or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
40479
40480The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
40481before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
40482can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
40483
40484The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
40485should define the event action.
40486
40487An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
40488with the event type:
40489.display
40490&`dane:fail `& failure reason
40491&`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
40492&`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
40493&`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
40494&`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
40495&`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
40496&`msg:host:defer `& error string
40497&`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
40498&`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
40499.endd
40500
40501The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
40502
40503For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
40504however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
40505the course of its processing:
40506.ilist
40507variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
40508transport call
40509.next
40510acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
40511and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
40512.endlist
40513Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
40514a useful way of writing to the main log.
40515
40516The expansion of the event_action option should normally
40517return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
40518following will be forced:
40519.display
40520&`tcp:connect `& do not connect
40521&`tls:cert `& refuse verification
40522&`smtp:connect `& close connection
40523.endd
40524All other message types ignore the result string, and
40525no other use is made of it.
40526
40527For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
40528then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
40529the target system.
40530
40531For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
40532chain element received on the connection.
40533For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
40534loaded locally.
40535
40536. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40537. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40538
40539.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
40540 "Adding drivers or lookups"
40541.cindex "adding drivers"
40542.cindex "new drivers, adding"
40543.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
40544The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
40545authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
40546
40547.olist
40548Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
40549existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
40550.next
40551Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
40552.display
40553<&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
40554.endd
40555where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
40556code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
40557should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
40558.next
40559Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
40560.code
40561#define <type>_NEWDRIVER
40562.endd
40563.next
40564Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
40565and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
40566.next
40567Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
40568near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
40569Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
40570As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
40571simple form that most lookups have.
40572.next
40573Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
40574&_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
40575driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
40576.next
40577Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
40578definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
40579.next
40580Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
40581&_src_&.
40582.next
40583Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
40584as for other drivers and lookups.
40585.endlist
40586
40587Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
40588proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
40589occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
40590options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
40591searched using a binary chop procedure.
40592
40593There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
40594the interface that is expected.
40595
40596
40597
40598
40599. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40600. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40601
40602. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40603. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
40604. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
40605. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
40606. processors.
40607. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40608
40609.literal xml
40610<?sdop
40611 format="newpage"
40612 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
40613 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
40614?>
40615.literal off
40616
40617.makeindex "Options index" "option"
40618.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
40619.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
40620
40621
40622. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40623. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////